NEC Server N8100 1061F User Manual

N8100-1061F/1062F/1063F/1100F/1125F/1126F  
NEC Express5800/120Rh-2  
User's Guide  
5th Edition  
5-2006  
ONL-4133eN-120Rh2-100-99-0604  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keep this User's Guide at hand for quick reference at anytime necessary.  
SAFETY INDICATIONS  
Follow the instructions in this User's Guide for your safety to use the server.  
The server contains components with possible danger, hazards that may cause by ignoring warnings,  
and preventive actions against such hazards.  
Server components with possible danger are indicated with a warning label placed on or around them  
as well as described in this User's Guide.  
In the User's Guide or warning labels, "WARNING" or "CAUTION" is used to indicate a degree of  
danger. These terms are defined as follows:  
Indicates the presence of a hazard that may result in death or serious  
WARNING  
personal injury if the instruction is ignored.  
Indicates the presence of a hazard that may cause minor personal injury,  
including burns, or property damage if the instruction is ignored.  
CAUTION  
Precautions and notices against hazards are presented with one of the following three symbols. The  
individual symbols are defined as follows:  
This symbol indicates the presence of a hazard if the instruction is ignored.  
An image in the symbol illustrates the hazard type. (Attention)  
This symbol indicates prohibited actions. An image in the symbol illustrates a  
particular prohibited action. (Prohibited Action)  
This symbol indicates mandatory actions. An image in the symbol illustrates a  
mandatory action to avoid a particular hazard. (Mandatory Action)  
(Example)  
Symbol to draw attention  
Term indicating a degree of danger  
CAUTION  
Hot surface  
Immediately after the server is powered off, its internal components such as  
hard disk drives are very hot. Leave the server until its internal components  
fully cool down before installing/removing any component.  
Symbol indicating a prohibited  
action (may not always be  
indicated)  
Description of a danger  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SYMBOLS USED IN THIS USER'S GUIDE AND WARNING  
LABELS  
Attentions  
Indicates that improper use may cause an electric shock.  
Indicates that improper use may cause personal injury.  
Indicates that improper use may cause fingers to be caught.  
Indicates that improper use may cause fumes or fire.  
Indicates a general notice or warning that cannot be specifically identified.  
Indicates that improper use may cause loss of eyesight due to laser beam.  
Prohibited Actions  
Indicates a general prohibited action that cannot be specifically identified.  
Do not disassemble, repair, or modify the server. Otherwise, an electric shock or fire  
may be caused.  
Mandatory Action  
Unplug the power cord of the server. Otherwise, an electric shock or fire may be  
caused.  
Indicates a mandatory action that cannot be specifically identified. Make sure to  
follow the instruction.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NOTE: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital  
device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable  
protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial  
environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not  
installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to  
radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful  
interference in which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense.  
CE Statement  
Warning: This is a Class A product. In domestic environment this product may cause radio  
interference in which case the user may be required to take adequate measures (EN55022).  
BSMI Statement  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trademarks  
NEC DianaScope, NEC ESMPRO and NEC EXPRESSBUILDER are trademarks of NEC Corporation.  
Microsoft, Windows, Windows Server, Windows NT, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks or trademarks of  
Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries.  
Intel, Pentium, and Xeon are registered trademarks of Intel Corporation.  
Datalight is a registered trademark of Datalight, Inc.  
ROM-DOS is a trademark of Datalight, Inc.  
LSI-Logic, MegaRAID, MegaRAID Storage Manager and Power Console Plus are registered trademarks or  
trademarks of LSI Logic Corp.  
Novell and NetWare are registered trademarks of Novell, Inc. of the United States.  
AT is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation in the United States and other  
countries.  
Adaptec and its logo is a registered trademark of Adaptec, Inc. of United States.  
SCSISelect is a trademark of Adaptec, Inc. of the United States.  
Adobe, Adobe logo, and Acrobat are trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated.  
DLT and DLTtape are trademarks of Quantum Corporation of the United States.  
All other product, brand, or trade names used in this publication are the trademarks or registered trademarks of  
their respective trademark owners.  
Windows XP stands for Microsoft® Windows® XP Professional operating system and Microsoft® Windows®  
XP Home Edition operating system. Windows 2000 stands for Microsoft Windows 2000 Server operating  
®
®
system and Microsoft Windows 2000 Advanced Server operating system, and Microsoft Windows 2000  
®
®
®
®
Professional operating system. Windows 2003 stands for Microsoft Windows Server2003 operating  
®
system and Microsoft Windows Server2003 Standard Edition and Enterprise Edition. Windows Me stands  
®
for Microsoft Windows Millennium Edition operating system. Windows 98 stands for Microsoft  
®
®
®
Windows 98 operating system. Windows 95 stands for Microsoft Windows 95 operating system.  
®
®
®
Momentary voltage drop prevention:  
This product may be affected by a momentary voltage drop caused by lightning. To prevent a  
momentary voltage drop, an AC uninterruptible power supply (UPS) unit should be used.  
Notes:  
(1) No part of this manual may be reproduced in any form without the prior written permission of  
NEC Corporation.  
(2) The contents of this User's Guide may be revised without prior notice.  
(3) The contents of this User's Guide shall not be copied or altered without the prior written  
permission of NEC Corporation.  
(4) All efforts have been made to ensure the accuracy of all information in this User's Guide. If  
you notice any part unclear, incorrect, or omitted in this User's Guide, contact the sales agent  
where you purchased this product.  
(5) NEC assumes no liability arising from the use of this product, nor any liability for incidental or  
consequential damages arising from the use of this User's Guide regardless of Item (4).  
(6) If you find any missing pages or pages out of order in this manual, please contact your dealer  
for a replacement.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i
PREFACE  
Welcome to the NEC Express5800/120Rh-2 server.  
The NEC Express5800 server holds powerful performance and employs the latest technology to  
implement a computer for the next generation. With its potential capabilities, the server may be  
used as the workstation PC that configures a client-server system and provides high-speed  
processing and superior reliability.  
Read this User's Guide thoroughly to fully understand handling of the server and appreciate its  
functions to the maximum extent.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ii  
ABOUT THIS USER'S GUIDE  
This User's Guide is a guide for proper setup and use of the server.  
This User's Guide also covers useful procedures for dealing with difficulties and problems that may  
arise during setup or operation of the server.  
Keep this manual for future use.  
The following describes how to proceed with this User's Guide.  
How to Use This User's Guide  
To aid you in finding information quickly, this User's Guide contains the following information:  
Chapter 1 Notes on Using Your Server  
includes information that needs attention to use the server. Make sure to read this chapter  
before setting up and using the server. It also includes requirements and advisory information  
for transfer and disposal of the server.  
Chapter 2 General Description  
includes information necessary to use the server, such as names and functions of its  
components, handling of the floppy disk and CD-ROM drives.  
Chapter 3 Setting Up Your Server  
tells you how to select a site, unpack the system, assemble the rack-mount subsystem, make  
cable connections, and power on your system.  
Chapter 4 Configuring Your Server  
tells you how to configure the system and provides instructions for running the BIOS Setup  
Utility and the Adaptec Configuration Utility, which is used to configure SCSI devices in your  
system. This chapter also provides information on mother board jumper settings.  
Chapter 5 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
describes how to install the operating system.  
Chapter 6 Installing and Using Utilities  
describes how to install the utilities for the server. It also includes a description on using the  
attached CD-ROM "NEC EXPRESSBUILDER".  
Chapter 7 Maintenance  
provides you with all the information necessary to maintain successful operation of the server.  
This chapter also includes a description on relocating and storing the server.  
Chapter 8 Troubleshooting  
contains helpful information for solving problems that might occur with your system.  
Chapter 9 Upgrading Your Server  
provides you with instructions for upgrading your system with an additional processor, optional  
memory, optional add-in cards, hard disk drives, peripheral devices, and power supply.  
Appendix A Specification  
provides specifications for your server.  
Appendix B Other Precautions  
provides supplementary notes on using the server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
iii  
Appendix C IRQ and I/O Port Address  
provides a list of factory-set IRQs and I/O port addresses assigned.  
Appendix D Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
describes how to install Microsoft Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions without using Express  
Setup. Using the Express Setup tool is recommended for installing Windows Server 2003 x64  
Editions. See Chapter 5 for details.  
Appendix E Installing Windows Server 2003  
describes how to install Microsoft Windows Server 2003 without using Express Setup. Using  
the Express Setup tool is recommended for installing Windows Server 2003. See Chapter 5  
for details.  
Appendix F Installing Windows 2000  
describes how to install Microsoft Windows 2000 without using Express Setup. Using the  
Express Setup tool is recommended for installing Windows 2000. See Chapter 5 for details.  
Appendix G Product Configuration Record Table  
provides a table to be filled with your server configuration.  
Text Conventions  
The following conventions are used throughout this User's Guide. For safety symbols, see  
"SAFETY INDICATIONS" provided earlier.  
Items that are mandatory or require attention when using the server  
IMPORTANT:  
Helpful and convenient piece of information  
NOTE:  
IN THE PACKAGE  
The carton contains various accessories, as well as the server itself. See the packing list to make  
sure that you have everything and that individual components are not damaged. If you find any  
component missing or damaged, contact your sales agent.  
Store the provided accessories in a designated place for your convenience. You will need  
them to install an optional device or troubleshoot the server, as well as to set it up.  
Make a backup copy of each provided floppy disk, if any. Store the original disk as the  
master disk in a designated place, and use its copy.  
Improper use of any provided floppy disk or CD-ROM may alter your system  
environment. If you find anything unclear, immediately ask your sales agent for help.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
iv  
CONTENTS  
Preface ..............................................................................................................................................i  
About This User's Guide..................................................................................................................ii  
In the Package................................................................................................................................ iii  
Chapter 1 Notes on Using Your Server........................................................................1-1  
Warning Labels............................................................................................................................ 1-2  
Safety Notes................................................................................................................................. 1-3  
General .................................................................................................................................... 1-3  
Power Supply and Power Cord Use......................................................................................... 1-5  
Rack......................................................................................................................................... 1-6  
Installation, Relocation, Storage, and Connection................................................................... 1-7  
Cleaning and Working with Internal Devices.......................................................................... 1-9  
During Operation................................................................................................................... 1-10  
For Proper Operation ..................................................................................................................1-11  
Transfer to Third Party............................................................................................................... 1-13  
Disposal and Consumables ........................................................................................................ 1-14  
User Support .............................................................................................................................. 1-15  
Chapter 2 General Description .....................................................................................2-1  
Overview...................................................................................................................................... 2-1  
External View .......................................................................................................................... 2-2  
Front View with Front Bezel Closed ....................................................................................... 2-3  
Front View with Front Bezel Removed ................................................................................... 2-4  
Rear View................................................................................................................................ 2-6  
Internal View ........................................................................................................................... 2-8  
Mother Board .......................................................................................................................... 2-9  
Status Indicators......................................................................................................................... 2-10  
POWER LED ....................................................................................................................... 2-10  
STATUS LED ....................................................................................................................... 2-10  
DISK ACCESS LED ............................................................................................................ 2-12  
ACT LED ............................................................................................................................. 2-12  
UID LED (UID) .................................................................................................................... 2-12  
Disk Access LED................................................................................................................... 2-12  
Hard Disk Drive LED............................................................................................................ 2-13  
LAN Connector LEDs........................................................................................................... 2-14  
AC POWER LED.................................................................................................................. 2-15  
Standard Features....................................................................................................................... 2-16  
Power Supplies...................................................................................................................... 2-17  
Peripheral Bays...................................................................................................................... 2-17  
SAF-TE Logic............................................................................................................................ 2-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
v
System Board Features ...............................................................................................................2-18  
Processor ................................................................................................................................2-18  
Memory..................................................................................................................................2-18  
PCI Riser Slots.......................................................................................................................2-19  
Video ......................................................................................................................................2-19  
SCSI Controller......................................................................................................................2-19  
Network Controller ................................................................................................................2-20  
Keyboard and Mouse .............................................................................................................2-20  
ACPI.......................................................................................................................................2-20  
Remote Management Card (RMC) ........................................................................................2-21  
Degradation Feature ...................................................................................................................2-22  
Remote Power-On Feature (Wake On LAN)..............................................................................2-22  
AC-Link Feature.........................................................................................................................2-22  
System Security..........................................................................................................................2-23  
Security with Mechanical Locks and Monitoring ..................................................................2-23  
Software Locks via the BIOS Setup Utility............................................................................2-23  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.........................................................................................................2-27  
NEC ESMPRO ...........................................................................................................................2-28  
Off-line Maintenance Utility ......................................................................................................2-28  
System Diagnostic Utility...........................................................................................................2-28  
NEC DianaScope........................................................................................................................2-28  
Using Your Server.......................................................................................................................2-29  
Front Bezel.............................................................................................................................2-29  
POWER Switch......................................................................................................................2-31  
Identification of Servers (UID Switch) ..................................................................................2-36  
Floppy Disk Drive..................................................................................................................2-37  
CD-ROM Drive......................................................................................................................2-39  
Chapter 3 Setting Up Your Server ................................................................................ 3-1  
Setup Flow....................................................................................................................................3-2  
Selecting Server Site.....................................................................................................................3-3  
Unpacking the System..................................................................................................................3-5  
Installing the Server......................................................................................................................3-5  
Restricted Access Location ......................................................................................................3-6  
ESD Precaution ........................................................................................................................3-6  
Checking Components .............................................................................................................3-6  
Required Tools .........................................................................................................................3-6  
Installation Procedure for NEC Rack/Third Vendor's Rack .....................................................3-7  
Removing the Server from the Rack Assembly......................................................................3-14  
Connecting Peripheral Devices...................................................................................................3-16  
Connecting Power Cord..............................................................................................................3-18  
Turning On the Server ................................................................................................................3-20  
Installing Operating System .......................................................................................................3-22  
Installing Utilities .......................................................................................................................3-22  
Making Backup Copies of System Information..........................................................................3-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
vi  
Chapter 4 Configuring Your Server..............................................................................4-1  
System BIOS (SETUP)................................................................................................................ 4-1  
Starting SETUP Utility............................................................................................................ 4-2  
Description on On-Screen Items and Key Usage .................................................................... 4-3  
Menu and Parameter Descriptions........................................................................................... 4-4  
SCSI BIOS (SCSISelect) ........................................................................................................... 4-19  
Using SCSISelect Utility ....................................................................................................... 4-19  
Configuring SCSI Controller on Mother Board .................................................................... 4-19  
Configuring SCSI Controller on Optional Board .................................................................. 4-25  
RAID BIOS ............................................................................................................................... 4-26  
RAID Configuration .................................................................................................................. 4-27  
RAID Configuration of SCSI Hard Disk Drive..................................................................... 4-27  
Configuring Mother Board Jumpers .......................................................................................... 4-44  
Chapter 5 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup...............................5-1  
About Express Setup.................................................................................................................... 5-2  
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 ................................................................................................. 5-3  
Installation Notice ................................................................................................................... 5-3  
The Flow of Setup ................................................................................................................... 5-8  
Installing the Windows Server 2003........................................................................................ 5-9  
Installing and Setting Device Drivers.................................................................................... 5-14  
Setting for Solving Problems................................................................................................. 5-24  
Installing Maintenance Utilities............................................................................................. 5-28  
Updating the System - Installing Service Pack - ................................................................... 5-29  
Making Backup Copies of System Information .................................................................... 5-29  
Exceptional Setup.................................................................................................................. 5-30  
Microsoft Windows 2000........................................................................................................... 5-31  
Installation Notice ................................................................................................................. 5-31  
The Flow of Setup ................................................................................................................. 5-36  
Installing the Windows 2000 ................................................................................................. 5-37  
Installing and Setting Device Drivers.................................................................................... 5-42  
Setting for Solving Problems................................................................................................. 5-48  
Installing Maintenance Utilities............................................................................................. 5-51  
Updating the System - Installing Service Pack - ................................................................... 5-52  
Making Backup Copies of System Information .................................................................... 5-52  
Exceptional Setup.................................................................................................................. 5-53  
HostRAID.................................................................................................................................. 5-54  
Overview of HostRAID......................................................................................................... 5-54  
Notes...................................................................................................................................... 5-55  
HostRAID Setup Flow .......................................................................................................... 5-56  
Migration of Hard Disk Drive (Migration)............................................................................ 5-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
vii  
Chapter 6 Installing and Using Utilities....................................................................... 6-1  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER...........................................................................................................6-2  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER for DOS-Based with Local Console.............................................6-4  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER for DOS-based with Remote Console ..........................................6-9  
Starting...................................................................................................................................6-10  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER for Windows-Based (Master Control Menu)..............................6-13  
Configuration Diskette Creator...................................................................................................6-14  
NEC ESMPRO ...........................................................................................................................6-18  
Functions and Features...........................................................................................................6-18  
Adaptec Storage Manager- Browser Edition..........................................................................6-19  
Adaptec Storage Manager.......................................................................................................6-20  
MegaRAID Storage Manager(Server)....................................................................................6-21  
Setup with Express Setup.......................................................................................................6-21  
Manual Setup .........................................................................................................................6-21  
MegaRAID Storage Manager(Management PC) ...................................................................6-21  
Power Console Plus....................................................................................................................6-22  
Major Functions .....................................................................................................................6-22  
Components............................................................................................................................6-22  
Server Setup ...........................................................................................................................6-24  
Management PC Setup...........................................................................................................6-25  
NEC DianaScope........................................................................................................................6-26  
Chapter 7 Maintenance.................................................................................................. 7-1  
Making Backup Copies ................................................................................................................7-1  
Cleaning........................................................................................................................................7-2  
Cleaning the Server..................................................................................................................7-3  
Cleaning the Interior.................................................................................................................7-4  
Cleaning the Keyboard/Mouse.................................................................................................7-5  
Cleaning CD-ROM ..................................................................................................................7-6  
System Diagnostics.......................................................................................................................7-7  
Test Items .................................................................................................................................7-7  
Starting and Ending the System Diagnostics............................................................................7-8  
Relocating/Storing The Server....................................................................................................7-11  
Chapter 8 Troubleshooting........................................................................................... 8-1  
System Viewers ............................................................................................................................8-2  
LEDs.............................................................................................................................................8-3  
Error Messages .............................................................................................................................8-4  
Error Messages after Power-on ................................................................................................8-4  
POST Error Messages ..............................................................................................................8-5  
Beep Codes...............................................................................................................................8-9  
Solving Problems........................................................................................................................8-10  
Problems with the Server .......................................................................................................8-10  
Problems with Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions ...............................................................8-17  
Problems with Windows Server 2003 R2...............................................................................8-18  
Problems with Windows Server 2003 and Windows 2000.....................................................8-19  
Problems with NEC EXPRESSBUILDER ............................................................................8-21  
Problems with Express Setup.................................................................................................8-22  
Problems with Master Control Menu .....................................................................................8-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
viii  
Problems with Configuration Diskette Creator ..................................................................... 8-26  
Problems with Disk Array Configuration.............................................................................. 8-26  
Collecting Event Log................................................................................................................. 8-27  
Collecting Configuration Information........................................................................................ 8-28  
Collecting Dr. Watson Diagnostic Information.......................................................................... 8-29  
Memory Dump........................................................................................................................... 8-29  
Preparing for Memory Dumping ........................................................................................... 8-29  
Saving the Dump File............................................................................................................ 8-30  
Recovery for Windows 2000 System......................................................................................... 8-31  
Off-Line Maintenance Utility .................................................................................................... 8-34  
Starting the Off-line Maintenance Utility.............................................................................. 8-35  
Features of Off-line Maintenance Utility............................................................................... 8-36  
Resetting the Server................................................................................................................... 8-37  
Forced Shutdown ....................................................................................................................... 8-38  
Chapter 9 Upgrading Your Server ................................................................................9-1  
Safety Notes................................................................................................................................. 9-2  
Anti-static Measures .................................................................................................................... 9-3  
Preparing for Installation and Removal ....................................................................................... 9-4  
Confirmation after Installation/Removal ..................................................................................... 9-5  
Device Installation or Removal Procedure .................................................................................. 9-6  
Hard Disk Drive ...................................................................................................................... 9-6  
Power Supply Unit ................................................................................................................ 9-12  
Server (Pull-out from the Rack) ............................................................................................ 9-16  
Drive Cover ........................................................................................................................... 9-17  
Logic Cover........................................................................................................................... 9-18  
DIMM.................................................................................................................................... 9-19  
Processor (CPU).................................................................................................................... 9-23  
PCI Board.............................................................................................................................. 9-30  
Disk Array Controller Board ................................................................................................. 9-38  
Backup Device....................................................................................................................... 9-49  
Redundant Hot Swap-fan....................................................................................................... 9-55  
Remote Management Card (RMC)........................................................................................ 9-58  
Appendix A Specifications........................................................................................... A-1  
Appendix B Other Precautions.................................................................................... B-1  
Transfer Rate of the On-board LAN Controller ......................................................................B-1  
Server Management Software .................................................................................................B-1  
Floppy Disk .............................................................................................................................B-1  
CD-ROM.................................................................................................................................B-4  
Tape Media..............................................................................................................................B-4  
Keyboard .................................................................................................................................B-5  
Mouse......................................................................................................................................B-6  
Appendix C IRQ............................................................................................................. C-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ix  
Appendix D Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions........................................D-1  
Before Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions.................................................................D-1  
Optional Board Supported by NEC EXPRESSBUILDER......................................................D-1  
Updating System .....................................................................................................................D-2  
Re-installing to the Hard Disk Drive which has been upgraded to Dynamic Disk .................D-2  
Manual Installation when N8103-80F/81F and SCSI HostRAID Keeps Connection.............D-2  
MO Device..............................................................................................................................D-2  
Partition Size...........................................................................................................................D-3  
Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions.............................................................................D-4  
Creating "Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER"..D-4  
Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions Clean Installation...........................................................D-6  
Reinstallation to Multiple Logical drives................................................................................D-8  
Updating the System .............................................................................................................D-10  
Driver Installation and Advanced Settings ................................................................................D-11  
PROSet..................................................................................................................................D-11  
Network Driver .....................................................................................................................D-12  
Optional Network Board Driver............................................................................................D-13  
Adapter Fault Tolerance (AFT)/Adaptive Load Balancing (ALB)........................................D-14  
Re-install the Network Driver...............................................................................................D-14  
Graphics Accelerator Driver..................................................................................................D-15  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-56/-75/-95/N8190-126)......................................D-15  
Installing RAID Controller Driver (N8103-80F/81F)...........................................................D-16  
Setting for Collecting Memory Dump (Debug Information).....................................................D-16  
Appendix E Installing Windows Server 2003 ..............................................................E-1  
Before Installing Windows Server 2003...................................................................................... E-1  
Optional Board Supported by NEC EXPRESSBUILDER...................................................... E-1  
Disk Array Controller (N8103-91).......................................................................................... E-2  
Installing Service Pack............................................................................................................ E-2  
Updating System ..................................................................................................................... E-2  
Re-installing to the Hard Disk Drive which has been upgraded to Dynamic Disk ................. E-2  
Manual Installation when N8103-80F/81F/86 and SCSI HostRAID Keeps Connection........ E-2  
MO Device.............................................................................................................................. E-2  
Partition Size........................................................................................................................... E-3  
About the Upgrade to Windows Server 2003 R2 .................................................................... E-4  
Installing Windows Server 2003.................................................................................................. E-5  
Creating "Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" ..................... E-5  
Windows Server 2003 Clean Installation ................................................................................ E-7  
Upgrade Installation................................................................................................................ E-9  
Reinstallation to Multiple Logical drives.............................................................................. E-12  
Updating the System - Installing Service Pack -................................................................... E-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
x
Driver Installation and Advanced Settings.................................................................................E-15  
PROSet..................................................................................................................................E-15  
Network Driver......................................................................................................................E-16  
Re-install the Network Driver ...............................................................................................E-17  
Graphics Accelerator Driver..................................................................................................E-17  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-65F)....................................................................E-18  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-75)......................................................................E-19  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-56/-95/N8190-126) ............................................E-19  
Installing Disk Array Controller Driver (N8103-80F/81F) ...................................................E-20  
About Windows Activation ...................................................................................................E-21  
Available Switch Options for Windows Server 2003 Boot.ini File .......................................E-23  
Setting for Collecting Memory Dump (Debug Information) .....................................................E-24  
Appendix F Installing Windows 2000...........................................................................F-1  
Before Installing Windows 2000.................................................................................................. F-1  
Optional Board Supported by NEC EXPRESSBUILDER...................................................... F-1  
Disk Array Controller (N8103-91) .......................................................................................... F-2  
Installing Service Pack ............................................................................................................ F-2  
Updating System ..................................................................................................................... F-2  
Re-installing to the Hard Disk Drive which has been upgraded to Dynamic Disk.................. F-2  
Manual Installation when N8103-80F/81F/86 and SCSI HostRAID Keeps Connection ........ F-2  
MO Device .............................................................................................................................. F-2  
Partition Size ........................................................................................................................... F-3  
Installing Windows 2000 ............................................................................................................. F-4  
Creating "Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER"................................. F-4  
Windows 2000 Clean Installation............................................................................................ F-6  
Reinstallation to Multiple Logical Drives ............................................................................... F-7  
Updating the System - Installing Service Pack - ..................................................................... F-9  
Driver Installation and Advanced Settings................................................................................. F-10  
PROSet.................................................................................................................................. F-10  
Network Driver...................................................................................................................... F-11  
Re-install the Network Driver ............................................................................................... F-12  
Graphics Accelerator Driver.................................................................................................. F-13  
USB 2.0 Driver...................................................................................................................... F-13  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-65F/75)............................................................... F-14  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-56/-95/N8190-126) ............................................ F-14  
Installing RAID Controller Driver (N8103-80F/81F) ........................................................... F-15  
Available Switch Options for Windows 2000 Boot.ini File................................................... F-15  
Setting for Collecting Memory Dump (Debug Information) ..................................................... F-16  
Appendix G Product Configuration Record Table..................................................... G-1  
Hardware .................................................................................................................................G-1  
Software...................................................................................................................................G-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 1  
Notes on Using Your Server  
This chapter includes information necessary for proper and safe operation of the server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-2 Notes on Using Your Server  
WARNING LABELS  
The warning label is attached to components with possible danger or their vicinity in your server to  
inform the user that a hazardous situation may arise when operating the server. (Do not  
intentionally remove or damage any of the labels.)  
If you find any labels totally/partially removed or illegible due to damage, contact your service  
representative.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notes on Using Your Server 1-3  
SAFETY NOTES  
This section provides notes on using the server safely. Read this section carefully to ensure proper  
and safe use of the server. For symbols, see "SAFETY INDICATIONS" provided earlier.  
General  
WARNING  
Do not use the server for services where critical high availability may directly  
affect human lives.  
Your server is not intended to be used with or control facilities or devices  
concerning human lives, including medical devices, nuclear facilities and  
devices, aeronautics and space devices, transportation facilities and devices;  
and facilities and devices requiring high reliability. NEC assumes no liability for  
any accident resulting in personal injury, death, or property damage if the server  
has been used in the above conditions.  
Do not use the server if any smoke, odor, or noise is present.  
If smoke, odor, or noise is present, immediately turn off the server and  
disconnect the power plug from the outlet, then contact your service  
representative. Using the server in such conditions may cause a fire.  
Keep needles or metal objects away from the server.  
Do not insert needles or metal objects into ventilation holes in the server or  
openings in the floppy disk or CD-ROM drive. Doing so may cause an electric  
shock.  
Do not use the server in any unapproved place.  
Install the server on a standard EIA 19-inch rack assembly. Do not install the  
rack containing the server in a place inappropriate to the rack installation  
environment.  
Failure to follow these instructions may cause some bad influences to be  
imposed on the server and other systems installed on the rack and also a fire or  
personal injury due to falling of the rack may occur. For the detailed  
explanation on the place where the server should be installed and the  
earthquake-resistant construction for the rack, refer to the manual attached to  
the rack or contact you service representative.  
Always install the server on a rack conforming to the relevant standard.  
Install the server on a rack confirming to the EIA standard for the Server to be  
used. Do not use the server with installed on any other rack than standard EIA  
19-inch rack or without the installation on a proper rack. Failure to follow these  
instructions may cause the server to operate incorrectly and/or personal injury or  
damages of surrounding devices to occur. Contact your service representative  
for the racks available for the server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-4 Notes on Using Your Server  
CAUTION  
Keep water or foreign matter away from the server.  
Do not let any form of liquid (water etc.) or foreign matter (e.g., pins or paper  
clips) enter the server. Failure to follow this warning may cause an electric  
shock, a fire, or a failure of the server. When such things accidentally enter the  
server, immediately turn off the power and disconnect the power plug from the  
outlet. Do not disassemble the server. Contact your service representative.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notes on Using Your Server 1-5  
Power Supply and Power Cord Use  
WARNING  
Do not hold the power plug with a wet hand.  
Do not disconnect/connect the plug while your hands are wet. Failure to follow  
this warning may cause an electric shock.  
Do not connect the ground wire to a gas pipe.  
Never connect the ground wire to a gas pipe. Failure to follow this warning  
may cause a gas explosion.  
CAUTION  
Plug in to a proper power source.  
Use a proper wall outlet. Use of an improper power source may cause a fire or  
a power leak.  
Do not install the server where you need an extension cord. Use of a cord that  
does not meet the power specifications of the server may heat up the cord and  
cause a fire.  
Do not connect the power cord to an outlet that has an illegal number of  
connections.  
The electric current exceeding the rated flow overheats the outlet, which may  
cause a fire.  
Insert the power plug into the outlet as far as it goes.  
Heat generation resulting from a halfway inserted power plug (imperfect contact)  
may cause a fire. Heat will also be generated if condensation is formed on  
dusty blades of the halfway inserted plug, increasing the possibility of fire.  
Use the authorized power cord only.  
Use only the power cord that comes with your server. Use of an unauthorized  
power cord may cause a fire when the electric current exceeds the rated flow.  
Also, observe the following to prevent an electric shock or fire caused by a  
damaged cord.  
Do not stretch the cord harness.  
Do not pinch the power cord.  
Do not bend the power cord.  
Keep chemicals away from the  
power cord.  
Do not twist the power cord.  
Do not place any object on the  
power cord.  
Do not alter, modify, or repair the  
power cord.  
Do not secure the power cord with  
staples or equivalents.  
Do not use any damaged power  
cord. (Replace a damaged power  
cord with a new one of the same  
specifications. Ask your service  
representative for replacement.)  
Do not bundle power cords.  
Do not use the attached power cord for any other devices or usage.  
The power cord that comes with your server is designed aiming to connect with  
this server and to use with the server, and its safety has been tested. Do not use  
the attached power cord for any other purpose. Doing so may cause a fire or an  
electric shock.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-6 Notes on Using Your Server  
Rack  
CAUTION  
Do not carry or install the server only by a single person.  
More than one person is required to carry or install the rack. Failure to follow  
this instruction may cause the rack to fall to result in personal injury and/or  
breakages of surrounding devices. In particular, a high rack (such as 44U  
rack) is unstable if it is not fixed by stabilizers. More than one person must  
always carry or install the rack while they support it.  
Do not install the server so that the load may be concentrated on a specific  
point.  
Install stabilizers on the rack so that the total load of the rack and devices  
mounted on the rack is not concentrated on a singe point or join more than one  
rack with each other to distribute the load. Failure to follow this instruction may  
cause the rack to fall to result in personal injury.  
Do not install components on the server only by a single person.  
More than one person is required to install parts including the doors and trays for  
the rack. Failure to follow this instruction may cause some parts to fall to be  
broken and/or to result in personal injury.  
Do not pull out a device from the rack if the rack is unstable.  
Always pull out a device from the rack in the state that the rack is made stable  
(by the installation of stabilizers or earthquake-resistant construction).  
Do not leave more than one device being pulled out from the rack.  
Pulling out more than one device from the rack may cause the rack to be fallen.  
Only pull out a single device from the rack at a time.  
Do not provide the wiring for the server to exceed the rating of the power supply.  
To prevent burns, fires, and device damages, the power supplied to the power  
supply in the rack shall not exceed the rating load of the power branch circuit.  
Contact your electric constructor or the local power company for the  
requirements on the wiring and installation of electric facilities.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notes on Using Your Server 1-7  
Installation, Relocation, Storage, and Connection  
WARNING  
Disconnect the power cord(s) before installing or removing the server.  
Make sure to power off the server and disconnect the power cord(s) from a  
power outlet before installing/removing the server. All voltage is removed only  
when the power cords are unplugged.  
CAUTION  
Never attempt to lift the server only by yourself.  
The server weighs max. 30 kg (depending on its hardware configuration).  
Carrying the server only by yourself may strain your back. Hold the server  
firmly by its bottom with another person to carry it. Do not hold the front door to  
lift the server. The front door may be disengaged from the server, causing  
personal injury.  
Do not install the server in any place other than specified.  
Do not install the server in the following places or any place other than specified  
in this User's Guide. Failure to follow this instruction may cause a fire.  
a dusty place  
a humid place such as near a boiler  
a place exposed to direct sunlight  
an unstable place  
Do not install the server on a rack with leaving covers removed.  
Do not install the server on a rack with the cover being removed. Failure to  
follow this instruction may reduce the cooling effect in the server to result in  
some malfunction and/or dusts to enter the server to result in a fire or electric  
shock.  
Do not pinch your finger with rails or other components.  
Note sufficiently that your fingers may not be caught between a rail and another  
mechanical part or cut by a rail at installation or removal of the server from the  
rack.  
Do not apply any load on the server pulled out from the rack.  
Do not apply any load on the server pulled out from the rack. Doing so bends  
the frame of the server. Consequently, the server cannot be pushed back into  
the rack. Placing an object on the server may also cause personal injury if the  
server drops.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-8 Notes on Using Your Server  
CAUTION  
Do not connect any interface cable with the power cord of the server plugged to  
a power source.  
Make sure to power off the server and unplug the power cord from a power  
outlet before installing/removing any optional internal device or  
connecting/disconnecting any interface cable to/from the server. If the server  
is off-powered but its power cord is plugged to a power source, touching an  
internal device, cable, or connector may cause an electric shock or a fire  
resulted from a short circuit.  
Do not use any unauthorized interface cable.  
Use only interface cables provided by NEC and locate a proper device and  
connector before connecting a cable. Using an authorized cable or connecting  
a cable to an improper destination may cause a short circuit, resulting in a fire.  
Also, observe the following notes on using and connecting an interface cable.  
Do not use any damaged cable connector.  
Do not step on the cable.  
Do not place any object on the cable.  
Do not use the server with loose cable connections.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notes on Using Your Server 1-9  
Cleaning and Working with Internal Devices  
WARNING  
Do not disassemble, repair, or alter the server.  
Never attempt to disassemble, repair, or alter the server on any occasion other  
than described in this User's Guide. Failure to follow this instruction may cause  
an electric shock or fire as well as malfunctions of the server.  
Do not look into the CD-ROM drive.  
A laser beam is used in the CD-ROM drive. Do not look into or insert a mirror  
into the drive while the drive is powered. If a laser beam is caught in your eyes,  
you may lose your eyesight (the laser beam is invisible).  
Do not remove the lithium battery.  
The server contains the lithium battery. Do not remove the battery. Placing  
the lithium close to a fire or in the water may cause an explosion.  
When the server does not operate appropriately due to the dead lithium battery,  
contact your service representative. Do not disassemble the server to replace  
or recharge the battery by yourself.  
Disconnect the power plug before cleaning the server.  
Make sure to power off the server and disconnect the power plug from a power  
outlet before cleaning or installing/removing internal optional devices.  
Touching any internal device of the server with its power cord connected to a  
power source may cause an electric shock even of the server is off-powered.  
Disconnect the power plug from the outlet occasionally and clean the plug with a  
dry cloth. Heat will be generated if condensation is formed on a dusty plug,  
which may cause a fire.  
CAUTION  
Avoid installation in extreme temperature conditions.  
Immediately after the server is powered off, its internal components such as  
hard disk drives are very hot. Leave the server until its internal components  
fully cool down before installing/removing any component.  
Make sure to complete board installation.  
Always install a board firmly. An incompletely installed board may cause a  
contact failure, resulting in smoking or fire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-10 Notes on Using Your Server  
During Operation  
CAUTION  
Do not pull out or remove the server from the rack unnecessarily.  
Do not pull out or remove the server from the rack unnecessarily. Pulling out or  
removing the server from the rack may cause not only the server to operate  
incorrectly but also the server to fall on people to make them injured.  
Stay away from the fan.  
Keep your hand or hair away from the cooling fan on the rear of the server.  
Failure to follow this warning may get your hand or hair caught in the fan,  
resulting in injury.  
Avoid contact with the server during thunderstorms.  
Disconnect the power plug from the outlet when a thunderstorm is approaching.  
If it starts thundering before you disconnect the power plug, do not touch any  
part of the server including the cables. Failure to follow this warning may cause  
a fire or an electric shock.  
Keep animals away from the server.  
Failure to follow this warning may cause a fire or an electric shock.  
Do not place any object on top of the server.  
The server may fall and cause property damage to the surroundings.  
Do not leave the server with its CD-ROM tray ejected.  
Dust may enter the server through openings and cause malfunctions of the  
server. Any person may also bump it and get injured.  
Do not use a cellular phone or pager around the server.  
Turn off the cellular phone or pager. Radio interference may cause  
malfunctions of the server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notes on Using Your Server 1-11  
FOR PROPER OPERATION  
Observe the following notes for successful operation of the server. Use of the server ignoring the  
notes will cause malfunctions or failures of the server.  
Install the rack assembly in a place that meets requirements for successful operation. For  
details, see Chapter 3, "Setting Up Your Server."  
The server is intended for installation in a Restricted Access Location, mounted above a  
non-combustible material.  
Do not delete the hard disk partition exclusively provided for maintenance of the server  
although it may appear on the OS.  
Make sure to power off the server before connecting or disconnecting cables between the  
server and peripheral devices.  
Verify that the access LED on the server is unlit before turning off the server or ejecting  
the floppy disk.  
The server management logic on your system board monitors and logs system voltage  
changes. When plugging the power cord to the system, you may experience 10 seconds  
delay from the time you press the POWER switch on the front panel. This is normal  
system operation and is required by the server management logic.  
Do not turn off the server until the POST (Power On Self-Test) completes. See Chapter 2  
for details of POST.  
When you have just turned off the server, wait at least 30 seconds before turning it back  
on.  
Turn off the power and unplug the power cord from the outlet before relocating the server.  
Clean the server on a regular basis. (See Chapter 7 for cleaning.) Regular cleaning  
proactively prevents various failures of the server.  
Lightning may cause a momentary voltage drop. To prevent this problem, it is  
recommended to use of an uninterruptible power supply unit.  
Check and adjust the system clock before the operation if any of the following conditions  
is applicable.  
– After carriage of device  
– After storage of device  
– After the device is entered into the pause state under the environmental condition  
enduring device operation (temperature: 10°C - 35°C, humidity: 20% - 80%)  
Check the system clock at the rough rate of once per month. When the system clock is  
installed in a system requiring high time precision, it is recommended to use a time server  
(NTP server).  
If the system clock is remarkably delayed or advanced as the passage of time in spite of  
adjustment, contact your service representative to ask maintenance.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-12 Notes on Using Your Server  
Store the unit under the storage condition (temperature: –10°C - 55°C, humidity: 20% -  
80%, without condensation) to allow built-in devices and the unit to operate correctly in  
the next operation.  
Make sure to use optional devices supported by the server. Some non-supported devices  
may be physically installed/connected but cause failures of the server as well as a  
malfunction of the server.  
NEC recommends you use NEC's genuine products. Some third-party products claim  
that they support the server. However, repair of the server due to a failure or damage  
resulted from use of such third-party products will be charged.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notes on Using Your Server 1-13  
TRANSFER TO THIRD PARTY  
The following must be observed when you transfer (or sell) the server or software provided with the  
server to a third party:  
Server Hardware  
Make sure to provide this User's Guide along with the server to a third party.  
Provided Software  
To transfer or sell any software application that comes with the server to a third party, the following  
requirements must be satisfied:  
All provided software applications must be transferred and no backup copies must be  
retained.  
Transfer requirements listed in "Software License Agreement" that comes with each  
software application must be satisfied.  
Software applications that are not approved for transfer must be uninstalled before  
transferring the server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-14 Notes on Using Your Server  
DISPOSAL AND CONSUMABLES  
Dispose the server, all the internal devices, floppy disks, and CD-ROMs according to all  
national laws and regulations.  
IMPORTANT: For disposal (or replacement) of the battery on the  
mother board of the server, consult with your service representative.  
The server contains some components that are only good for a limited period of time and  
require replacement, such as fans, internal batteries, the internal CD-ROM drive, the  
floppy disk drive, and the mouse. For stable operation of the server, NEC recommends  
you replace these components on a regular basis. Consult with your service  
representative for replacement or the product lives.  
WARNING  
Do not remove the lithium battery.  
The server contains the lithium battery. Do not remove the battery. Placing  
the lithium or nickel cadmium battery close to a fire or in the water may cause an  
explosion.  
When the server does not operate appropriately due to the dead lithium battery,  
contact your service representative. Do not disassemble the server to replace  
or recharge the battery by yourself.  
Mother board  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notes on Using Your Server 1-15  
USER SUPPORT  
Before Asking for Repair, do the following when the server appears to fail:  
1. Check if the power cord and the cables to other devices are properly connected.  
2. See Chapter 8 to find if your problem fits the description. If it does, take the  
recommended measure for it.  
3. Check if the software required for operation of the server is properly installed.  
If the server still appears to fail after you have taken the above actions, consult with your service  
representative immediately. Take notes on LED indications of the server and alarm indications on  
the display unit before consultation, which may provide a significant help to your sale agent.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-16 Notes on Using Your Server  
Advice for Health  
The longer you keep using the computer equipment, the more you become  
tired, which may cause disorders of your body. When you use a  
computer, observe the following to keep yourself from getting tired:  
Good Working Posture  
You have good posture if the following are satisfied when you use a  
computer:  
You sit on a chair with your back straight.  
Your hands are parallel with the floor when you put them on the  
keyboard.  
You look at the screen slightly lower than your eye height.  
You have "good working posture" as described in the above when no part  
of your body is under excess strain, in other words when your muscles are  
most relaxed.  
You have "bad posture" when you sit with your back hunched up or you  
operate a display unit with your face close to the screen. Bad working  
posture may cause eye strain or poor eyesight.  
Adjustment of Display Unit Angles  
Most display units are designed for adjustment of the horizontal and  
vertical angles. This adjustment is important to prevent the screen from  
reflecting bright lights and to make the display contents easy to see. You  
will not be able to keep "good working posture" and you will feel more tired  
than you should if you operate a display unit without adjusting horizontal  
and vertical angles.  
Adjustment of Screen Brightness and Contrast  
The display unit has brightness and contrast adjustment functions. The  
most suitable brightness and contrast depend on the individual and the  
working environment (well-lighted room or insufficient light). Adjust  
brightness and contrast so that the screen will be easy to see. An  
extremely bright or dark screen will give a bad effect to your eyes.  
Adjustment of Keyboard Angle  
The keyboard provided with the server is designed for adjustment of an  
angle. Adjust the keyboard angle at which the keyboard is easy to  
operate. The adjustment assists in reducing strain on your shoulders,  
arms, and fingers.  
Cleaning of Equipment  
Clean equipment regularly. It is difficult to see the display contents on a  
dusty screen. Keeping equipment clean is also important for your sight.  
Fatigue and Rest  
If you feel tired, you should stop working and do light exercises.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2  
General Description  
This chapter provides information that you should be familiar with before using the server. It  
includes names and functions of the components and features of the server.  
OVERVIEW  
Your server is a modular, multiprocessing server based on the IntelXeonmicroprocessor. It is  
a solid performer and offers the latest technology. The combination of compute performance,  
memory capacity, and integrated I/O provides a high performance environment for many server  
market applications. These range from large corporations supporting remote offices to small  
companies looking to obtain basic connectivity capability such as file and print services, e-mail,  
web access, web site server, etc.  
Your server is housed and available as a rack-mount system. Your server conveniently installs into  
a standard EIA 19-inch rack assembly.  
Your server includes a 3.5-inch diskette drive, a CD-ROM drive, six hot-swap SCSI hard disk drive  
bays, and a removable media device bay. The hot-swap SCSI hard disk drive bays support up to  
six 1.0-inch SCSI hard disk drives that can be swapped in or out of the system without powering it  
down, if RAID functionality is configured in the system.  
The removable media drive bay may be used for installation of a high-speed tape drive.  
As application requirements increase, you can expand your server with an additional processor,  
additional memory, add-in boards and peripheral devices: tape devices, CD-ROM, and hard disk  
drives.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-2 General Description  
External View  
2
1
7
6
5
4
3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Drive cover  
Logic cover  
Switches, indicators, and front I/Os  
Optical disk drive (CD-ROM drive)  
Floppy disk drive  
Backup file device bay  
SCSI hot-plug hard disk drive bay  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-3  
Front View with Front Bezel Closed  
The following figure shows the location of the front system features.  
ID  
7
3
4-1  
4-2  
6
5
1
2
1
Front bezel  
The front bezel is a cover protecting the front devices during daily operation. A security key  
is provided to lock the cover.  
2
3
Key slot  
Insert the security key into this slot when unlocking the front bezel.  
STATUS LED (green/amber) (on the front panel)  
This LED indicates the server status. The LED is green during normal operation. The LED  
turns amber or flashes when the server enters the abnormal state.  
ACT LED (green)  
This LED is on while the system is connected to the network. The number "1" on the icon  
indicates LAN port 1, and the number "2" indicates LAN port 2.  
DISK ACCESS LED (green/amber)  
4
5
This LED is green during access to the internal hard disk drives. The LED turns amber when  
even one of the internal hard disk drives fails.  
6
7
POWER LED (green)  
This LED turns green when the power is turned on.  
UID LED (blue)  
This LED goes on when the UID switch is pressed. (The LED also goes on or blinks when  
software issues a command.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-4 General Description  
Front View with Front Bezel Removed  
14  
11  
12  
14  
13  
14  
5
2
3-0  
3-1 3-2  
4
3-3 3-4 3-5  
6-1 6-2 6-3  
2
1
1
10-1 10-2 10-3  
9
8
7
1
Captive thumb screws (1 at the right and left each)  
The screws secure the server to the rack.  
Handles (1 at the right and left each)  
Hold the handles when dismounting/mounting the server from/in the rack.  
Hard disk drive bays  
2
3
Mount hard disk drives in the bays. Each number following the bold-faced number indicates  
the SCSI ID or SAS port number. In the standard configuration, the hard disk drive trays are  
mounted in all the bays.  
4
DISK LED (green/amber)  
Hard disk drive LED. Each hard disk drive LED is green during access to the hard disk drive.  
The LED turns amber when the hard disk drive fails. The LED flashes switching back and  
forth between green and amber during build processing (in only disk array configuration).  
CD/FD bay  
A CD-ROM or floppy disk drive is mounted.  
CD-ROM drive  
5
6
This drive reads data from the CD-ROM.  
6-1 Disk access LED  
6-2 CD tray eject button  
6-3 Emergency hole  
7
USB connectors (2 ports)  
Connect device compliant with the USB interface to the connectors.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-5  
8
9
Serial port B (COM B) connector  
Used to communicate with the remote console via direct connection.  
Backup device bay  
Mount an optional DAT or AIT drive in this bay.  
10 3.5-inch floppy disk drive  
This drive reads/writes data from/to the 3.5-inch floppy disk.  
10-1 Disk access LED  
10-2 Disk slot  
10-3 Eject button  
11 UID (Unit ID) switch  
Press this switch to turn on/off the UID LEDs on the front and rear panels of the server.  
Pressing the switch once turns on the LEDs. Pressing it again turns them off.  
12 POWER switch  
Press this switch to turn on/off the power. Pressing the switch once turns on the power, and  
the POWER LED goes on. Pressing it again turns off the power. Keep pressing the switch  
for 4 seconds or more forcibly turns off the power.  
13 DUMP switch (NMI switch)  
Press this switch to dump memory.  
14 LEDs (See the previous page for the six LEDs.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-6 General Description  
Rear View  
1
2
3
4
15  
14-2 14-1 13 12 11 10  
9
8
7
6
5
16 17-1 18 16 17-2 18  
1
Low-profile PCI board extension slots  
Mount PCI boards of the low-profile type into the slots. The slots are called 3C, 2C, and 1C  
from top.  
2
3
Captive thumbscrew  
Secure the logic cover.  
Full-height PCI board extension slots  
Mount PCI boards of the full-height type in the slots. The slots are called 3B, 2B, and 1B  
from top.  
4
5
AC inlet  
Connect the attached power cord to this socket.  
AC POWER LED  
This LED turns green and flashes when the server receives AC power from the power cord.  
The LED turns green when the server power switch is turned on, and it turns amber when a  
power failure occurs.  
6
7
Power supply unit (power supply slot 1)  
This unit supplies power to the server.  
Power supply unit extension slot (power supply slot 2)  
Mount an optional power supply unit in this slot. The slot is protected with the blank cover  
in the standard status.  
8
9
Mouse/keyboard connectors  
Connect the mouse and keyboard to the connectors through the provided relay cables.  
SCSI connector  
Connect external SCSI device to this connector.  
10 UID LED (blue)  
This LED goes on when the UID switch is pressed. (The LED also goes on when software  
issues a command.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-7  
11 UID (Unit ID) switch  
Press this switch to turn on/off the UID LEDs on the front and rear panels of the server.  
Pressing the switch once turns on the LEDs. Pressing it again turns them off.  
12 DUMP switch  
Press this switch to dump memory.  
13 Serial port A (COM A) connector  
Connect device having a serial interface to this connector. Use COM B connector to  
communicate with the remote console. A leased line cannot be connected directly to this  
connector.  
14 USB connectors  
Connect device compliant with the USB interface to this connector.  
15 VGA connector  
Connect the display unit to this connector.  
16 LINK/ACT LED (green)  
This LED indicates the access status of the LAN.  
17 LAN connectors  
Connect network systems on the LAN to the connectors.  
The number "1" following the bold-faced number indicates LAN port 1, and the number "2"  
indicates LAN port 2.  
18 Speed LED (amber)  
This LED indicates the transmission speed of the LAN.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-8 General Description  
Internal View  
1
2-1  
2-2  
3
4
13-1  
5
6
13-2  
13-3  
7
8
13-4  
FRONT  
REAR  
12  
2-4  
2-3  
11  
10  
9
1
2
SCSI backplane  
Cooling fans  
2-1: FAN1  
2-3: FAN3  
2-2: FAN2  
2-4: FAN4  
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Support arm  
Power supply unit  
Remote management card  
Mother board  
Riser card  
Chassis intrusion switch  
DIMM (Two DIMMs are mounted as standard in slots #7 and #8.)  
10 Processor (mounted under the CPU and heat sink)  
11 Processor duct (dashed-line)  
12 Front panel board  
13 Optional redundant fan slots  
13-1: FAN5  
13-3: FAN7  
13-2: FAN6  
13-4: FAN8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-9  
Mother Board  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
14  
13-1  
9
13-2  
FRONT  
REAR  
11  
12  
10  
1
2
3
4
Main power connector  
Lithium battery  
CMOS clear jumper switch  
Hard disk drive access LED pin header  
(Connect the LED relay cable of an additional SCSI/RAID controller.)  
Remote management card socket  
SCSI 1 connector (for SCSI hard disk drives)  
SCSI 2 connector (for backup file device)  
Password clear jumper switch  
5
6
7
8
9
Connectors for external device  
10 PCI riser card slot  
(For full-height boards. 100 MHz/64-bit, 3.3V, PCI-X)  
11 PCI riser slot  
(For only low-profile boards. 66MHz/64-bit, 3.3V, PCI-X)  
12 DIMM sockets (for the interleave type)  
(The sockets are called #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6, #7, and #8 sequentially from top.)  
13 Processor sockets  
13-1 Processor #1 (CPU #1)  
13-2 Processor #2 (CPU #2)  
14 Redundant fan jumper switch  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-10 General Description  
STATUS INDICATORS  
This section explains the indication and meanings of the server LEDs.  
POWER LED (  
)
The green POWER LED lights to indicate normal operation while the server is powered. When  
the server is off-powered, the POWER LED stays unlit.  
The POWER LED indicates that the server is running in the power-saving mode (sleep mode). If  
the OS supports the power-saving mode such as Windows Server 2003, running a command blinks  
the POWER LED in green and place the server in the power-saving mode. Press the POWER  
switch to turn out the POWER LED and place the server back in the normal mode.  
The power-saving mode is only available when the OS supports the power-saving feature. Some  
OS's allow you to set the server to automatically turn in the power-saving mode when no access is  
made to the server for a certain period of time or to select the power-saving mode with a command.  
STATUS LED (  
)
The STATUS LED is on (green) while the server is operating normally. (The rear panel also has  
the STATUS LED on it.) If the STATUS LED is off or turns amber and flashes, it indicates that  
the server is in abnormal state.  
The table below explains the STATUS LED indication, the meanings, and the procedures.  
NOTES:  
If NEC ESMPRO or the offline maintenance utility is installed, you  
can confirm the cause of a failure by referring to the error log.  
If shutdown processing can be performed through the operating  
system when you want to restart the system after turning the power  
off, restart the system by performing shutdown processing. If  
shutdown processing cannot be performed, restart the system by  
resetting, forcibly turning the power off, or disconnecting and then  
connecting the power cord.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-11  
STATUS LED  
indication  
Description  
Procedure  
On (green)  
The server is operating normally.  
Flashing  
(green)  
The server is operating with the  
memory, CPU in degraded state.  
Check the AC POWER LED indication  
on the rear panel of the server.  
Identify the device in degraded state  
by using the BIOS setup utility  
"SETUP," and replace it as soon as  
possible.  
An uncorrectable memory error  
has often occurred.  
Off  
The power is off.  
POST is in progress.  
Wait for a while. The STATUS LED  
turns green when POST is completed.  
A CPU error occurred.  
A CPU temperature alarm was  
detected. (IERR)  
A timeout occurred when the time  
set for the watchdog timer arrived.  
Turn the power off and then turn it on.  
If the POST screen displays an error  
message, take notes of the message,  
and contact your service  
representative.  
A CPU bus error occurred.  
A memory dump request is made.  
Wait until the memory dump is  
completed.  
On (amber)  
A temperature alarm was detected.  
Check if the internal fans are clean  
and if the fan units are firmly  
connected.  
If the STATUS LED indication does not  
change when the fans are normal,  
contact your service representative.  
A voltage alarm was detected.  
All the power supply units failed.  
Contact your service representative.  
Flashing  
(amber)  
Either of the following was detected  
in the redundant power  
configuration:  
AC power not supplied to one of  
the two power supply units  
Connect the power cord to supply  
power. If the power supply unit is  
faulty, contact your service  
representative.  
Failure of one of the two power  
supply units  
A fan alarm was detected.  
Check if the fan units are firmly  
connected.  
If the STATUS LED indication does not  
change when the fans are normal,  
contact your service representative.  
A temperature warning was  
detected.  
Check if the internal fans are clean  
and if the fan units are firmly  
connected.  
If the STATUS LED indication does not  
change when the fans are normal,  
contact your service representative.  
A voltage warning was detected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-12 General Description  
DISK ACCESS LED ( )  
The DISK ACCESS LED indicates the status of the hard disk drive mounted in the 3.5-inch disk  
bay.  
The LED turns green each time access is made to the hard disk drive.  
When the DISK ACCESS LED turns amber, it indicates that a hard disk drive failure has occurred.  
Check the hard disk drive LED for the status of the failing hard disk drive.  
IMPORTANT: If a hard disk drive in the server is connected to the  
internal disk array controller (which is additionally mounted), the  
access LED signal cable (connected to the connector on the mother  
board) must be connected from the disk array controller to the mother  
board.  
ACT LED (  
)
The ACT LED is green while the server is connected to the LAN. The LED flashes while the  
server is accessed via the LAN (during transmission/reception of packets). The number next to the  
icon indicates the network port number on the rear panel of the server.  
UID LED (UID)  
Pressing the UID switch toggles the front panel UID LED (blue) and the mother board UID LED on  
and off. The mother board UID LED is visible through the rear of the chassis and allows you to  
locate the server you're working on from the rear of the servers on a rack.  
Disk Access LED  
The disk access LED of the floppy disk drive or CD-ROM drive is on while the drive is accessed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-13  
Hard Disk Drive LED  
The disk LED mounted in the 3.5-inch disk bay indicates the following depending on the status:  
LED  
Flashing (green)  
The LED indicates that the hard disk drive is accessed.  
On (amber)  
The LED indicates a failure of a hard disk drive mounted in disk array configuration.  
NOTE: Even if one of the hard disk drives fails in disk array  
configuration (RAID1 or RAID5), the server can continue operation.  
However, replace the disk as soon as possible, and perform  
reconstruction (rebuild) processing. (The failing disk can be replaced  
in hot swap mode.)  
Flashing switching back and forth between green and amber  
The LED indicates that reconstruction (rebuild) processing is being performed for the hard  
disk drive. (This flashing does not indicate a failure.) When a failing hard disk drive is  
replaced in disk array configuration, the system automatically rebuilds the data. (Auto-  
rebuild function) The LED switches back and forth between green and amber during  
rebuild processing.  
The LED goes off when the rebuild processing has terminated. It turns amber when the  
rebuild processing fails.  
IMPORTANT: If the server is turned off during rebuild processing, the  
processing is stopped. Restart the server, mount the new hard disk  
drive in hot swap mode, and then perform rebuild processing again.  
Observe the following notes on using the auto-rebuild function.  
Do not turn the power off. (Once the power is turned off, the auto-  
build function does not start.)  
Let 90 seconds or more pass between when dismounting a failing  
hard disk drive and when mounting the new one.  
Do not replace a failing hard disk drive while rebuild processing is  
being performed for another hard disk drive.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-14 General Description  
LAN Connector LEDs  
There are two LEDs for each of the two LAN ports (connectors) on the rear panel.  
Speed LEDs  
LINK/ACT LEDs  
LINK/ACT LED  
Each LINK/ACT LED indicates the status of the standard network port of the server.  
While power is supplied to the server and HUB and the connection is correct, the LED is  
on (green). The LED turns green and flashes while the network port is  
transmitting/receiving data.  
If the LED does not go on when the LINK state is placed, check if the network cable is in  
normal state and if it is connected correctly. If the LED does not go on yet when the  
network cable is normal, the network (LAN) controller may be faulty. In this case,  
contact your service representative.  
Speed LED  
This LED indicates whether each of the network ports normally equipped with the server  
is operated through the 1000BASE-T, 100BASE-TX or 10BASE-T network interface. If  
the LED is lit amber, the network port is operated through 1000BASE-T. If the LED is  
lit green, the network port is operated through 100BASE-TX. If the LED is off, the  
network port is operated through 10BASE-T.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-15  
AC POWER LED  
There is an AC POWER LED for the power supply unit on the rear. The LED turns green and  
flashes when the power supply unit receives AC power from the power cord, which is connected to  
the AC inlet.  
The LED turns green when the server power switch is turned on. If the LED does not go on when  
the server power switch is turned on or if it turns or blinks amber, the power supply unit is probably  
faulty. In this case, contact your service representative to replace the power supply unit.  
AC inlet  
Power supply  
Power supply  
slot 1  
slot 2  
AC POWER LED  
NOTE: If one power supply unit fails while an optional power supply  
is mounted, the system can continue operation with the other power  
supply unit. (Redundant function) The failing power supply unit can  
be replaced in hot swap mode (with the power on) without the system  
being stopped.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-16 General Description  
STANDARD FEATURES  
High performance  
Expandability  
IntelXeonProcessor  
Three full-length, full-height 64-bit/100  
MHz PCI-X riser slots and three low  
profile 64-bit/66 MHz riser slots  
Large memory of up to 16 GB  
Six hot-swap SCSI hard disk drive bays  
Up to two multi-processors are available  
for upgrade.  
(3.20DGHz / 3.20GHz / 3.40GHz /  
3.60GHz / 3.80GHz)  
High-speed network interface  
(1000Mbps/100Mbps/10Mbps supported)  
High-speed disk access  
(Ultra320 SCSI)  
High-speed memory access (DDR2-400)  
One backup file bay  
USB2.0 interface (A USB-support driver  
is required.)  
Two network ports  
High-reliability  
Many Available Features  
Memory monitoring feature (error  
correction/error detection)  
Graphic accelerator "ATI RADEON 7000"  
support  
CPU/memory degradation feature (logical  
isolation of a failed device)  
Memory chipkill feature  
Bus parity error detection  
Temperature detection  
Error notification  
El Torito Bootable CD-ROM (no  
emulation mode) format support  
POWER switch mask  
Software power-off  
Remote power-on feature  
AC-Link feature  
Internal fan monitoring feature  
Internal voltage monitoring feature  
Redundant power supply (hot-swap)  
Onboard RAID 0/1  
Auto-rebuild feature (hot-swappable)  
BIOS password feature  
Consoleless feature  
Self-diagnosis  
Power On Self-Test (POST)  
Test and Diagnosis (T&D)  
Mechanical security lock  
Remote Management Card  
Redundant fans (option)  
Management Utilities  
Easy and Fine Setup  
NEC ESMPRO  
NEC DianaScope  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER (system setup  
utility)  
Configuration Parameter Diskette Creator  
SETUP (BIOS setup utility)  
SCSISelect (SCSI device utility)  
Maintenance Features  
Off-line Maintenance Utility  
Memory dump feature using the DUMP  
switch  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-17  
Power Supplies  
The power supply consists of the power supply bay and one power supply module. A second power  
supply module can be purchased to provide a redundant, 1+1 system. With either configuration, the  
power supply provides 600 watts of power and is designed to minimize EMI.  
The power subsystem supports implementation of remote management features including remote  
enable that permits power to be activated from a variety of sources.  
Peripheral Bays  
Your server supports a variety of standard PC AT-compatible peripheral devices. The chassis  
includes these peripheral bays:  
An optional removable media front panel bay for mounting a half-height 3.5-inch  
peripheral device such as an optional tape drives  
Depending on your configuration, your server includes six hot-swap SCSI hard disk drive  
bays for mounting hard disk drives installed in easily removable drive carriers.  
NOTE: The hot-swap SCSI hard disk drive bays contain a hot-swap  
back plane that require an 80-pin single connector attachment (SCA)  
connector on the drives that you install.  
The CD/FD bay includes the standard CD-ROM/FDD module.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-18 General Description  
SAF-TE LOGIC  
NOTE: SAF-TE Logic is in systems that include the hot-swap SCSI  
disk drive cage. SAF-TE Logic is not available in systems that  
include the standard SCSI disk drive cage.  
The SCSI backplane includes SAF-TE (SCSI Accessed Fault Tolerant Enclosure) logic that provides  
an interface to the disk subsystem that supports status signals, hot swapping drives, and enclosure  
monitoring.  
The transport mechanism for the standardized alert detection and status reporting is the SCSI bus.  
Disk drives, power supplies, cooling fans, and temperature are continually monitored and the  
conditions then reported over the SCSI bus to the system. When used with RAID management  
software the user can be alerted of impending or imminent disk conditions requiring attention.  
This allows the user to react to conditions that could normally go unnoticed until data loss.  
SYSTEM BOARD FEATURES  
The following subsections describe the system board major components.  
Processor  
The system board accommodates one or two IntelXeonprocessors with 1MB cache in the  
INT3/FCPGA socket package. This processor uses the .13 micron technology and offers advanced  
performance. The processor external interface operates at a maximum of 800 MHz.  
Memory  
The system board contains six 240-pin DIMM slots each supporting 72-bit ECC (64-bit main  
memory plus ECC) registered SDRAM DIMMs (DDR2 400 compatible). Memory is two-way  
interleaved and partitioned in three groups. You may install a minimum of 1GB (512MB × 2) and as  
much as 16 GB.  
The controller automatically detects, sizes, and initializes the memory array, depending on the type,  
size, and speed of the installed DIMMs, and reports memory size and allocation to the server via  
configuration registers.  
NOTE: Use DIMMs that have been tested for compatibility with the  
server board.  
Contact your service representative or dealer for a current list of  
approved memory modules.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-19  
PCI Riser Slots  
The mother board has two PCI riser slots. Riser slot B provides the following features:  
Bus speed up to 100 MHz  
184 pin, 5 volt keyed, 64-bit expansion slot connector  
Support for a 3-slot PCI riser card  
Support for both full length and low profile PCI cards  
Riser C provides the following features:  
Bus speed up to 66 MHz  
184 pin, 5 volt keyed, 64-bit expansion slot connector  
Support for a 3-slot PCI riser card  
Support for only low profile PCI cards  
Video  
The mother board uses an ATI RADEON 7000 PCI graphics accelerator with 8 MB of video  
SDRAM. The embedded SVGA video subsystem supports:  
Resolutions up to 1600 x 1200 under 2D and 1024 x 768 under 3D  
CRT and LCD monitors up to 100 Hz vertical refresh rate  
The mother board supports disabling of the onboard video through the BIOS setup menu or when a  
plug in video card is installed in any of the PCI slots.  
SCSI Controller  
The SCSI version of the server board includes an embedded Adaptec AIC-7902 controller providing  
dual Ultra320 Low Voltage Differential (LVD) SCSI channels.  
The SCSI bus is terminated on the server board with active terminators that cannot be disabled. The  
onboard device must always be at one end of the bus. The device at the other end of the cable must  
also be terminated. LVD devices generally do not have termination built-in and need to have a  
termination source provided. Non-LVDs devices generally are terminated through a jumper or  
resistor pack on the device itself.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-20 General Description  
Network Controller  
NOTE: To ensure EMC product regulation compliance, the system  
must be used with a shielded LAN cable.  
The mother board uses a dual-channel Ethernet Controller and supports 10Base-T/100Base-  
TX/1000Base-T network subsystems.  
The network controller supports the following features:  
64-bit, 100 MHz PCI-X interface  
Integrated IEEE 802.3 10Base-T, 100Base-TX, and 1000Base-T compatible PHY  
IEEE 820.3u auto-negotiation support  
Chained memory structure similar to the 82559, 82558, 82557 and 82596  
Full duplex support at both 10 Mbps, 100 Mbps, and 1000 Mbps operation  
Low power +3.3 V device  
On the system board, NIC 1 can be used as both a network interface and server management  
interface.  
Keyboard and Mouse  
The keyboard/mouse controller is PS/2-compatible. A Y-cable can be used if both a PS/2 mouse and  
keyboard are required at the same time.  
ACPI  
The mother board supports the Advanced Configuration and Power Interface (ACPI) as defined by  
the ACPI 2.0 specifications. An ACPI aware operating system can put the system into a state where  
the hard drives spin down, the system fans stop, and all processing is halted. However, the power  
supply will still be on and the processors will still be dissipating some power, so the power supply  
fans will still run.  
The system board supports sleep states s0, s1, s4, and s5:  
s0: Normal running state.  
s1: Processor sleep state. No context will be lost in this state and the processor caches will  
maintain coherency.  
s4: Hibernate or Save to Disk: The memory and machine state are saved to disk. Pressing  
the power button or other wakeup event will restore the system state from the disk and  
resume normal operation. This assumes that no hardware changes have been made to the  
system while it was off.  
s5: Soft off: Only the RTC section of the CSB and the BMC are running in this state. No  
context is saved by the OS or hardware.  
IMPORTANT: The system is off only when the AC power cord is  
disconnected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-21  
Remote Management Card (RMC)  
Server management is concentrated in the Remote Management Card (RMC). The RMC and  
associated circuitry are powered from a 5Vdc standby voltage, which remains active when system  
power is switched off, but the ac power source is still on and connected.  
The RMC supports the NEC DianaScope, which allows remote server management through  
networks. Events monitored by the manager system include over-temperature and over-voltage  
conditions, fan failure, or chassis intrusion.  
Information on NEC DianaScope may be found in the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM.  
One major function of the RMC is to autonomously monitor system management events, and log  
their occurrence in the nonvolatile System Event Log (SEL). The events being monitored include  
overtemperature and overvoltage conditions, fan failure, or chassis intrusion. To enable accurate  
monitoring, the RMC maintains the nonvolatile Sensor Data Records (SDRs), from which sensor  
information can be retrieved. The RMC provides an ISA host interface to SCR sensor information,  
so that software running on the server can poll and retrieve the server's current status.  
The RMC performs the following:  
Monitors server board temperature and voltage*  
Monitors processor presence and controls Fault Resilient Boot (FRB)  
Detects and indicates baseboard fan failure*  
Manages the SEL interface  
Manages the SDR Repository interface  
Monitors the SDR/SEL timestamp clock  
Monitors the system management watchdog timer  
Monitors the periodic SMI timer  
Monitors the event receiver  
Controls secure mode, including video blanking, diskette write-protect monitoring, and  
front panel lock/unlock initiation  
Controls Wake On LAN via Magic Packet support.  
*Also, NEC ESMPRO supports these features.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-22 General Description  
DEGRADATION FEATURE  
The degradation feature automatically isolates a failed DIMM or processor to assure continuous  
operation of the server when the POST (Power On Self-Test, self-diagnosis program after power on)  
detects such a DIMM or processor.  
NOTE: The degradation feature is only available when at least two  
DIMMs or processors are installed.  
Failed DIMMs and processors may be identified on the screen that the POST displays, or with the  
BIOS setup utility of the server, "SETUP." They may also be identified on the system that has the  
NEC ESMPRO installed.  
REMOTE POWER-ON FEATURE (WAKE ON LAN)  
The remote power-on function turns on the server through a network. It sends a special packet  
from the management computer to a remote server to turn it on if the server is off-powered.  
To enable this feature, use the BIOS setup utility, "SETUP." (See Chapter 4.)  
The remote power-on feature is not available in the following cases. Press the POWER switch  
once to start the OS, and turn off the server in an appropriate procedure.  
Abnormal previous system shut-down  
No power supply to the server (due to turned-off breaker, disconnected power cord, power  
blackout, etc.)  
AC-LINK FEATURE  
When the power cord of the server is connected to an uninterruptible power supply (UPS) unit, the  
server supports the power linkage feature that enables control over the power supply from the UPS  
to the server. The AC-Link feature can be enabled or disabled with the Server menu of the BIOS  
setup utility, "SETUP." (See Chapter 4.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-23  
SYSTEM SECURITY  
To help prevent unauthorized entry or use of the system, the system includes a full lockable front  
bezel and Server Management software that monitors the front bezel intrusion switch.  
Security with Mechanical Locks and Monitoring  
To unlock the bezel, insert the key in the lock and turn the lock counterclockwise until it stops  
(about a quarter turn). The bezel is now unlocked and can be opened again.  
To lock the bezel, insert the key in the lock. Turn the lock clockwise until it stops (about a quarter  
turn). The bezel is now locked and cannot be opened.  
Software Locks via the BIOS Setup Utility  
The BIOS Setup Utility provides a number of security features to prevent unauthorized or accidental  
access to the system. Once the security measures are enabled, you can access the system only after  
you enter the correct password(s). For example:  
Enable the keyboard lockout timer so that the server requires a password to reactivate the  
keyboard and mouse after a specified time out period – 1 to 120 minutes.  
Set and enable a supervisor password.  
Set and enable a user password.  
Set secure mode to prevent keyboard or mouse input and to prevent use of the front panel  
reset and power switches.  
Activate a hot key combination to enter secure mode quickly.  
Disable writing to the diskette drive when secure mode is set.  
Disable access to the boot sector of the operating system hard disk drive.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-24 General Description  
Using Passwords  
You can set either the user password, the supervisor password, or both passwords. If only the user  
password is set, you:  
Must enter the user password to enter BIOS Setup.  
Must enter the user password to boot the server if Password on Boot is enabled in the  
BIOS Setup.  
Must enter the user password to exit secure mode.  
If only the supervisor password is set, you:  
Must enter the supervisor password to enter BIOS Setup.  
Must enter the supervisor password to boot the server if Password on Boot is enabled in  
the BIOS Setup.  
Must enter the supervisor password to exit secure mode.  
If both passwords are set, you:  
May enter the user password to enter BIOS Setup. However, you will not be able to  
change many of the options.  
Must enter the supervisor password if you want to enter BIOS Setup and have access to all  
of the options.  
May enter either password to boot the server if Password on Boot is enabled in either the  
BIOS Setup.  
May enter either password to exit secure mode.  
Secure Mode  
Configure and enable the secure boot mode by using the BIOS Setup. When secure mode is in  
effect:  
You can boot the server and the operating system will run, but you must enter the user  
password to use the keyboard or mouse.  
You cannot turn off system power or reset the server from the front panel switches.  
Secure mode has no effect on functions enabled via remote server management or power control via  
the watchdog timer.  
Taking the server out of secure mode does not change the state of system power. That is, if you  
press and release the power switch while secure mode is in effect, the system will not be powered  
off when secure mode is later removed. However, if the front panel power switch remains depressed  
when secure mode is removed, the server will be powered off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-25  
Summary of Software Security Features  
The table below lists the software security features and describes what protection each offers. In  
general, to enable or set the features listed here, you must run the BIOS Setup and go to the Security  
Subsystem Group, menu. The table also refers to the Setup utility.  
Software Security Features  
Feature  
Description  
Secure mode  
How to enter secure mode:  
Setting and enabling passwords automatically places the system in  
secure mode.  
If you set a hot-key combination (through Setup), you can secure the  
system simply by pressing the key combination. This means you do not  
have to wait for the inactivity time-out period.  
When the system is in secure mode:  
The server can boot and run the operating system, but mouse and  
keyboard input is not accepted until the user password is entered.  
At boot time, if a CD is detected in the CD-ROM drive or a diskette in drive  
A, the system prompts for a password. When the password is entered, the  
server boots from CD or diskette and disables the secure mode.  
If there is no CD in the CD-ROM drive or diskette in drive A, the server  
boots from drive C and automatically goes into secure mode. All enabled  
secure mode features go into effect at boot time.  
To leave secure mode: Enter the correct password(s).  
Disable writing to  
diskette  
In secure mode, the server will not boot from or write to a diskette unless a  
password is entered.  
To write protect access to diskette whether the server is in secure mode or  
not, use the Setup main menu, Floppy Options, and specify Floppy Access  
as read only.  
Set a time out period Specify and enable an inactivity time out period of from 1 to 120 minutes.  
so that keyboard  
and mouse input are  
not accepted.  
If no keyboard or mouse action occurs for the specified period, attempted  
keyboard and mouse input will not be accepted.  
The monitor display will go blank, and the diskette drive will be write  
protected (if these security features are enabled through Setup).  
Also, screen can be  
blanked, and writes  
to diskette can be  
To resume activity: Enter the correct password(s).  
inhibited  
Control access to  
using the BIOS  
Setup: set  
To control access to setting or changing the system configuration, set a  
supervisor password and enable it through Setup.  
If both the supervisor and user passwords are enabled, either can be used  
to boot the server or enable the keyboard and/or mouse, but only the  
supervisor password will allow Setup to be changed.  
supervisor password  
To disable a password, change it to a blank entry in the Change Password  
menu of the Supervisor Password Option menu found in the Security  
Subsystem Group.  
To clear the password if you cannot access Setup, change the Clear  
Password jumper (see Chapter 4).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-26 General Description  
Feature  
Description  
Control access to  
the system other  
than BIOS Setup:  
set user password  
To control access to using the system, set a user password and enable it  
through Setup.  
To disable a password, change it to a blank entry in the Change Password  
menu of the User Password Option menu found in the Security Subsystem  
Group.  
To clear the password if you cannot access Setup, change the Clear  
Password jumper (see Chapter 4).  
Boot without  
keyboard  
The system can boot with or without a keyboard. During POST, before the  
system completes the boot sequence, the BIOS automatically detects and  
tests the keyboard if it is present and displays a message.  
Specify the boot  
sequence  
The sequence that you specify in setup will determine the boot order. If  
secure mode is enabled (a user password is set), then you will be  
prompted for a password before the server fully boots. If secure mode is  
enabled and the “Secure Boot Mode” option is also enabled, the server will  
fully boot but will require a password before accepting any keyboard or  
mouse input.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-27  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
The CD-ROM that comes with the server contains a setup utility called "NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER."  
The major functions of the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER are:  
To install the Operating System.  
"Express Setup" helps you to install the Windows Operating System. (See Chapter 5)  
To diagnose the system.  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER includes the System Diagnostics to check your server. (See  
Chapter 6)  
To create a support disk.  
Use this function to create the support disks used to boot the utilities from the floppy disk,  
or the OEM floppy disk used for a manual installation of Windows. (See Chapter 6)  
To update the BIOS.  
Use this function to update the system BIOS or firmware of the server. (See Chapter 6)  
To update the Windows System*  
"Update Express5800 system" in Master Control Menu(Windows-based NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER feature) updates the several resources of Microsoft Windows Server  
2003, Microsoft Windows 2000. (See Chapter 6)  
To install the utilities.  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER includes some management software for Windows (NEC  
ESMPRO, NEC DianaScope and so on) and maintenance utilities for DOS (System  
diagnostics, Off-line Maintenance Utility and so on).  
You can install the applications for Windows from Master Control Menu and install the  
utilities for DOS from Tools menu. (See Chapter 6)  
To read the online documents*  
You can refer to the online documents from Master Control Menu. (See Chapter 6)  
* These functions are available under the Windows system.  
NOTE: Some features among those listed above can be used from the  
remote computer via cross cable (COM), or LAN. See Chapter 6 for  
details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-28 General Description  
NEC ESMPRO  
The NEC ESMPRO is server management software that runs on the OS. The NEC ESMPRO  
includes the NEC ESMPRO Manager for the server monitoring terminal and the NEC ESMPRO  
Agent for the server.  
NOTE: For details of major functions of the NEC ESMPRO, system  
configuration and setups with the NEC ESMPRO, see Chapter 6.  
Available functions of the NEC ESMPRO depend on the OS you install.  
Ask your service representative for details.  
OFF-LINE MAINTENANCE UTILITY  
The Off-line Maintenance Utility is used for maintenance and fault analysis of the server. This  
utility is usually used by the service representative.  
Refer to Chapter 8 for details.  
SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC UTILITY  
The system diagnostic utility contained in the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER is useful to detect  
hardware failures. See Chapter 7 for details.  
NEC DianaScope  
The NEC DianaScope is a software for the remote management of the NEC Express5800 series.  
The NEC DianaScope can control the managed server even if OS is not running on the managed  
server.  
See Chapter 6 and online document in the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-29  
USING YOUR SERVER  
This section describes basic operations of the server including how to use devices such as the floppy  
disk drive and the CD-ROM drive. See Appendix B for notes on using the floppy disk, CD-ROM,  
and accessories including the keyboard and the mouse.  
Front Bezel  
Remove the front bezel to power on/off the server, to access the floppy disk drive, CD-ROM drive,  
and a removable media device, and to install/remove hard disk drives to the 3.5-inch disk bays.  
IMPORTANT:  
To open the front door, you must unlock the door with the provided  
security key.  
Pay attention not to press the POWER switch when you install or  
remove the front bezel.  
Installing or Removing the Front Bezel  
When turning the power of the server on/off, accessing to the floppy disk drive, CD-ROM drive, or  
a removable media device, or installing or removing a hard disk drive on or from the 3.5-inch disk  
bay, first remove the front bezel.  
IMPORTANT: The front bezel can be opened only when you unlock  
it by using the attached security key.  
1. Insert the attached security key into the key slot and turn the key to the front bezel side  
with it pressed lightly to release the lock.  
Unlock  
Lock  
2. Hold the right end of the front bezel lightly to pull it toward you.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-30 General Description  
3. Slide the front bezel to the left a little to remove the tab from the frame and then remove  
the front bezel from the server.  
To install the front bezel, latch the tab at the left side of the front bezel on the server frame.  
After the installation, lock the front bezel by using the key for security.  
Frame  
Tab  
1
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-31  
POWER Switch  
Use the POWER switch to turn on/off the server.  
Power On  
Press the POWER switch on the front of the computer chassis.  
The POWER LED lights in green.  
POWER  
switch  
POWER LED  
IMPORTANT:  
If the power cord is connected to a power control device such as a  
UPS (Uninterruptive Power Supply), make sure that the power  
control device is powered.  
The server management logic on your system board monitors and  
logs system voltage changes. When plugging the power cord to  
the system, you may experience 10 seconds delay from the time you  
press the POWER switch on the front panel. This is normal  
system operation and is required by the server management logic.  
Always allow POST to complete before powering down your  
system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-32 General Description  
POST  
POST (Power On Self-Test) is the self-diagnostic program stored in the system memory.  
When you power on the server, the system automatically runs POST to check the mother board,  
ECC memory module, CPU module, keyboard, and mouse. POST also displays messages of the  
BIOS setup utility, such as the start-up message, while in progress.  
With the factory setup of the server, the NEC logo appears on the display unit while POST is in  
progress. (To display the POST check results, press Esc.)  
NOTE: You can set the POST check results to appear on the display  
unit without pressing Esc. To do so, select "Enabled" for "Boot-time  
Diag Screen" under the Advanced menu of the BIOS SETUP utility.  
The POST check results should be checked in the following cases.  
When the server is used for the first time.  
When the server appears to fail.  
When the server beeps for many times between power-on and OS start-up.  
When an error message appears on the display unit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-33  
POST Execution Flow  
The following describes the progress of POST in the chronological order.  
IMPORTANT:  
Do not make key entries or perform mouse operations while POST  
is in progress.  
Some system configurations may display the message "Press Any  
Key" to prompt a key entry. This message is driven by BIOS of an  
installed optional board. Make sure to read the manual that comes  
with the optional board before any key entry.  
Powering on the server, after you installed or removed an optional  
PCI board or moved it to another slot, may display the message that  
indicates incorrect board configuration and suspend POST.  
In such a case, press F1 to continue POST. Board configuration  
can be made using the utility described later.  
1. After a few seconds from power-on, POST starts checking the memory. The count  
message of the basic and expansion memory appears at top left on the display unit screen.  
The memory check may takes a few minutes to complete depending on the memory size  
of the server. Also, it may take approximately one minute for the screen display to  
appear after rebooting the server.  
2. Some messages appear upon completion of the memory check. These messages appear  
to indicate that the system has detected the CPU, keyboard, and mouse.  
3. POST then detects the internal SCSI controller and display the message prompting you to  
launch the SCSI device utility. (Ignore the message. POST will automatically proceed  
a few seconds later.)  
Press <Ctrl> <A> for SCSISelect(TM) Utility!  
To launch the SCSI device utility, press Ctrl and A. See Chapter 4 for setup and  
parameters.  
You need to use the SCSI device utility in the following cases:  
– When new SCSI device is installed in a backup device bay.  
– When an external SCSI device connection is changed.  
– When the internal SCSI device connection is changed.  
– When the internal hard disk drives are configured with HostRAID.  
The server automatically restarts POST all over again when you exit the SCSI device  
utility.  
If the system drive is to be connected to a RAID controller, connect it to the PCI slot that  
has a highest boot priority than the PCI slots connected with the other RAID controller.  
Refer to "PCI Board" in chapter 9 for the boot order for the RAID controller.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-34 General Description  
4. POST displays SCSI ID numbers used by the connected SCSI devices on the screen.  
5. After a few seconds, POST displays the following message prompting you to launch the  
BIOS setup utility, SETUP, stored in the system memory of the server. This message  
appears at bottom left on the screen.  
Press <F2> to enter SETUP  
Launch the BIOS setup utility when you need to change the settings to meet the  
requirements for the server. As long as the above message is not displayed with an error  
message, you don't have to launch the utility. (Ignore the message. POST will  
automatically proceed.)  
To launch the SETUP utility, press F2 while the above message is displayed. See  
Chapter 4 for setup and parameters.  
The server automatically restarts POST all over again when you exit the SETUP utility.  
6. If the server has an optional RAID controller installed, POST displays the message  
prompting you to launch the RAID configuration utility and the RAID BIOS setup utility.  
Refer to the manual supplied with the RAID controller for detail instructions.  
POST will automatically proceed a few seconds later.  
7. If you set a password using the BIOS setup utility, SETUP, the password entry screen  
appears upon successful completion of POST.  
Up to three password entries will be accepted. Three incorrect password entries disable  
the server to boot. In such a case, turn off the power and wait about ten seconds before  
turning on to boot the server.  
IMPORTANT: Do not set a password before installing an OS.  
8. The OS starts when POST completes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-35  
POST Error Messages  
When POST detects an error, it displays an error message on the display unit screen. See Chapter  
8 for POST error codes.  
IMPORTANT: Take a note on the messages displayed before  
consulting with your service representative. Alarm messages are  
useful information for maintenance.  
Power Off  
Follow the procedure below to power off the server. If the power cord of the server is connected to  
a UPS, refer to the manual that comes with the UPS or the manual for the application that controls  
the UPS.  
IMPORTANT: Always allow POST to complete before turning off  
the server.  
1. Shut down the OS.  
2. Press the POWER switch on the front of the server.  
The POWER LED goes off.  
3. Power off peripheral devices.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-36 General Description  
Identification of Servers (UID Switch)  
An "UID (Unit ID) LED" is provided on the front panel and rear panel. If more than one server is  
mounted in a single rack, the LED identifies the server you are going to maintain.  
The UID LED goes on when the UID (Unit ID) switch on the front panel is pressed. It goes off  
when the switch is pressed again.  
Maintenance from the rear of the rack has to be carried out in a dark, narrow space. The interface  
cable of a server or power supply unit in normal state may be disconnected by accident in this  
situation. To prevent this problem, you should start maintenance after confirming the target server  
by using the UID switch.  
UID LED  
UID  
switch  
FRONT  
REAR  
UID LED  
UID switch  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-37  
Floppy Disk Drive  
The server is provided with the 3.5-inch floppy disk drive on its front to write/read data to/from a  
floppy disk.  
The server supports the following 3.5-inch floppy disks:  
2HD floppy disk (double-sided high-density track type)  
Stores data of 1.44MB.  
2DD floppy disk (double-sided double-density track type)  
Store data of 720KB.  
Make sure that the server is powered (the POWER LED is lit) before inserting a floppy disk into the  
floppy disk drive.  
When you completely insert the floppy disk into the floppy disk drive, the drive clicks and the eject  
button on the floppy disk is slightly pushed out.  
NOTES:  
When an unformatted floppy disk is inserted, the message notifying  
that date read is not available and the message prompting formatting  
are displayed. Refer to the manual that comes with the OS to  
format the floppy disk.  
If the floppy disk contains a system, powering on or restarting the  
server with the floppy disk inserted boots the system from the  
floppy disk.  
To eject the floppy disk from the floppy disk drive, press the eject button.  
NOTE: Make sure that the floppy disk access LED is unlit before  
ejecting the floppy disk. Ejecting the disk when the access LED is lit  
may destroy the disk data.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-38 General Description  
NOTE: Use of the floppy disk  
The floppy disk is an important data storage media with delicate  
structure and requires care. Keep the following notes in mind to use  
it:  
Insert the floppy disk into the floppy disk drive gently as far as it  
goes.  
Attach the label to the correct position.  
Do not write anything directly onto the disk surface with a pencil or  
ball-point pen.  
Do not open the shutter.  
Do not use the floppy disk in a dusty place.  
Do not place anything on the floppy disk.  
Do not leave the floppy disk in a high-temperature place (e.g., place  
exposed to direct sunlight or close to a heater).  
Keep the floppy disk away from cigarette smoke.  
Keep the floppy disk away from any liquid (e.g., water) and  
chemicals.  
Keep the floppy disk away from any magnetic objects (e.g.,  
magnet).  
Do not pinch the floppy disk with a paper clip or drop it.  
Keep the floppy disk in a floppy disk case that protects it from  
magnetism and dust.  
A floppy disk has a write-protect switch that prevents the stored data  
from accidental erasure. You can read data from a write-protected  
floppy disk, but you cannot save data into the floppy disk or format  
it. NEC recommends that you should write-protect any floppy disk  
containing valuable data unless you are about to save data. To  
write-protect a 3.5-inch floppy disk, use the write-protect switch  
provided on its back.  
Write-protect switch  
Write  
Write  
disable enable  
The floppy disk is a very delicate storage media. Dust or thermal  
changes, as well as operator's misconduct or sever failures, may  
cause loss of data. To avoid loss of data, NEC recommends that  
you should make a back-up copy of your valuable data on a regular  
basis. (Make sure to make a back-up copy of every floppy disk  
provided with the server.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-39  
CD-ROM Drive  
The server is provided with the CD-ROM drive on its front to read data from a CD-ROM (read-only  
compact disk). The CD-ROM provides larger and faster data read than the floppy disk.  
CAUTION  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may cause a fire, personal injury, or property damage. See  
pages 1-3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not leave the tray ejected from the CD-ROM drive.  
Set a CD-ROM on the CD-ROM drive in the following procedure.  
1. Confirm that the power of the server is on (with the POWER LED being lit in green)  
before setting the CD-ROM on the CD-ROM drive.  
2. Press the Eject button on the front of the CD-ROM drive.  
The tray comes out a little.  
3. Hold the tray lightly and pull it out toward you until the tray stops.  
4. Put the CD-ROM on the tray carefully and securely with the character printed surface  
facing upward.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-40 General Description  
5. As shown in the figure below, hold the tray with a hand and press the CD-ROM with  
fingers of another hand to make the hole of the CD-ROM fit to the rotor at the center of  
the tray.  
Rotor  
Press this part of CD-ROM.  
6. Push the front of the tray lightly to retract it into the drive.  
IMPORTANT: If a noisy sound in driving the CD-ROM drive occurs  
after setting a CD-ROM, set it again correctly.  
To take out the CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive, press the Eject button in the similar way in  
setting the CD-ROM to make the tray go out.  
If the access LED is lit in orange, the CD is being accessed. Confirm that the access LED is not lit  
before pressing the Eject button.  
As shown in the figure below, hold the tray with a hand and take the end of the CD-ROM lightly by  
the fingers of another hand with the suppression of the rotor at the center of the tray to remove the  
CD-ROM from the tray.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Description 2-41  
After taking out the CD-ROM, return the tray into the drive.  
When you fail to eject the CD-ROM tray with the Eject button and take out the CD-ROM from the  
server, follow the procedure below.  
Emergency hole  
1. Press the POWER switch to power off the server. (The POWER LED goes off.)  
2. Insert a metal pin of approximately 1.2 mm in diameter and 100 mm in length (a  
straightened large paper clip will make a substitute) into the emergency hole on the right  
front of the CD-ROM drive and gently push it in until the tray is ejected.  
IMPORTANT:  
Do not use a toothpick or plastic stick that is easy to break.  
If the above procedure does not let you take out the CD-ROM,  
contact your service representative.  
3. Hold the tray and pull it out.  
4. Take out the CD-ROM.  
5. Push the tray back into position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-42 General Description  
NOTE: Use of the CD-ROM  
Keep the following notes in mind to use the CD-ROM for the server:  
For the disk which does not conform to the CD standard, the  
playback of such a disk with the CD drive is not guaranteed.  
Do not drop the CD-ROM.  
Do not place anything on the CD-ROM or bend the CD-ROM.  
Do not attach any label onto the CD-ROM.  
Do not touch the signal side (nothing is printed on this side) with  
your hand.  
Place the CD-ROM with its printed side upward and gently put it on  
the tray.  
Do not scratch the CD-ROM or write anything directly on it with a  
pencil or ball-point pen.  
Keep the CD-ROM away from cigarette smoke.  
Do not leave the CD-ROM in a high-temperature place (e.g., place  
exposed to direct sunlight or close to a heater).  
When dust or fingerprints are attached on the CD-ROM, wipe the  
CD-ROM from its center to edge with a dry soft cloth slowly and  
gently.  
Use the CD cleaner to clean the CD-ROM. Do not use record  
spray/cleaner, benzene, or thinner.  
Keep the CD-ROM in a CD-ROM case when not in use.  
If the CD-ROM emits large noise in the CD-ROM drive, remove the  
CD-ROM and insert it back again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 3  
Setting Up Your Server  
This chapter describes how to set up the server appropriate for your system, on a step-by-step basis.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-2 Setting Up Your Server  
SETUP FLOW  
Follow the flowchart below to set up the server.  
Selecting the server site  
Select a suitable site for the server. Assemble the 19-inch rack assembly.  
Unpacking the system  
Unpack the server and accessories from the chipping carton box.  
Installing the server  
Install the server into the rack assembly.  
Connecting peripheral devices  
Connect peripheral devices to the server.  
Connecting the power cord  
Connect the power cord to the server.  
Turning on the server  
Power on the server to start software setups. Setups depend on the optional internal  
devices installed and the peripheral devices connected.  
Installing the operating system  
Install an operating system to the server. See Chapter 5.  
Installing the utilities  
Install the utilities in the provided NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM.  
See Chapter 6.  
Making backup copies of system information  
After all the system setup procedures are completed, make backup copies of system  
information.  
System information is required for recovering the server from the trouble or after  
replacing the system board.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up Your Server 3-3  
SELECTING SERVER SITE  
To use the server, install it on a standard EIA 19-inch rack assembly.  
Refer to the documentation attached to the rack or contact your service representative for the  
installation of the server on the rack.  
WARNING  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may result in death or serious personal injury. See pages 1-  
3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not use the server in any unapproved place.  
Do not connect the ground line to a gas pipe.  
CAUTION  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may cause a fire, personal injury, or property damage. See  
pages 1-3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not carry or install the server only by a single person.  
Do not install the server where the load may be concentrated on a specific  
point.  
Do not install any component on the server only by a single person.  
Do not pull out a device from the rack if the rack is unstable.  
Do not leave more than one device being pulled out from the rack.  
Do not provide the wiring exceeding the rating power.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-4 Setting Up Your Server  
Do not install the rack in the places listed below. Installing the rack or mounting the server on the  
rack in such a place may cause some malfunction to occur.  
Narrow space from which devices cannot be pulled out from the rack completely  
Place that cannot bear the total weights of the rack and devices mounted on the rack  
Place where stabilizers cannot be installed or where the rack can be installed only after the  
practice of proper earthquake-resistant construction  
Place of uneven or slanting floor  
Place of drastic temperature change (near a heater, air conditioner, or refrigerator)  
Place where intense vibration may be generated  
Place where corrosive gas is generated, chemicals are nearby, or chemicals may be  
accidentally sprayed over  
Place where a carpet not subject to anti-static process is laid.  
Place where some objects may be fallen on the rack  
Place near a device generating intense magnetic field (such as a TV, radio,  
broadcast/communication antenna, power transmission wire, and electromagnetic crane) is  
placed (If unavoidable, contact your service representative to request proper shield  
construction.)  
Place where the power cord of the server must be connected to an AC outlet that shares  
the outlet of another device with large power consumption.  
Place near equipment that generates power noise (e.g., contact spark at power-on/power-  
off of commercial power supply through a relay). If you must install the server close to  
such equipment, request your service representative for separate power cabling or noise  
filter installation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up Your Server 3-5  
UNPACKING THE SYSTEM  
When you receive your system, inspect the shipping containers prior to unpacking. If the shipping  
boxes are damaged, note the damage, and if possible, photograph it for reference. After removing  
the contents of the containers, keep the cartons and the packing materials. If the contents appear  
damaged when you unpack the boxes, file a damage claim with the carrier immediately.  
INSTALLING THE SERVER  
This subsection provides the instructions for the rack-mount server unit into a standard EIA 19-inch  
rack cabinet.  
Also this subsection describes the removal procedures for the rack-mount server unit from the 19-  
inch rack cabinet.  
WARNING  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may result in death or serious personal injury. See pages 1-  
3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not use any rack which does not conform to the relevant standard.  
Disconnect the power cord(s) before installing or removing the server.  
CAUTION  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may cause a fire, personal injury, or property damage. See  
pages 1-3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not leave more than one device being pulled out from the rack.  
Do not lift the server only by a single person.  
Always install the server in the specified place.  
Do not install the server on the rack leaving the cover removed.  
Do not pinch your finger with mechanical components.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-6 Setting Up Your Server  
Restricted Access Location  
The server is intended for installation in a restricted access location, mounted above a non-  
combustible material.  
ESD Precaution  
An electrostatic discharge (ESD) can damage disk drives, option boards, and other components. You  
can provide some ESD protection by wearing an antistatic wrist strap attached to chassis ground  
when handling system components.  
Electronic devices can be easily damaged by static electricity. To prevent damage, keep them in  
their protective packaging when they are not installed in your system.  
Checking Components  
Confirm that the following tools or components are provided to install the server on the rack.  
M5 screw  
M5 core nut  
Required Tools  
You may only prepare a Phillips screwdriver to install the server on the rack.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up Your Server 3-7  
Installation Procedure for NEC Rack/Third Vendor's Rack  
This server can be installed in either the NEC rack or a third vendor's rack. Take the following  
procedure to install the server in the rack:  
IMPORTANT: When installing the optional cable arm, see the  
instruction manual provided with the cable arm.  
Preparation before Installation  
The slide rail is fixed with the screw to prevent from falling off during transportation. Remove the  
left and right core nuts from the front of the server before you install the server in the rack.  
Set screw  
Core nut  
Hold the core nut, and rotate the set screw to remove the core nut.  
Keep the removed core nuts for future use.  
Removing the Rail Assemblies  
Remove the sliding rails from the server.  
Hold the rails and slowly slides them toward the rear of the server until a "click" is heard. The  
click indicates that the rails are locked.  
Push the release levers on the right and left sides of the server, and remove the rail assemblies from  
the server while unlocking.  
Release lever  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-8 Setting Up Your Server  
Only the inner rails remain screwed to the server when the rail assemblies have been removed.  
Inner rails  
IMPORTANT: The removed rail assemblies are to be installed on the  
inner rails later. To install each rail assembly on the correct inner rail,  
make a mark on the assemblies. Similarly, when installing more than  
one server, distinguish between the pairs of inner rails and rail  
assemblies of the servers by making marks.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up Your Server 3-9  
Installing the Core Nuts  
Install three core nuts on the front of the rack for each of the right and left sides and also two core  
nuts on the rear of the rack for each of the right and left sides.  
Install three core nuts in 1U (the minimum unit of rack height). Three slots (angle holes) are  
opened per 1U of a rack. Install the core nuts at the three slots. (For any NEC rack, round marks  
are put in the unit of 1U.) For two core nuts installed on the front of the rack, the upper and lower  
nuts are used to fix the front of the rail assembly, and the center is used to support the set screw of  
the server. The core nuts installed on the rear of the rack are used to fix the rear of the rail  
assemblies.  
Hang either clip of a core nut on a square hole on the rack and insert another clip into the hole by  
using a tool such as a flat tip screwdriver.  
NOTE: Confirm that all the core nuts are installed at the level.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-10 Setting Up Your Server  
Installing the Rail Assemblies  
Make sure of the right side rail assembly or the left one when installing it. See the figure below.  
Front  
Rear  
Left side rail assembly  
Right side rail assembly  
1. Loosen a screw securing the rail assembly.  
Screws  
2. Align the front and rear frames of rail assembly to the location where the core nuts are  
installed.  
Locate the rail assembly so that the frame of the rack is located between core nuts and  
frames of rail assembly.  
NOTE: Confirm that the portion of the frame to fix the rail assembly is  
located in front of the rack frame.  
3. Firmly secure the rail assembly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up Your Server 3-11  
Installing the Server  
CAUTION  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may cause a fire, personal injury, or property damage. See  
pages 1-3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not lift the server only by a single person.  
Do not pinch your finger with mechanical components.  
1. Pull out the sliding rails of the right and left rail assemblies until they are locked.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-12 Setting Up Your Server  
2. At least two persons are required to install the server. Securely hold the server and  
install it in the rack.  
Firmly fit the inner rails on the sides of the server into the rail assemblies that are installed  
on the rack, and then slowly push the server into the rack.  
If the server is locked on its way into the rack, slowly push it in while pressing the release  
levers on the right and left sides of the server.  
When the server is installed for the first time, the mechanical parts are rather hard to slide.  
You may feel strong friction when pushing in the server. In this case, strongly push it in.  
Release lever  
3. Confirm that the sliding rails work normally by pulling the server out of the rack and  
pushing it in several times.  
NOTE: Confirm that the sliding rails work normally. If the sliding  
rails are stuck to the rack frame and do not come out, reinstall them.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up Your Server 3-13  
Securing the Server  
Captive thumb screws  
1. Push the server into the rack as far as it will go.  
2. Tighten the right and left captive thumb screws on the front panel to secure the server to  
the rack.  
3. Install the front bezel.  
This completes the installing of the server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-14 Setting Up Your Server  
Removing the Server from the Rack Assembly  
The server should be removed from the rack by at least two persons.  
WARNING  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may result in death or serious personal injury. See pages  
1-3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not lift the server only by a single person.  
Do not pinch your finger with mechanical components.  
Note high temperature.  
Do not pull out a device from the rack if the rack is unstable.  
Do not leave more than one device being pulled out from the rack.  
1. Release the security lock to remove the front bezel.  
Security lock  
2. Confirm that the power of the server is OFF, and disconnect the power cable and all the  
interface cables connected to the server.  
3. <This step is required only when the optional cable arm is mounted.>  
Remove the two screws securing the cable arm, and dismount the cable arm from the  
server.  
4. Loosen the two captive thumb screws.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up Your Server 3-15  
5. Hold the handle and pull out the server from the rack slowly and carefully.  
The server clicks to be latched.  
Captive thumb screws  
Handles  
6. Pull out the server from the rack with the right and left release lever pressed to release the  
latch.  
IMPORTANT:  
Pull out the server slowly holding the bottom of the server by at  
least two persons.  
Do not apply any load on the server pulled out from the rack.  
Doing so may cause personal injury if the server drops.  
To remove some mechanical parts of the rack, see the installation procedure.  
Release lever  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-16 Setting Up Your Server  
CONNECTING PERIPHERAL DEVICES  
Connect peripheral devices to the server. The server is provided with connectors for wide variety  
of peripheral devices on its front and rear. The figure on the next page illustrates available  
peripheral devices for the server in the standard configuration and locations of the connectors for the  
devices.  
CAUTION  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may cause a fire, personal injury, or property damage. See  
pages 1-3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not connect any interface cable with the power cord of the NEC Express  
Server plugged to a power source.  
Do not use any unauthorized interface cable.  
IMPORTANT:  
Power off the server and a peripheral device before connection.  
Connecting a powered peripheral device to the powered server will  
cause malfunctions and failures.  
To connect a third-party peripheral device or interface cable to the  
server, consult with your service representative for availability of  
such a device or cable. Some third-party devices may not be used  
for the server.  
The total length of a cable (including the connection cable in SCSI  
device) is limited by the SCSI standard. Ask your service  
representative for details.  
A leased line cannot be connected directly to the serial port  
connectors.  
Secure the power cord(s) and interface cables with a tie wrap.  
Form the cables in such a way that they will not come into contact  
with the door or the guide rails on the sides of the server.  
Form the power cord with a slight slack at the AC inlet of the server.  
This is to prevent the power cord from coming off when the server  
is pulled out from the rack.  
Do not apply any pressure to the plug of the power cord.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up Your Server 3-17  
Device with the serial interface  
(e.g., Management PC)*2  
B
FRONT  
Device with the  
serial interface*2  
Hub  
Mouse  
USB device *1  
(multiport repeater)  
Keyboard  
*3  
1
2
A
REAR  
Finally connect the provided  
power cord to the receptacle. *4  
If connecting the server to UPS,  
see the explanation below.  
USB device *1  
Device with the  
SCSI interface *5  
Display unit  
*1 Any USB keyboard and mouse are not supported.  
*2 A leased line cannot be connected directly to this connector.  
The console of a management PC can be connected to only serial port B. (BIOS setup required.)  
*3 Use the provided branch cable.  
*4 Connect the power cord to a circuit breaker of 15 A or less.  
*5 Used exclusively with onboard SCSI connector.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-18 Setting Up Your Server  
CONNECTING POWER CORD  
Connect the provided power cord to the server.  
WARNING  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may result in death or serious personal injury. See pages 1-  
3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not hold the power plug with a wet hand.  
Do not connect the ground wire to a gas pipe.  
CAUTION  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may cause a fire, personal injury, or property damage. See  
pages 1-3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not plug the power cord in to an improper power source.  
Do not connect the power cord to an outlet that has an illegal number of  
connections.  
Insert the power plug into the outlet as far as it goes.  
Use the authorized power cord only.  
1. Plug the provided power cord into the power receptacle on the rear of the server.  
2. Plug the other end of the power cord into the wall outlet.  
IMPORTANT: Secure the power cord with an AC cord holder that  
comes with your server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up Your Server 3-19  
To connect the power cord from the server to an uninterruptive power supply (UPS), use service  
outlets on the rear of the UPS.  
The UPS service outlets are categorized into two groups: SWITCH OUT and UN-SWITCH OUT.  
(They may be called "OUTPUT1" and "OUTPUT2".)  
To control power supply with an application (NEC ESMPRO/UPSController) that controls the UPS,  
connect the power cord to an SWITCH OUT outlet.  
For constant power supply, connect the power cord to a UN-SWITCH OUT outlet. (Connect the  
modem that is in service for 24 hours to this outlet.)  
<Example>  
2
OUTPUT  
OUTPUT(SWITCH OUT)  
(UNSWITCHOUT)  
AC100V 50/50HZ  
UN-SWITCH OUT  
(OUTPUT 2)  
SWITCH OUT  
(OUTPUT 1)  
When the power cord from the server to a UPS, change the BIOS setup of the server to link with  
power supply from the UPS.  
To power on the server from the UPS (Uninterruptible Power Supply), select [Server] - [AC-LINK]  
- [Power On].  
Change a parameter for "AC-LINK" under the Server menu of the BIOS SETUP utility. See  
Chapter 4 for details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-20 Setting Up Your Server  
TURNING ON THE SERVER  
Turn on the server and follow the on-screen instructions for setup.  
IMPORTANT: Before turning on the server:  
Some optional boards require setups with the SETUP utility before  
installation. If the server has a PCI board with the PCI-to-PCI  
bridge installed, the SETUP utility is enabled to launch. Check on  
the board specifications to find out whether it requires pre-  
installation setups before actually installing the board.  
Some installed optional devices or connected peripheral devices  
require setups before proceeding to the next step.  
To use the server with no optional devices installed besides the graphic  
board, install a desired OS to the server.  
1. Make sure all external devices, such as a video display, keyboard, and mouse (optional)  
have been connected, and the power cords are connected.  
2. Power on the video display and any other external devices.  
3. Make sure that the floppy disk drive contains no floppy disk and the CD-ROM drive  
contains no bootable CD-ROM.  
4. Open the front bezel.  
5. Press the POWER switch.  
NOTES:  
If the power cord is connected to the power control unit such as the  
UPS, turn on the power control unit.  
If a remote management card (RMC) is installed in your server,  
connect the power cord and wait a few seconds before pressing the  
POWER switch. The POWER switch does not work in a few  
seconds after connecting the power cord due to RMC firmware  
start-up.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up Your Server 3-21  
POWER  
switch  
POWER LED  
The POWER LED on the front of the server comes on.  
In a few seconds, the NEC logo appears on the screen and the Power On Self-Test (POST)  
begins.  
The POST runs automatically when you power on the server or reset it with a keyboard  
operation (Ctrl + Alt + Delete). The POST runs diagnostics, initializes the server, sets  
interrupt vectors, detects installed peripheral devices, and boots the operating system (if  
installed). See Chapter 2 for detailed description on POST.  
If the server halts before completing the POST, the POST emits a beep code indicating a  
fatal system error requiring immediate attention. (See Chapter 8, "Troubleshooting," for  
troubleshooting information.)  
During memory test, the POST displays the amount of memory it was able to access and  
test. Depending on the amount of installed memory, it may take several minutes to  
complete the memory test.  
NOTE: The factory-set is defined to hide the POST screen with the  
NEC logo screen. You can always change the NEC logo screen to the  
POST screen by pressing Esc. To change the start-up screen, use the  
BIOS setup utility, "SETUP." (See Chapter 4 for details.)  
During the POST, you will see the banner message to prompt you to launch the BIOS SETUP utility  
stored in ROM on system board or on an installed option board.  
Start the BIOS SETUP utility appropriate to your system environment to change the BIOS setup.  
For the BIOS SETUP for the server, see Chapter 4. For the BIOS SETUP for the option board,  
refer to the manual that comes with the option board.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-22 Setting Up Your Server  
INSTALLING OPERATING SYSTEM  
See Chapter 5 for installing the Microsoft Windows Server 2003 or Microsoft Windows 2000  
operating systems.  
To install the other operating system listed above, contact your service representative.  
IMPORTANT: Before installing the operating system, adjust the  
system date and time by using the BIOS setup utility "SETUP." See  
the next chapter for detail.  
INSTALLING UTILITIES  
Install the utilities that come with the server. See Chapter 6 for details.  
MAKING BACKUP COPIES OF SYSTEM INFORMATION  
The system information includes the current BIOS settings and any specific information for the  
server.  
Save the information after completing the system setup.  
Without the backup data, you will not be able to recover the information.  
You can save the information by the following process.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive and reboot the  
system.  
2. Select [Tools].  
3. Select [Off-line Maintenance Utility].  
4. Select [System Information Management].  
5. Insert a floppy disk into the floppy disk drive.  
6. Select [Save].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4  
Configuring Your Server  
Configuration and setup utilities are used to change your system configuration. You can configure  
your system, as well as option boards you may add to your system, using the BIOS Setup Utility.  
Several unique system parameters are configured using the BIOS Setup, which is stored in the  
system FLASH memory.  
The Adaptec Configuration Utility detects the SCSI host adapters on the system board. Use this  
utility if you need to configure the two SCSI controllers in your system, to configure the hard disk  
drives connected to a SCSI controller as a RAID drive, or to perform a SCSI disk format or verify  
disk operation on the SCSI disk drives. The Adaptec Configuration Utility is also used to configure  
any SCSI removable media devices installed in your system.  
If your system has been factory configured, the BIOS Setup or Adaptec Configuration Utility do not  
need to be run unless you want to change the password or security features, add certain types of  
option boards or devices, or upgrade your system board.  
This chapter also provides information on several system configuration parameters that are set by  
jumpers on the system board. However, these parameters do not usually require change.  
SYSTEM BIOS (SETUP)  
The SETUP utility is used to change system configuration parameters. This utility is pre-installed in  
the flash memory of the server and ready to run.  
The server is configured with the correct parameters using the SETUP utility and shipped in the best  
conditions. Thus, you don't need to use the SETUP utility in most cases. However, you might  
wish to use the SETUP utility in the cases described below.  
IMPORTANT:  
The SETUP utility is intended for system administrator use only.  
The SETUP utility allows you to set a password. The server is  
provided with two levels of password: Supervisor and User. With  
the Supervisor password, you can view and change all system  
parameters of the SETUP utility. With the User password, system  
parameters available for viewing and changing are limited.  
Do not set any password before installing the OS.  
The server contains the latest version of the SETUP utility. Dialog  
boxes appear on your SETUP utility, thus, may differ from  
descriptions in this manual. If you find anything unclear, see the  
online help or ask your service representative.  
Use the Exit menu when exiting the SETUP utility. Exiting the  
utility with the POWER switch or reset operation causes the stored  
parameters to lose.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-2 Configuring Your Server  
Starting SETUP Utility  
Powering on the server starts POST (Power On Self-Test) and displays its check results. If the  
NEC logo is displayed, press Esc.  
After a few seconds, the following message appears at bottom left on the screen.  
Press <F2> to enter SETUP  
Press F2 to start the SETUP utility and display its Main menu.  
If you have previously set a password with the SETUP utility, the password entry screen appears.  
Enter the password.  
Enter password:[  
]
Up to three password entries will be accepted. If you fail to enter the password correctly for three  
consecutive times, the server halts. (You can no longer proceed.) Power off the server.  
NOTE: The server is provided with two levels of password:  
Administrator and User. With the Administrator password, you can  
view and change all system parameters. With the User password,  
system parameters available for viewing and changing are limited.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-3  
Description on On-Screen Items and Key Usage  
Use the following keyboard keys to work with the SETUP utility. (Key functions are also listed at  
the bottom of the screen.)  
Indicates the current menu.  
Indicates there  
are submenus.  
Online help  
window  
Setup item  
menu*  
Explanation of key  
functions menu  
Parameter (high-lights upon selection) menu  
* The menus displayed in gray indicates the information only or unchangeable secured by BIOS  
password.  
Selects an item on the screen. The highlighted item is currently  
selected.  
Cursor (, ):  
Selects the Main, Advanced, Security, Server, Boot, or Exit menu.  
Cursor (, ):  
and +:  
Changes the value (parameter) of the selected item. When a  
submenu option (an option preceded by "³") is selected, these  
keys are disabled.  
Enter  
Esc  
F9:  
Press Enter to select (determine) parameters.  
Exit SETUP and return to the previous screen.  
Sets the parameter of the currently displayed item back to the  
factory set parameter.  
F10:  
Save and exit the SETUP utility.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4 Configuring Your Server  
Menu and Parameter Descriptions  
The SETUP utility has the following six major menus:  
Main  
Advanced  
Security  
Server  
Boot  
Exit  
To set minute functions, select a submenu from the above menus. The following describes  
available functions and parameters, as well as the factory-set, for each menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-5  
Main  
Option  
Parameter  
HH:MM:SS  
MM/DD/YYYY  
Disabled  
Description  
Set the system time.  
Set the system date.  
Set the settings of floppy disk  
drive A (standard configuration).  
Your Setting  
System Time  
System Date  
Legacy Floppy A  
360Kb 51/4  
1.2MB 51/4  
720Kb 31/2  
[1.44/1.25MB 31/2]  
2.88MB 31/2  
[Disabled]  
Legacy Floppy B  
Set the settings of floppy disk  
drive B. No second floppy disk  
drive is included in this system.  
360Kb 51/4  
1.2MB 51/4  
720Kb 31/2  
1.44/1.25MB 31/2  
2.88MB 31/2  
[Disabled]  
Hard Disk Pre-Delay  
Allows slower spin-up drives to  
come ready.  
3 seconds  
6 seconds  
9 seconds  
12 seconds  
15 seconds  
21 seconds  
30 seconds  
Select submenu  
Primary IDE Master/  
Primary IDE Slave  
Secondary IDE Master  
Secondary IDE Slave  
Serial ATA Channel 0  
Master  
Set the information on the device  
connected to each channel on  
the submenu. The settings of  
some items may be changed.  
However, leave the items as they  
are at the shipment.  
Serial ATA Channel 1  
Master  
Processor Settings  
Select submenu  
Shows the processor settings  
submenu.  
Language  
[English (US)]  
Italiano  
Select which language BIOS  
displays.  
Español  
Français  
Deutsch  
[
]: Factory-set  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-6 Configuring Your Server  
Primary IDE Master/Primary IDE Slave/Secondary IDE Master/Secondary IDE  
Slave/Serial ATA Channel 0 Master/ Serial ATA Channel 1 Master  
Correspondence between the menu items and devices:  
Primary IDE Master:  
Primary IDE Slave:  
Secondary IDE Master:  
Secondary IDE Slave:  
ATA hard disk drive 1 (option)  
ATA hard disk drive 2 (option)  
CD-ROM drive (standard)  
None  
Serial ATA Channel 0 Master: Serial ATA hard disk drive 1 (option)  
Serial ATA Channel 1 Master: Serial ATA hard disk drive 2 (option)  
Option  
Parameter  
Description  
Your Setting  
Type  
None  
User  
[Auto]  
CD-ROM  
Selects the type of device attached to  
the IDE or serial ATA channel. It is  
strongly recommended to keep the  
factory setting [Auto].  
The following options do not appear when None or Auto are selected for Type.  
Multi-Sector  
Transfers  
Disabled  
2 Sectors  
4 Sectors  
8 Sectors  
16 Sectors  
Specifies the number of sectors that  
are transferred per block during  
multiple sector transfers.  
LBA Mode Control Enabled  
Disabled  
Enable/disable LBA instead of  
cylinder, head, sector, addressing.  
Transfer Mode  
Standard  
Fast PIO 1  
Fast PIO 2  
Fast PIO 3  
Fast PIO 4  
FPIO 3/DMA1  
FPIO 4/DMA2  
Disabled  
Mode 0  
Select the method for moving data  
to/from the drive.  
Ultra DMA  
Select the Ultra DMA mode used for  
moving data to/from the drive.  
Mode 1  
Mode 2  
Mode 3  
Mode 4  
Mode 5  
[
]: Factory-set  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-7  
Processor Settings  
Option  
Parameter Description  
Your Setting  
Processor Retest  
[No]  
Yes  
If yes, BIOS will clear historical  
processor status and retest the  
processor on the next boot.  
Processor Speed  
nnn GHz  
Displays clock speed for the  
processor. (View only)  
Processor 1 CPUID  
Numeral  
Disabled  
Displays CPU ID for processor, if  
present.  
"Disabled" indicates that the  
processor is defected. (View only)  
Processor 1 L2 Cache  
Processor 2 CPUID  
nnn KB  
Displays L2 cache size for  
processor.  
Displays CPU ID for processor, if  
present.  
Numeral  
Disabled  
"Disabled" indicates that the  
processor is defected. (View only)  
Processor 2 L2 Cache  
nnn KB  
Displays L2 cache size for  
processor.  
Hyper-Threading  
Technology  
[Enabled]  
Disabled  
[Disabled]  
Enabled  
Disable or enable the Hyper-  
Threading Technology.  
Execute Disabled Bit  
Displays the CPU which supports  
Execute Disabled Bit.  
[
]: Factory-set  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-8 Configuring Your Server  
Advanced  
Option  
Memory Configuration  
Parameter Description  
Displays Memory Configuration  
Your Setting  
submenu.  
PCI Configuration  
Displays PCI Configuration  
submenu.  
Displays Peripheral Configuration  
submenu.  
Displays Advanced Chipset Control  
submenu.  
Peripheral Configuration  
Advanced Chipset Control  
Boot-time Diagnostic  
Screen  
[Enabled]  
Disabled  
When disabled, the BIOS will display  
the NEC logo during POST. Press  
Esc to switch to the POST execution  
screen.  
Reset Configuration Data  
NumLock  
[No]  
Yes  
Select "Yes" if you want to clear the  
system configuration data during the  
next boot. Automatically reset to  
"No" in the next boot.  
[Auto]  
On  
Sets power on Numlock state.  
Off  
Memory/Processor Error  
SATA RAID Enable  
[Boot]  
Halt  
[Disabled]  
Enabled  
If "Halt" is selected, the boot is  
stopped when POST error occurs.  
Cannot be used in this system.  
[
]: Factory-set  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-9  
Memory Configuration  
Option  
System Memory  
Parameter  
nnn KB  
Description  
Indicates the total capacity of the basic  
memory. (View only)  
Your Setting  
Extended Memory nnnnnnn KB  
Indicates the total capacity of the  
extended memory. (View only)  
DIMM Group #1 -  
#4  
Normal  
Disabled  
Not installed  
Indicates the current memory status.  
"Normal" indicates the normal status,  
"Disabled" indicates a memory error, and  
"Not installed" indicates no DIMM installed  
(view only).  
Group #1 indicates DIMMs in DIMM  
sockets #1 and #2.  
Group #2 indicates DIMMs in DIMM  
sockets #3 and #4.  
Group #3 indicates DIMMs in DIMM  
sockets #5 and #6.  
Group #4 indicates DIMMs in DIMM  
sockets #7 and #8.  
(Memory is interleaved and two DIMMs  
are used in pair.)  
Memory Retest  
Yes  
[No]  
Causes BIOS to retest all memory on the  
next boot.  
Extended RAM  
Step  
1MB  
1KB  
Every location  
[Disabled]  
"1MB" indicates that the memory test is  
done in the unit of 1MB. "1KB" indicates  
that the memory test is done in the unit of  
1KB. "Every location" tests every memory  
location. "Disabled" indicates that only  
memory initialization is done.  
Online Spare  
Memory  
[Disabled]  
Enabled  
Disables or enables online spare memory  
feature. See "DIMM" in Chapter 8 for  
details.  
[
]: Factory-set  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-10 Configuring Your Server  
PCI Configuration  
– Embedded SCSI submenu  
Option  
SCSI Controller  
Parameter  
[Enabled]  
Disabled  
Description  
Enables or disables the onboard SCSI  
controllers.  
Your Setting  
Option ROM Scan [Enabled]  
Disabled  
If Enabled, initialize device expansion ROM.  
[
]: Factory-set  
– Embedded NIC (Dual Gbit) submenu  
Option  
LAN Controller  
Parameter  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Description  
Your Setting  
If Disabled, the BIOS will hold the  
embedded chip in reset. In this  
configuration, the controller hardware is  
completely disabled, and will be invisible to  
the PnP operating systems.  
Option ROM Scan [Enabled]  
Disabled  
If Enabled, initialize device expansion ROM.  
[
]: Factory-set  
– Embedded Video Controller submenu  
Option  
Onboard VGA  
Control  
Parameter  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Description  
Your Setting  
If Disabled, the BIOS will hold the  
embedded chip in reset. In this  
configuration, the controller hardware is  
completely disabled, and will be invisible to  
the PnP operating systems.  
[
]: Factory-set  
Option  
PCI Slot 1B/2B/3B  
Option ROM  
Parameter  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Description  
Your Setting  
Used to enable or disable an option ROM  
on a PCI board connected to the full-height  
riser card.  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
PCI Slot 1C/2C/3C  
Option ROM  
Used to enable or disable an option ROM  
on a PCI board connected to the low-profile  
riser card.  
[Disabled]  
Enabled  
Option PCI-X  
Riser Support  
Used to enable or disable an option N8112-  
02 riser card (PCI-X).  
[Disabled]  
Enabled  
PCIe Option Mode  
Cannot be used in this system. Do not  
change the factory setting.  
[
]: Factory-set  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-11  
Peripheral Configuration  
IMPORTANT: Note that the interrupt and/or base I/O address are not  
overlapped with others. If the value set for the interrupt or base I/O  
address is used in another resource, the yellow asterisk (*) appears.  
Reset any item with the yellow asterisk properly.  
Option  
Serial Port A  
Parameter  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Auto  
Description  
Selects whether serial port A is  
enabled or disabled.  
Your Setting  
Base I/O address  
[3F8]  
2F8  
Selects the base I/O address for serial  
port A.  
3E8  
2E8  
Interrupt  
IRQ 3  
Selects the interrupt for a serial port A.  
[IRQ 4]  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Auto  
Serial Port B  
Selects whether serial port B is  
enabled or disabled (display only).  
Base I/O address  
3F8  
[2F8]  
Selects the base I/O address for serial  
port A.  
3E8  
2E8  
Interrupt  
[IRQ 3]  
IRQ 4  
Selects the interrupt for a serial port A.  
PS/2 Mouse  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Auto Detect  
If disabled, PS/2 mouse port will not  
function.  
USB Host Controller Disabled  
[Enabled]  
If disabled, the USB ports do not  
accept the USB device class 3 (HID:  
Human Interface Device).  
Legacy USB  
Support  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Selects whether the USB keyboard is  
made available in OS which does not  
support USB formally.  
Parallel ATA  
Disabled  
Channel 0  
Channel 1  
[Both]  
Selects parallel ATA is enabled or  
disabled.  
Serial ATA  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Selects whether the serial ATA is  
enabled or disabled.  
[
]: Factory-set  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-12 Configuring Your Server  
Advanced Chipset Control  
Option  
Parameter  
Description  
Your Setting  
Enable Multimedia [No]  
Specify whether the system supports  
the multimedia timer feature.  
Timer  
Yes  
Wake On  
LAN/PME  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Specify whether the remote power-on  
function through embedded NIC, PCI  
devices in slots 1 to 5 is enabled or  
disabled.  
Wake On Ring  
[Disabled]  
Enabled  
Specify whether the remote power-on  
function through a serial port is  
enabled or disabled.  
Wake On RTC  
Alarm  
[Disabled]  
Enabled  
Specify whether the remote power-on  
function by using RTC alarm feature is  
enabled or disabled.  
[
]: Factory-set  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-13  
Security  
The Security menu appears if you move the cursor to the position of "Security."  
Press Enter on "Set Supervisor Password" or "Set User Password," to display the following screen.  
Enter the passwords on the dialog box. Passwords may have up to eight characters including  
alphanumerics and symbols.  
IMPORTANT:  
User password can be set only when Administrator password is  
already set.  
Set the passwords only after OS is installed.  
See the table below for the items.  
Option  
User Password Is  
Parameter  
Clear  
Set  
Description  
Your Setting  
Status only, user cannot modify.  
Once set, this can be disabled by  
setting it to a null string, or by clearing  
password jumper on system board  
(see Configuring Mother Board  
Jumpers in this Chapter).  
Supervisor  
Password Is  
Clear  
Set  
Status only, user cannot modify.  
Once set, this can be disabled by  
setting it to a null string, or by clearing  
password jumper on system board  
(see Configuring Mother Board  
Jumpers in this Chapter).  
Set User  
Password  
Up to eight  
alphanumerics  
Supervisor password controls access  
to the setup utility.  
When Enter is pressed, the user is  
prompted for a password; press Esc  
to abort. Once set, this can be  
disabled by setting it to a null string, or  
by clearing password jumper on  
system board (refer to Configuring  
Mother Board Jumpers in this  
chapter).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-14 Configuring Your Server  
Option  
Parameter  
Description  
Your Setting  
Set Supervisor  
Password  
Up to eight  
alphanumerics  
When the <Enter> key is pressed, the  
user is prompted for a password;  
press ESC key to abort. Once set, this  
can be disabled by setting it to a null  
string, or by clearing password jumper  
on system board (refer to Configuring  
Mother Board Jumpers in this  
chapter).  
Password on boot [Disabled]  
Enabled  
Disables or enables password entry  
on boot.  
Fixed disk boot  
sector  
[Normal]  
Write Protect  
Will write protect the boot sector of the  
hard drive to prevent viruses from  
corrupting the drive under DOS if set  
to write protect.  
Secure Mode  
Timer  
[Disabled]  
1 min  
2 min  
5 min  
10 min  
20 min  
1 hr.  
Set the period from no input from the  
keyboard or mouse to the point at  
which the system enters into the  
secure mode.  
2 hr.  
Security Hot Key  
CTRL-ALT-  
[L]  
Z
Specify the hot key to invoke secure  
mode features. Pressing the assigned  
key along with Ctrl and Alt invoke  
secure mode. This option is enabled  
when User Password is set.  
Secure Mode Boot [Disabled]  
Enabled  
Specify whether the system boots in  
secure mode. This option is enabled  
when User Password is set.  
Video Blanking  
[Disabled]  
Enabled  
[Disabled]  
Enabled  
Specify whether to turn off the monitor  
when secure mode is activated.  
Controls access to the floppy disk  
drive during the secure mode.  
Floppy Write  
Protect  
Power Switch  
Inhibit  
[Disabled]  
Enabled  
Enables or disables the POWER  
switch. If "Enabled" is selected,  
power-off with the POWER switch  
becomes unavailable after OS boot-  
up. (Forced shut down also becomes  
unavailable. Forced shut down is a  
feature to shut down by pressing the  
POWER switch for at least four  
seconds.)  
[
]: Factory-set  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-15  
Server  
Option  
Parameter  
Description  
Your Setting  
System  
Management  
System Management submenu is  
displayed.  
Console  
Console Redirection submenu is  
displayed.  
Event Log Configuration submenu is  
displayed.  
Specify whether to support PCI PERR or  
not.  
Redirection  
Event Log  
Configuration  
Assert NMI on  
PERR  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Assert NMI on  
SERR  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Specify whether to support PCI SERR or  
not.  
FRB-2 Policy  
Disable FRB2  
Timer  
Set the FRB level 2 timer.  
[Retry 3 Times]  
[Disabled]  
5 Minutes  
10 Minutes  
15 Minutes  
20 Minutes  
25 Minutes  
30 Minutes  
35 Minutes  
40 Minutes  
45 Minutes  
50 Minutes  
55 Minutes  
60 Minutes  
Boot Monitoring  
Specify whether to enable or disable the  
boot monitoring function on booting, or  
select the time limit for timeout.  
To use this function, install NEC  
ESMPRO Agent. Set this item to  
"Disabled" if the system is booted from  
OS without installation of NEC  
ESMPRO Agent.  
Boot Monitoring  
Policy  
[Retry 3 Times]  
Retry Service  
Boot  
Specify the processing at the  
occurrence of timeout during boot  
monitoring.  
If [Retry 3 times] is selected, the system  
is reset after the occurrence of timeout  
and OS boot is retried up to three times.  
If [Retry Service Boot] is selected, the  
system is reset after the occurrence of  
timeout and OS boot is retried up to  
three times. Then the boot is tried from  
the service partition for three times. The  
failure in the third boot causes the  
system to stop booting.  
Always Reset  
If [Always Reset] is selected, the system  
is reset after the occurrence of timeout  
and OS boot is retried repeatedly.  
*
If no service partition exists in the  
system, OS boot is retried repeatedly  
from the system partition.  
Thermal Sensor  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Specify whether to enable or disable the  
thermal sensor monitoring function. If a  
thermal error is detected with this item  
being set to "Enabled", the system stops  
at the end of POST.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-16 Configuring Your Server  
Option  
Post Error Pause  
Parameter  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Description  
Your Setting  
Specify whether to stop the POST once  
at the end of POST if an error occurs  
during the POST.  
AC-LINK  
Stay Off  
Specify the state of power when the AC  
power to the server is turn off once and  
then on.  
[Last State]  
Power On  
[0] - 255  
Power On Delay  
Time (Sec)  
Specify the power on delay time within  
the range between 0 and 255 seconds.  
The time specified is valid when "Power  
On" or "Last State" is specified for AC  
LINK.  
Platform Event  
Filtering  
[Disabled]  
Enabled  
This item becomes meaningless when  
the notification feature of remote  
management card (RMC) is enabled.  
[
]: Factory-set  
IMPORTANT: To power on the server from the UPS (Uninterruptible  
Power Supply), select [Server] - [AC LINK] - [Power On].  
The table below shows the operation when the AC power to the server is turn off once and then on  
again, depending on the setting of "AC LINK."  
Setting of AC LINK  
System status before AC power off  
Stay Off  
Off  
Last State  
Power On  
Operating  
Aborting (DC power being off also)  
Forced shutdown  
On  
Off  
Off  
On  
On  
On  
Off  
Off  
* Press the power switch continuously for four seconds or longer. This forcibly turns off the  
power.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-17  
System Management Submenu  
Option  
Parameter  
Description  
Your Setting  
BIOS Version  
Displays the current BIOS version.  
(View only)  
IPMI Specification  
Version  
Displays IPMI specification version.  
(View only)  
BMC Device ID  
BMC Device  
Version  
Displays BMC device ID. (View only)  
Displays BMC device version. (View  
only)  
BMC Firmware  
Version  
PIA Version  
Displays BMC firmware version. (View  
only)  
Displays version of the platform  
information area. (View only)  
Displays revision of the sensor data  
record.  
SDR Revision  
[
]: Factory-set  
Console Redirection Submenu  
Option  
BIOS Redirection  
Port  
Parameter  
[Disabled]  
Serial Port A  
Serial Port B  
[Disabled]  
Serial Port A  
Serial Port B  
9600  
Description  
Your Setting  
Specify the address/interrupt of the  
serial port to which a remote console  
is connected.  
ACPI Redirection  
Port  
Specify the serial port to which an  
ACPI console is connected.  
Baud Rate  
Specify the baud rate used for the  
interface with successive remote  
consoles.  
[19.2K]  
38.4K  
57.6K  
115.2K  
Flow Control  
Console Type  
None  
Specify the flow control method.  
Xon/Xoff  
[CTS/RTS]  
CTS/RTS+CD  
[PC ANSI]  
VT100+  
Specify the type of remote console.  
VT-UTF8  
[
]: Factory-set  
Console Redirection Submenu  
Option  
Parameter  
Description  
Your Setting  
Clear all Event  
Logs  
Press Enter and select "Yes" to clear  
the system event log.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-18 Configuring Your Server  
Boot  
If you move the cursor to the position of "Boot," the Boot menu appears, which is used to set the  
boot priority.  
The factory-default boot order is listed below.  
1. CD-ROM drive  
2. Removable Devices  
3. Hard Drive  
4. IBA GE Slot 0200 v1216  
5. IBA GE Slot 0209 v1216  
The server searches for devices in the order set in this menu on booting. Finding the boot software,  
the server starts the software.  
The priority of the boot devices can be changed by using the , , +, and - keys. Move the cursor  
to the desired device with the or key and change the priority with the + or - key.  
IMPORTANT: To boot NEC EXPRESSBUILDER, set the priority of  
the devices as shown in the figure above.  
Exit  
The options on the menu are described below.  
Exit Saving Changes  
Exit after writing all modified BIOS Setup item values to CMOS.  
Exit Discarding Changes  
Exit leaving CMOS unmodified. User is prompted if any of the setup fields ware modified.  
Load Setup Defaults  
Load default values for all BIOS Setup items.  
Discard Changes  
Read the previous values of the all BIOS Setup items from CMOS.  
Save Changes  
Write all BIOS Setup item values to CMOS.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-19  
SCSI BIOS (SCSISelect)  
The SCSISelect utility is provided to configure the SCSI controller on the mother board (or the  
SCSI controller on an optional board). This utility may be started with a simple key operation  
while POST is in progress and requires no specific start-up disk.  
Using SCSISelect Utility  
Use the SCSISelect utility mainly to set the transfer speed of connected SCSI devices or to  
configure the internal hard disk drives connected to the onboard SCSI controller as a RAID drive  
(HostRAID). The SCSI devices include those installed in the backup file bay, such as an external  
DAT and MO, but not hard disk drives.  
IMPORTANT: SCSI configuration must be made on a per-SCSI  
controller basis with a utility. The server contains one SCSI controller.  
When you added optional SCSI controllers, you need to make  
configuration for each SCSI controller in addition to the standard  
internal SCSI controller. Some additional SCSI controllers may  
require a different utility to make changes to the configuration.  
Configuring SCSI Controller on Mother Board  
The following describes configuration for the SCSI controller on the mother board of the server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-20 Configuring Your Server  
Running the Utility  
To run the utility, perform the following procedures:  
1. Power on the server.  
The following message appears while POST is in progress.  
IMPORTANT: The message appears for each additional SCSI  
controller.  
Adaptec SCSI BIOS Vxxx xxxxx  
(c) 2000 Adaptec, Inc. All Rights Reserved  
ꢀꢀꢀPress <Ctrl> <A> for SCSISelect(TM) Utility! ꢁꢁꢁ  
2. Press and hold Ctrl and A.  
The SCSISelect utility starts and its Main menu appears.  
3. Select the channel and press Enter.  
AIC-7902 A at Slot 23 02:03:00  
AIC-7902 B at Slot 23 02:03:01  
NOTE: "AIC-7902A" is for backup file devices. "AIC-7902B" is for  
internal SCSI hard disk drives.  
The Options menu appears.  
4. Select option in the Options box and press Enter.  
AIC-7902 at slot 23, 03:03:00  
Would you like to configure the SCSI controller, or run the  
SCSI Disk Utilities? Select the option and press <Enter>.  
Options  
Configure/View SCSI Controller Settings  
SCSI Disk Utilities  
Enable HostRAID Support  
If you wish to configure the adapter or a device, select "Configure/View SCSI Controller  
Settings".  
If you wish to format a disk, verify disk media, or display a list of devices and their SCSI  
IDs, select "SCSI Disk Utilities".  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-21  
Exiting the Utility  
To exit the utility, press Esc until a message prompts you to exit (if you changed any setting, you  
are prompted to save the changes before you exit).  
Configure/View SCSI Controller Settings  
The Configure/View Host Adapter Settings has the following menu items and parameters. Read  
descriptions to select a correct parameter for each menu item.  
SCSI Bus Interface Definitions  
To set three menu items under "SCSI Bus Interface Definitions", select a menu item with the cursor  
keys (or ) and press Enter to fix the item. Use the cursor keys (or ) for parameter selection.  
The following table lists menu items, available parameters, and descriptions.  
Menu item  
SCSI Controller ID  
SCSI Controller Parity  
Parameter  
0 - [7] - 15  
[Enabled]  
Disabled  
Description  
Select "7".  
Select "Enabled".  
SCSI Controller  
Termination  
[Enabled]  
Disabled  
Enable or disable the SCSI termination.  
Select "Enabled".  
[
]: Factory-set  
Additional Options  
To set three menu items under "Additional Options", select a menu item with the cursor keys (or  
) and press Enter to display its submenu. Then, select a submenu item with the cursor keys (or  
) and press Enter to fix the item. Use the cursor keys (or ) for parameter selection.  
Boot Device Configuration  
Move the cursor onto "Boot Device Configuration" and press Enter to display the  
submenu. The Boot Device Configuration submenu allows you to select the device  
connected to the channel A or B as a boot device. Always select "AIC-7902 A".  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-22 Configuring Your Server  
SCSI Device Configuration  
Move the cursor onto "SCSI Device Configuration" and press Enter to display the  
submenu.  
The following table lists submenu items, available parameters, and descriptions.  
IMPORTANT: Select a parameter for each submenu item on a per-  
SCSI ID basis. Verify the SCSI ID of a desired device before  
configuration.  
NOTE: To find out the SCSI ID for the optional device connected,  
select "SCSI Disk Utilities" on the Options menu and press Enter.  
See "SCSI Disk Utilities" for detail.  
Submenu item  
Sync Transfer Rate  
(MB/Sec)  
Parameter  
Description  
Select "320".  
You may need to change the value  
depending on your optional device.  
Refer to the manual that comes with your  
optional device for details.  
[320]  
160  
33.3  
20.0  
80.0  
66.6  
40.0  
[Yes]  
No  
10.4  
ASYN  
Packetized  
QAS  
Optimizes bus utilization and minimizes  
command overhead to bolster performance  
by transferring commands, data, and status  
using Deal Transition (DT) data phases.  
Quick Arbitration and Selection (QAS)  
reduces the overhead of control release on  
the SCSI bus from one device to another to  
help decrease command overhead and  
increase bus utilization.  
[Yes]  
No  
Initiate Wide  
Negotiation  
[Yes]  
No  
Select "Yes" if your SCSI device supports the  
Wide SCSI interface. Select "No" if not.  
Enable Disconnection [Yes]  
No  
Select "Yes".  
Send Start Unit  
Command  
[Yes]  
No  
Select "Yes" to send the command to the  
hard disk drive. Otherwise select "No".  
BIOS Multiple LUN  
Support  
Yes  
[No]  
[Yes]  
No  
Select "No".  
Include in BIOS Scan  
Select "Yes".  
[
]: Factory-set  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-23  
Advanced Configuration  
Move the cursor onto "Advanced Configuration" and press Enter to display the submenu.  
The following table lists submenu items, available parameter, and descriptions.  
Submenu item  
Reset SCSI Bus at  
IC Initialization  
Display <Ctrl><A>  
Message During  
BIOS Initialization  
Extended Int 13  
Translation for DOS Disabled  
Drives > 1 GByte  
POST Display Mode [Verbose]  
Silent  
Parameter  
[Enabled]  
Disabled  
[Enabled]  
Disabled  
Description  
Select "Enabled".  
Select "Enabled".  
Select "Enabled".  
Select "Verbose".  
[Enabled]  
Diagnostic  
SCSI Controller Int  
13 Support  
[Enabled]  
Disabled:  
NOT Scan  
Disabled:  
scan bus  
Enable or disable SCSI BIOS.  
Select "Enabled" for most cases other than the  
following:  
To boot the OS from a hard disk drive  
connected to any other controller than SCSI  
controller. (If the controller has no hard disk  
drives connected, there is no problem.)  
BIOS of the SCSI controller may be disabled to  
reserve an area in the expansion ROM space  
if the controller has no hard disk drives  
connected.  
Domain Validation  
[Enabled]  
Disabled  
Select "Enabled".  
Support Removable Boot Only  
AIC-79xx BIOS automatically controls the  
removable disks.  
Disks Under Int 13  
as Fixed Disks  
All Disks  
[Disabled]  
[Enabled]  
Disabled  
BIOS Support for  
Bootable CD-ROM  
Select "Enabled".  
[
]: Factory-set  
HostRAID  
Move the cursor onto "HostRAID" and press Enter to choose the HostRAID option.  
Submenu item  
Parameter Description  
HostRAID  
Enabled  
[Disabled]  
Select "Disabled" if the onboard HostRAID  
controller is not used.  
[
]: Factory-set  
NOTE: For detail explanation on the HostRAID feature, see  
SCSISelect Utility User's Manual and Adaptec Storage Manager-  
Browser Edition User's Guide or Adaptec Storage ManagerUser's  
Guide. You may view or print these documents from the NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-24 Configuring Your Server  
SCSI Disk Utilities  
This utility scans the SCSI bus for SCSI devices, reports a description of each device. Run these  
utilities before configuring SCSI devices.  
To enter the utility, select "SCSI Disk Utilities" on the Options menu.  
The SCSI ID scan begins displaying the message as shown below.  
AIC-7901 at Slot 00. 23 03:03:00  
Scanning SCSI ID:14: Lun Number  
When the SCSI ID scan completes, the screen listing SCSI IDs and associated devices appears.  
Find out the SCSI ID for the installed optional on this screen. You can also view the device  
information by selecting a device and pressing Enter.  
The following sub menu appears.  
SCSI ID#4 : xxxxxxxxx  
Firmware : xxxx xxx  
Capacity : xxGB  
Format  
Verify Disk Media  
The following table lists submenu items and descriptions.  
Submenu item  
Format  
Description  
Formats the selected device in the raw level.  
Verify Disk Media  
Verifies all the sectors in the selected device. If one or  
more bad sectors are found, reassigns the sectors.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-25  
Configuring SCSI Controller on Optional Board  
To configure SCSI devices connected to an optional SCSI controller board, use the SCSI BIOS  
utility provided with the optional SCSI controller board.  
Refer to the manual that comes with the optional SCSI controller board for details.  
When the server has multiple SCSI controller boards installed, the server first displays the start-up  
message of the SCSISelect utility for the SCSI controller on the mother board. It then displays the  
utility start-up message for additional SCSI controllers one by one. The start-up message appears  
for the SCSI controller board in the PCI #6 slot first, the PCI #5, #4, #3, onboard SCSI, #2, and  
finally #1. The message displayed may vary depending on the optional SCSI controller board.  
Refer to the manual that comes with the optional SCSI controller board for details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-26 Configuring Your Server  
RAID BIOS  
The RAID (Redundant Array of Inexpensive Devices) option available for your system is N8103-  
80F/81F/86F RAID controller boards which give your system the added security of fault tolerance.  
If you want to change the RAID level or add additional hard disk drives to the array, use the RAID  
configuration utility. The RAID configuration utility is included with a RAID controller.  
If you are adding the RAID controller to an existing system, the RAID configuration utility allows  
you to configure your disk array before reinstalling your network operating system. The RAID  
controllers support various versions of RAID technology (referred to as RAID levels). To use any  
RAID level, you must configure the RAID controller using the RAID configuration utility prior to  
installing your Network Operating System. For an explanation of this utility, refer to the  
documentation that comes with the RAID controller. It describes RAID technology and provides  
tips on making your array perform well in your specific application. It also covers array hardware  
preparation, configuration, and initialization. After completing the steps in the manual, you can  
install your Network Operating System.  
If you want to remotely configure the array (from a PC client); increase array capacity online; or  
monitor statistics on disk and controller activity, you must install the array manager provided with  
your RAID subsystem. Increasing array capacity is covered in the documentation shipped with the  
option.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-27  
RAID CONFIGURATION  
This section describes how to use the internal hard disk drives in the disk array RAID configuration.  
To use an external hard disk drive in a disk array, the optional disk array controller and the  
additional disk drive are necessary. Refer to the manual of the optional disk array controller or  
additional external disk drive for details.  
For SAS-DAC model, refer to the N8103-91 Disk Array Controller (Internal SAS HDD) User's  
Guide.  
To configure the internal hard disk drives as the disk array drive:  
Configure the six SCSI hard disk drives by using the onboard RAID controller.  
Configure the hard disk drives by using the optional disk array controller.  
RAID Configuration of SCSI Hard Disk Drive  
You can configure a disk array (RAID0, RAID1, or RAID10) by using the onboard RAID controller  
of the server.  
You need six SCSI hard disk drives for configuration.  
RAID0 (striping)  
Stores data on two, three, or four hard disk drives by dividing it (striping). All the hard  
disk drives can be accessed at the same time. This improves disk access performance  
compared with using a single hard disk drive.  
IMPORTANT:  
RAID0 does not have data redundancy. When a hard disk drive  
failure occurs, data cannot be restored.  
Logical capacity of the array becomes a multiple of the connected  
hard disk drive.  
RAID1 (mirroring)  
Stores the data being saved to one hard disk dive to another hard disk drive. This method  
is called "mirroring." When storing data onto one hard disk drive, the same data is  
simultaneously stored onto another hard disk drive. When a hard disk drive becomes  
faulty, the one with the same data can be used. This provides operation without the system  
going down.  
IMPORTANT:  
RAID1 reads or writes data to/from the several hard disk drives at  
the same time. The disk access performance is lower than the single  
disk.  
Logical capacity of the array is equal to one hard disk drive  
connected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-28 Configuring Your Server  
Installing the Hard Disk Drives  
Install the two or more SCSI hard disk drives to your server. Refer to Chapter 9 for detail.  
IMPORTANT: Use two hard disk drives of the same revolution. In  
addition, use two hard disk drives of the same capacity if you are going  
to configure RAID1.  
Enabling RAID Feature by SCSISelect Utility  
The two or more hard disk drives installed can be used either as a single disk or a RAID drive.  
To configure a disk drives as RAID drive, you must specify the hard disk drive being connected to  
the onboard SCSI connector as a RAID drive by using the SCSISelect Utility.  
NOTE: The factory-set value is to use the hard disk drive as a single  
disk drive.  
To change settings by SCSISelect Utility:  
1. Start the SCSISelect Utility.  
AIC-7902 A at Slot 23 02:03:00  
AIC-7902 B at Slot 23 02:03:01  
2. Select the channel to set HostRAID to open the Options window.  
3. Select [Configure/View SCSI Controller Settings] and press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-29  
4. Select [Disabled] of Host RAID on Configuration menu and press Enter.  
5. Change it to [Enabled].  
6. Press Esc. The confirmation message [Save Changes Mode?] appears. Select [Yes].  
7. Press Esc to return to the Options menu.  
8. Select [Configure/View HostRAID] and press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-30 Configuring Your Server  
Main Menu  
When you select [Configure/View HostRAID Settings], the Main Menu as shown below appears  
upon completion of device scan.  
Main Menu Display  
ID  
Type  
-
-
Indicates SCSI ID of hard disk drive or ID of array.  
Indicates RAID level for the array, and available disk drive that is not in the array.  
Hard Drive  
Striped(R0)  
Mirrored(R1)  
Stripe/Mirror(R10)  
Spare  
-
-
-
-
-
Available hard disk drive that is not in the array.  
Array configured in RAID0  
Array configured in RAID1  
Array configured in RAID10 (spanning of RAID1)  
Hard disk drive assigned as a spare disk  
Vendor  
Product  
Size  
-
-
-
-
Indicates the manufacturer of hard disk drive or HostRAID (Adaptec).  
Indicates the model name of hard disk drive or array name.  
Indicates the capacity of hard disk drive or that of array.  
Indicates the status of hard disk drive or array.  
Status  
Free  
-
-
-
-
Available hard disk drive that is not in the array.  
Array is in normal state.  
One of the RAID1 or RAID10 hard disk drives is failed.  
One or more RAID0 hard disk drives is failed.  
Two or more RAID1 or RAID10 hard disk drives are failed.  
The array is in build process.  
Optimal  
Degraded  
Dead  
Building  
Verify  
Rebuild  
-
-
-
The array is in verify process.  
The array is in rebuild process.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-31  
When you select the array on Main Menu, the detailed information of the hard disk drives in array is  
displayed.  
Detailed indications  
ID  
Type  
-
-
Indicates SCSI ID of hard disk drive that configures the array  
Indicates RAID level for the array.  
Striped (R0)  
Mirrored (R1)  
Stripe/Mirror (R10)  
-
-
-
Array configured in RAID0  
Array configured in RAID1  
Array configured in RAID10 (spanning of RAID1)  
Vendor  
Product  
Size  
-
-
-
-
Indicates the manufacturer of hard disk drive.  
Indicates the model name of hard disk drive.  
Indicates the capacity of hard disk drive.  
Indicates the status of hard disk drive.  
Status  
Optimal  
Degraded  
Failed  
Building  
Verify  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Hard disk drive is normally operating.  
Hard disk drive is being degraded.  
Hard disk drive is being failed.  
Hard disk drive is being built.  
Hard disk drive is being verified.  
Hard disk drive is being rebuilt.  
Hard disk drive is being hidden from controller.  
Replaced  
Missing  
Exiting the Utility  
To exit the utility, press Esc until the following message prompts you to exit. Select [Yes] to exit  
and press any key to restart the computer. The change you have made becomes valid after the  
system restarts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-32 Configuring Your Server  
RAID Configuration by SCSISelect Utility  
Creating Arrays  
Take the following procedures to create an array.  
Requirements  
Before creating arrays, make sure the disks for the array are connected and installed in your system.  
1. Start the SCSISelect Utility.  
Select [Configure/View HostRAID Settings] from Options menu of the channel to create  
an array.  
2. Press C on the main menu to create an array.  
Some characters may not be displayed correctly when console redirection is used. It is no  
problem on operation. Ignore it and press C.  
IMPORTANT:  
At least two hard disk drives are required to create an array.  
If the hard disk drives of different capacities are used, the array  
capacity is determined according to the smaller one.  
Use only the hard disk drives supported by the server.  
The hard disk drive which has been configured as an array disk  
drive cannot be selected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-33  
3. Select an RAID type in [Select RAID Type] window and press Enter.  
Put a cursor to the selected item, another window opens indicating the minimum and  
maximum number of disks to create an array and a message for assigning a spare disk.  
NOTE: For setting of RAID, see "Creating RAID0 Array" or  
"Creating RAID1 Array" described later.  
IMPORTANT: After creating an array, set the boot priority for the  
created array according to "Boot Priority".  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-34 Configuring Your Server  
Creating RAID0 Array  
To create a RAID0 array:  
1. Select [RAID-0] on [Select RAID Type] window.  
2. Use the cursor key to move the focus to the desired hard disk drive and determine it by  
Space, and then press Enter.  
An [X] mark is placed next to the selected hard disk drive.  
3. Select the desired stripe size and press Enter. Available stripe sizes are 16, 32, and 64  
KB.  
4. Enter the desired RAID Name in [Assign RAID Name] window.  
IMPORTANT:  
RAID Name must be unique and up to 15 characters are acceptable.  
If a valid partition information or a boot block is detected in the  
selected hard disk drive, a warning message will be displayed.  
Select [Yes] to continue creating an array, [No] to terminate.  
Take sufficient care not to select the proper hard disk drive. If not,  
the data will not be restored.  
5. The message "Do you want to make this array as bootable?" to prompt you to specify the  
boot priority of the new array appears. Select [YES] to specify, or [NO] to ignore, and  
then press Enter.  
NOTE: The boot priority can be changed after the arrays have been  
created. To change priority, see "Boot Priority" described earlier.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-35  
6. Select [Yes] for the message [Create Array?] and press Enter.  
Selecting [No] terminates creating an array and returns to the main menu.  
7. Select [Yes] for the message [Are you sure?] and press Enter.  
Selecting [No] terminates creating an array and returns to the main menu.  
8. Press Esc when the message [Build Completed] is displayed to return to the main menu.  
NOTE: On the main menu, make sure that "Optimal" is indicated for  
the status of the created array.  
IMPORTANT: After creating an array, set the boot priority for the  
created array according to "Boot Priority".  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-36 Configuring Your Server  
Creating RAID1 Array  
To create a RAID1 array, perform either of the followings:  
Create a new RAID1 array.  
Migrate to RAID1 array using the data stored in an existing single disk. (Migration)  
Creating RAID1 array using the existing single hard disk drive is called "migration". In migration,  
the source hard disk drive must have been used as the boot disk in the standard SCSI connection.  
Refer to "HostRAID Setup Card" for details of migration.  
To create a RAID1 array:  
1. Select [RAID-1] on the [Select RAID Type] window.  
2. Use the cursor key to move the focus to the desired hard disk drive and determine it by  
Space, and then press Enter.  
A [X] mark is placed next to the selected hard disk drive.  
Select one of the options in [RAID-1 Build Option] window and press Enter.  
Available options are as follows:  
– Create new RAID-1:  
– Copy from (X) to (Y):  
– Copy from (Y) to (X):  
Default  
Copy data from the disk of ID X to that of ID Y.  
Copy data from the disk of ID Y to that of ID X.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-37  
IMPORTANT:  
To migrate the boot disk that contains an OS, refer to the "Migration  
in NEC Express5800 Windows".  
Make sure the copy source and copy destination. If they are  
incorrect, the data will no longer be restored.  
3. Enter the desired RAID Name in [Assign RAID Name] window.  
IMPORTANT:  
RAID Name must be unique and up to 15 characters are acceptable.  
If a valid partition information or a boot block is detected in the  
selected hard disk drive or copy target disk drive, a warning  
message will be displayed. Select [Yes] to continue creating an array,  
[No] to terminate.  
Take sufficient care not to select the proper hard disk drive or copy  
destination drive. If not, the data will not be restored.  
4. The message "Do you want to make this array as bootable?" to prompt you to specify the  
boot priority of the new array appears. Select [YES] to specify, or [NO] to ignore, and  
then press Enter.  
NOTE: The boot priority can be changed after the arrays have been  
created. To change priority, see "Boot Priority" described earlier.  
5. Select [Yes] for the message [Create Array?] and press Enter.  
Selecting [No] terminates creating an array and returns to the main menu.  
6. Select [Yes] for the message [Are you sure?] and press Enter.  
Selecting [No] terminates creating an array and returns to the main menu.  
When an array has been created, build operation starts.  
IMPORTANT: Be sure to complete the Build process. Do not stop the  
process by pressing Esc. OS detects only an array of which build  
process has been completed and its status is "Optimal". In addition, no  
OS can be installed in that array.  
7. Press Esc when the message [Build Completed] is displayed to return to the main menu.  
NOTE: On the main menu, make sure that "Optimal" is indicated for  
the status of the created array.  
IMPORTANT: After creating an array, set the boot priority for the  
created array according to "Boot Priority".  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-38 Configuring Your Server  
Creating RAID10 Array  
1. Select [RAID-10] on [Select RAID Type] window and press Enter.  
2. Use the cursor key to move the focus to the desired hard disk drive and determine it by  
Space, and then press Enter.  
An [X] mark is placed next to the selected hard disk drive.  
3. Select the desired stripe size and press Enter. Available stripe sizes are 16, 32, and 64  
KB.  
4. Enter the desired RAID Name in [Assign RAID Name] window.  
IMPORTANT:  
RAID Name must be unique and up to 15 characters are acceptable.  
If a valid partition information or a boot block is detected in the  
selected hard disk drive, a warning message will be displayed.  
Select [Yes] to continue creating an array, [No] to terminate.  
Take sufficient care not to select the proper hard disk drive. If not,  
the data will not be restored.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-39  
5. The message "Do you want to make this array as bootable?" to prompt you to specify the  
boot priority of the new array appears. Select [YES] to specify, or [NO] to ignore, and  
then press Enter.  
6. Select [Yes] for the message [Create Array?] and press Enter.  
Selecting [No] terminates creating an array and returns to the main menu.  
7. Select [Yes] for the message [Are you sure?] and press Enter.  
Selecting [No] terminates creating an array and returns to the main menu.  
8. Press Esc when the message [Build Completed] is displayed to return to the main menu.  
NOTE: The boot priority can be changed after the arrays have been  
created. To change priority, see "Boot Priority" described earlier.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-40 Configuring Your Server  
Deleting Arrays  
To delete an array:  
IMPORTANT: Back up the data in the hard disk drive of an array  
before you delete it. Otherwise, all data on the array is lost. Deleted  
arrays cannot be restored.  
1. On the main menu, move cursor to select the array you wish to delete and press Enter.  
2. Press D on the screen shown below.  
Some characters may not be displayed correctly when console redirection is used. It is no  
problem on operation. Ignore it and press D.  
3. Select [Yes] for the message [Delete Array?] and press Enter.  
Selecting [No] returns to the main menu without deleting any array.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-41  
4. <RAID0>  
[Deleting information] window appears. Select the hard disk drive you wish to delete its  
partition or boot block, or select [None], then press Enter.  
<Example>  
Drive ID 0:  
Data in drive 0 is entirely erased. Data in drive 1 is reserved.  
Data in drive 1 is entirely erased. Data in drive 0 is reserved.  
All the data in both drives is erased.  
Drive ID 1:  
Drive ID 0 & 1:  
None:  
Array is deleted, but the data is reserved in both drives.  
<Other than RAID0>  
The [Deleting information] window is not displayed, proceed to the next step.  
IMPORTANT: The partition or boot block of the hard disk drive  
selected [Deleting information] is deleted.  
5. Select [Yes] for the message [Are you sure?] and press Enter.  
Selecting [No] returns to the main menu without deleting any array.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-42 Configuring Your Server  
Creating Spare Disk  
Up to two spare disks can be assigned for one channel.  
Spare disk is available for RAID1 and RAID10 (spanning of RAID1) only.  
NOTE: Spare disk must have larger capacity than the hard disk drives  
configuring the array.  
If the hard disk drives in the array have 73GB or larger and the spare  
disk is 36GB, a 36-GB disk cannot be used as a spare disk.  
To assign a spare disk:  
1. Press S on Main Menu.  
Some characters may not be displayed correctly when console redirection is used. It is no  
problem on operation. Ignore it and press S.  
2. Select [Add Spare] on the Option window as shown below.  
3. Select a hard disk drive for spare disk from the list of available disks, and press Enter.  
4. Select [Yes] for the message [Are you sure?] and press Enter.  
Selecting [No] returns to the main menu without assigning any spare disk.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-43  
5. On the main menu, make sure that the type of selected hard disk drive is changed to  
"Spare", and its status "Optimal".  
To unassign a spare disk, take the same steps from 1 to 4 except for selecting "Delete  
Spare" instead of "Add Spare".  
Boot Priority  
To specify boot priority to an array:  
1. Select an array you wish to set the boot priority from the main menu and press Enter.  
2. Press B on the window showing the details of array.  
Some characters may not be displayed correctly when console redirection is used. It is no  
problem on operation. Ignore it and press B.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-44 Configuring Your Server  
CONFIGURING MOTHER BOARD JUMPERS  
With the pre-installed SETUP utility, you can set desired passwords to protect the data stored in the  
server against access from unauthorized users. When you forget the passwords, however, you may  
want clear them. The following describes how to clear these passwords. You can also use the  
following procedure to clear the CMOS data in the server.  
IMPORTANT:  
Clearing the CMOS data resumes the factory-set configuration data.  
After clearing CMOS, you must run the BIOS SETUP utility and  
execute the following menus to reconfigure your mother board.  
– Load Setup Defaults in the Exit menu  
– Memory Retest of Memory Configuration in the Advanced menu  
– Processor Retest of Processor Settings in the Main menu  
To clear passwords or the CMOS data, use the jumper switch on the mother board of the server.  
The following figure illustrates the jumper switch location.  
IMPORTANT: Do not change any other switch settings. Any  
change may cause the server to fail or malfunction.  
: Strapped  
JBAT1  
Protect  
Pin for protecting/  
Clear  
clearing the CMOS contents  
1 2 3  
J7  
Protect  
Clear  
Pin for protecting/  
clearing the password  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Your Server 4-45  
The following describe the clearing procedure.  
WARNING  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may result in death or serious personal injury. See pages  
1-3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not disassemble, repair, or alter the server.  
Do not remove the lithium battery.  
Do not connect the ground line to a gas pipe.  
CAUTION  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may result in death or serious personal injury. See pages 1-  
3 to 1-8 for details.  
Never attempt to lift the server only by yourself.  
Make sure to complete board installation.  
Do not install the server on a rack with leaving covers removed.  
Do not pinch your finger with mechanical components.  
Note high temperature.  
Do not pull out a device from the rack if the rack is unstable.  
Do not leave more than one device being pulled out from the rack.  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" as described in Chapter 9 of this  
guide to prepare.  
2. Remove the logic cover.  
3. Locate the position of the jumpers on the mother board you are changing.  
4. For clearing the BIOS password, remove the jumper strap on the BIOS password clear  
jumper. For Clearing the CMOS, move the jumper strap to the CMOS clear position.  
Refer to the previous illustration to find the location of the jumper.  
5. Wait for a while (about 5 seconds), and then reinstall the jumper block to the default  
position.  
6. Reinstall the server removed in Step 2.  
7. Plug the power cord to your server and turn on the server.  
8. Press F2 at the prompt to run the BIOS SETUP utility, and select "Load Setup Defaults"  
at the Exit menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-46 Configuring Your Server  
(This page is intentionally left blank.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5  
Installing the Operating System with Express  
Setup  
This section describes information on using Express Setup to install and configure the following  
operating systems to the server.  
Microsoft® Windows Server2003 R2 Standard Edition / Microsoft® Windows  
Server2003 R2 Enterprise Edition / Microsoft® Windows Server2003 Standard  
Edition / Microsoft® Windows Server2003 Enterprise Edition  
Microsoft® Windows® 2000 Server / Microsoft® Windows® 2000 Advanced Server  
To use the server with the other operating systems described in this section, contact your service  
representative.  
IMPORTANT: Before installing the operating system, adjust the  
system date and time by using the BIOS setup utility "SETUP." See  
Chapter 4 for detail.  
This chapter also includes information on configuring the HostRAID™ drive.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-2 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
About Express Setup  
"Express Setup" helps you to install the Windows Operating System.  
The setup automatically configures the RAID system and installs the Operating System and some  
management software.  
IMPORTANT: Executing the Express Setup erases all data on the  
hard disk drive.  
You can also use "Configuration disk" at "Express Setup" in order to save or backup parameters for  
installation.  
The Configuration disk is able to have some parameters files that include the configuration  
information for the server setup.  
If you want to set up the server as before, execute the Express Setup with the parameters file you  
have saved before.  
NOTES:  
The parameters file is not mandatory to set up the system.  
If you want to create a parameters file, have a blank floppy  
disk(MS-DOS 1.44MB format) ready.  
If you want to use the drivers located on the "OEM-Disk for Mass  
Storage Device" that ships with optional boards, a parameters file  
is mandatory.  
You can create a parameters file in advance using "Configuration  
Diskette Creator" included in NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-3  
Microsoft Windows Server 2003  
This subsection provides information on installing Microsoft® Windows Server2003 in the  
Server. Read instruction in this section before proceeding the installation.  
NOTES:  
Express Setup does not support the installation of Windows Server  
2003 x64 Editions. If you want to install it, see Appendix D.  
If you install Windows Server 2003 without using Express Setup,  
see Appendix E.  
Installation Notice  
This section explains precautions and matters you should be aware of before beginning installation  
in order to install Windows Server 2003 correctly.  
Supported OS on this model  
The server supports the following edition:  
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 Standard Edition / Microsoft Windows Server 2003  
R2 Enterprise Edition / Microsoft Windows Server 2003 Standard Edition / Microsoft  
Windows Server 2003 Enterprise Edition (hereinafter, referred to as "Windows Server  
2003")  
On installing other OS, contact sales dealer or the maintenance service representative.  
BIOS Settings  
Before installing Windows Server 2003, confirm if the BIOS settings are correct.  
See Chapter 4 to confirm the settings.  
NEC ESMPRO Agent  
NEC ESMPRO Agent requires to install the necras.sys driver on your Windows system.  
If you install the Windows without using the Express Setup, run the "Update Express5800 system"  
in Master Control Menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-4 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Optional Board Supported by NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM attached to your system supports the following optional  
boards;  
NOTE: If you want to install the other boards by using a driver floppy  
disk ("OEM-FD for Mass storage device"), except ones listed below,  
see "Exceptional setup" and "Installing Optional Mass Storage Driver"  
of "Configuration Diskette Creator" in Chapter 6.  
Supporting installation of OS in NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
– N8103-80F Disk Array Controller (SCSI 1ch)  
– N8103-81F Disk Array Controller (SCSI 2ch)  
– N8103-86 Disk Array Controller (0ch)  
– N8103-91 Disk array controller (Internal SAS HDD)  
– Adaptec HostRAID(SCSI) (Controller on the I/O board)  
Other optional boards  
– N8103-56 SCSI Controller  
– N8103-65F SCSI Controller  
– N8103-75 SCSI Controller  
– N8103-95 SCSI Controller  
– N8190-126 SCSI Controller  
[In case of use of N8103-91]  
In use of N8103-91, please surely install Windows Server 2003 ServicePack 1 by  
Windows Server 2003.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-5  
Windows Server 2003  
Express Setup can install Windows Server 2003 operating system. Confirm below notes before  
installing the Windows.  
IMPORTANT:  
Before starting the installation, complete all the process of adding  
the optional device and the setup of Express server mainframe  
(BIOS and optional board specification)  
The document for installing Windows Server 2003 is also attached  
to the other software package which is sold separately from NEC,  
but refer to this document when you install Windows Server 2003  
on this model.  
After completing Express Setup, see "Setup for Solving Problems"  
described later to specify the settings for trouble recovery such as  
"Specifying Memory Dump".  
Installing on the Mirrored Volume  
If you want to install Windows Server 2003 on the volume that is mirrored using "Disk  
Management", invalid the mirroring before operating the installation to set back to the basic disk,  
and valid the mirroring again after the installation has completed.  
Creating, invalid, delete mirror volume can be operated from "Disk Management" in "Computer  
Management".  
Connecting MO Device  
If you operate installing Windows Server 2003 with MO device connected, the installation may not  
be completed normally. In such case, detach MO device and then re-install the system from the  
beginning.  
Media such as DAT  
During the OS installation, do not attach the unnecessary media for OS installation to the system,  
such as DAT.  
Connecting Hard Disk Drive  
Connect the hard disk drive that OS is not going to be installed after installing OS.  
If you create multiple logical drives in your system, refer to "Re-installing the operation system  
when multiple logical drives exist" (Appendix D).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-6 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Creating Partition Size  
The size for the partition that the system is to be installed can be calculated from the following  
formula.  
Size necessary to install the system + Paging File Size + Dump File Size  
+ Application Size  
Size necessary to install the system = 2900MB (Only Windows Server 2003)  
3500MB (Windows Server 2003 with Service  
Pack1)  
4400MB (Windows Server 2003 + Service Pack1  
CD-ROM)  
Paging File Size (Recommended) = Mounted Memory Size * 1.5  
Dump file Size  
Application Size  
= Mounted Memory Size + 12MB  
= Required Size  
IMPORTANT:  
The above-mentioned paging file size is recommended for  
collecting debug information (memory dump). The paging file  
with initial size large enough to store the dump file in the boot  
drive is required.  
Correct debug information might not be able to be collected due to  
virtual memory shortage when the paging file is insufficient, so set  
an enough size of the paging file with the entire system.  
The maximum paging file size which can be set on one partition is  
4095MB. If the above paging file size exceeds 4095MB, specify  
4095MB for the paging file size.  
The maximum dump file size for the system with more than 2GB  
memory mounted is '2048MB + 12MB'.  
If you install any application program or the like, add necessary  
space to the partition to install these programs.  
For example, if the mounted memory size is 512MB, the partition size will be calculated by the  
above formula as follows:  
2900MB + (512MB * 1.5) + (512MB + 12MB) + Application Size  
= 4192MB + Application Size  
Dividing into the partition of the recommended size into multiple disks as written below will solve  
problem that it cannot be reserved in one disk.  
1. Set the "Size required for installation + Paging file size".  
2. See Chapter 5 and set that debugging information (equivalent to the dump file size) is to  
be written to a separate disk.  
(If the disk does not have enough free space to enable the dump file size to be written,  
then after installing the system using the "Size required for installation + Paging file size",  
install an additional new disk.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-7  
Re-installing to the hard disk which has been upgraded to Dynamic Disk  
You cannot re-install Windows Server 2003 with the current partition of the hard disk drive  
upgraded to Dynamic Disk kept remained.  
If you want to keep the current partition remained, see Appendix D to re-install the system.  
About Maintenance Partition (the area displayed as "MAINTE_P")  
The maintenance partition for server maintenance is reserved in the head of Hard Disk Drive (a  
partition of approximately 55MB).  
This area is for saving some maintenance utilities.  
Do not delete the maintenance partition.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-8 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
The Flow of Setup  
This section shows the flow of the Express setup.  
: Process that proceeds automatically  
: Process that needs to input or select  
Do you want to use the parameters file in order to set up  
the Express server ?  
Yes  
Read notes and restrictions  
No  
Confirmed  
Insert floppy disk into the floppy disk drive  
Confirmed  
Confirmed  
New File  
(Select Setup Parameter File)  
Existing File  
Checking the Setup Parameter File  
Correct  
Skipped  
Select whether or not to confirm/modify the setting  
Confirmed  
Disk Array Configuration Dialogue-box appears  
Creating Maintenance Partition and Installing Utilities  
Operating System Installation Menu appears  
Creating a working partition  
Confirm Setup File Create New File  
Choose the Windows category  
No Floppy Disk  
In case [Skip] is selected  
Confirm or input parameters for the Windows installation  
Remove the Floppy Disk and CD-ROM  
from the Drive  
Copying NEC Modules  
Copying Selected Application Modules  
Insert Windows CD-ROM  
Agree Software License Agreement  
Insert SP CD-ROM  
(If you selected [Yes] on [Apply Service Pack].)  
Install OS Automatically  
Log on Automatically  
After restarting the computer, the  
installation is completed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-9  
Installing the Windows Server 2003  
Express Setup proceeds the setup by specifying the necessary information on the wizard. You can  
also save the setup information created on the wizard in a floppy disk as a setup file.  
NOTE: Prepare a floppy disk to use as Configuration Disk if you  
want to save the parameters or use the drivers located on the "OEM-  
Disk for Mass Storage Device" that ships with optional boards. When  
using the floppy disk, the Express setup can continue the setup  
without specifying the parameters.  
1. Turn the power of peripheral device on, and then turn on the server.  
NOTES:  
If you operate installing Windows Server 2003 with MO device  
connected, the installation may not be completed normally. In such  
case, detach MO device and then re-install the system from the  
beginning.  
Install the OS before connecting another hard disk drive.  
If you create multiple logical drives in your system, refer to  
"Reinstalling the operation system when multiple logical drives  
exist" (Appendix D).  
2. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of the server.  
3. Press Ctrl, Alt, and Delete to reboot from the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
The system boots from the CD-ROM and NEC EXPRESSBUILDER starts.  
4. Click [Express Setup].  
5. The message, "Do you want to use the parameters file in order to set up the Express server  
or workstation ?", appears.  
If you want to use the parameters file, click [Yes].  
If not, click [No].  
6. "NOTE" appears. Click [Confirm] after reading that.  
NOTE: If some operating system has been installed on the hard disk  
drive already, the message which asks if you continue the installation  
appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-10 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
7. If you select "Yes" at step 5, place a floppy disk into the floppy disk drive mounted on the  
server.  
If not, go on the next step.  
NOTE: If you set the floppy disk at this step, do not remove the  
floppy disk from the server until the message as removing the floppy  
disk appears.  
[Using the existing Configuration Disk]  
The parameters files in the floppy disk is listed in dialogue-box.  
1) Select a parameters file to use in the Express Setup.  
After the parameters file is specified, the message "Do you want to review or modify  
the Setup File parameters?" appears.  
2) If you want to modify or confirm the parameters file, click [Review]. If not, click  
[Skip].  
Click [Review] Go on the next step.  
Click [Skip] Go on the step 9.  
NOTE: If you do not use disk array controller, go on the step 9. After  
that, the dialog-box appears.  
[Using a blank disk]  
1) Click the box under [Setup File Name: (A)] or press A.  
The dialog box appears.  
2) Input the file name and click [Use].  
8. Confirm or modify the parameters of disk array configuration.  
NOTE: If you do not use disk array controller, go on the next step.  
If a Disk array controller is connected to the server or the HostRAID is enabled, the  
[Configure RAID] dialogue-box appears. Confirm the parameters, modify if necessary,  
and then click [OK].  
When the dialogue-box is closed, the Express setup automatically performs the RAID  
configuration, creating Maintenance partition and installing several utilities.  
9. Select the installing Operating system.  
Select "Windows" from the menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-11  
10. Select the Windows family.  
Select "Microsoft Windows Server 2003 Standard Edition Microsoft Windows Server  
2003 Enterprise Edition" category.  
NOTE: If you select "Skip" at step 8, this menu does not appear.  
Go on the step 13.  
11. Next, [Basic Information] wizard appears. Confirm the parameters, modify if necessary,  
and then click [Next].  
After that, click [Next], [Back], or [Help] on the screen to continue. Modify the  
parameters each time if necessary.  
IMPORTANT:  
Reserve the partition to install the OS more than the minimally  
required size.  
If you select "Use Existing Array" at "New/Existing RAID  
Configuration", the information included in the first partition  
(excluding maintenance partition) will all be formatted and deleted.  
The information included in the other partition will be retained.  
In the figure below, describes the partition which information will  
be deleted when maintenance partition exists.  
First Partition  
<Maintenance Partition>  
Retained  
Second  
Partition  
Deleted  
Third  
Partition  
Retained Retained  
Fourth  
Partition  
You can not re-install the system with the existing partition that is  
upgraded to Dynamic Disk remained. Do not select "Use  
Existing Array" at "New/Existing RAID Configuration".  
If you specify other than 4095MB for the "Installing Partition", it  
is necessary to convert to NTFS.  
If "Use Existing Array" at "New/Existing RAID Configuration" is  
selected but the partition other than the one to install Windows  
Server 2003 does not exist (excluding maintenance partition),  
Express Setup will reserve the maximum area of the hard disk  
drive to install Windows Server 2003.  
You can not go to the next screen if the specification is incorrect.  
NOTES:  
If you click [Cancel] in [Basic Information] screen, the screen will  
go back to select the OS. [Cancel] exists only in [Basic  
Information] screen.  
If you click [OK] in [Role of Computer] screen, the setup  
automatically selects default value for the later specification to  
continue the installation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-12 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
12. Copy the modules for the optional mass storage driver.  
If you want to install the optional mass storage driver, insert the floppy disk attached to  
mass storage driver into the floppy disk drive and follow the message to operate the  
installation.  
NOTE: This function requires mounting a floppy disk drive on your  
server.  
13. Remove the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive according to  
the message.  
If you proceed the setup by using setup parameter file, remove the floppy disk from the  
floppy disk drive.  
Insert Windows Server 2003 CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
[Agree Software License Agreement] screen appears.  
14. Read the contents carefully and click [I agree.] or press F8 if you do agree. If you do not  
agree, click [I disagree] or press F3.  
IMPORTANT:  
If you do not agree to this agreement, the setup terminates and  
Windows Server 2003 will not be installed.  
If "NetWare Gateway (and Client) Service" is specified to install,  
the window to specify the details of "NetWare Gateway (and  
Client) Service" pops up on the first logon. Specify the  
appropriate value.  
15. If you selected [Yes] on [Apply Service Pack] at Basic Information, follow the procedure  
below.  
1) Follow the message to take Windows Server 2003 CD-ROM out of the CD-ROM  
drive.  
2) Follow the message to insert Windows Server 2003 Service Pack 1 or later into the  
CD-ROM drive.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-13  
NOTE: About MegaRAID Storage Manager (hereinafter, refered to as  
"MSM")  
When N8103-91 board is connected, Windows Server 2003 Service  
Pack 1 or later is necessary to install MSM. When you try to install  
MSM, and the setting of whether to apply Service Pack is [No], the  
following message will be displayed during the Express Setup.  
Service Pack 1 or later is necessary  
to continue the installation of MSM  
(MegaRAID Storage Manager).  
Apply the Service Pack ?  
* If you click [No], MSM will not be installed.  
[YES]  
[NO]  
If you click [YES], Windows Server 2003 Service Pack 1 and MSM  
will be installed.  
If you click [NO], MSM will not be installed. If you change the  
setting of whether to apply Service Pack or not by this message after  
you agreed the Software License Agreement, this change (the setting  
of whether to install MSM and Service Pack or not) is not reflected in  
the parameter file.  
Windows Server 2003 and the specified application will be installed automatically and  
logon to the system. Install and configure the device drivers.  
16. If you install Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2, insert Microsoft Windows Server 2003  
R2 Standard Edition DISC 2 or Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 Enterprise Edition  
DISC 2 into the CD-ROM drive after the OS installation.  
Hereinafter, proceed operations according to the message.  
When the installation has finished, remove Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 Standard  
Edition DISC 2 or Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 Enterprise Edition DISC 2 from  
the CD-ROM drive, and restart the system.  
Now the Setup using Express Setup has completed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-14 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Installing and Setting Device Drivers  
Follow these steps to install and configure the device drivers.  
PROSet  
PROSet is a utility that confirms the function of network contained in network driver.  
Utilizing PROSet enables the following items:  
Confirm detailed information of the adapter.  
Diagnose loop back test, packet transmission test and so on.  
Setup of teaming.  
Configuring several network adapters as one team provides the server a tolerant environment on any  
trouble and enhance throughput between the switches.  
PROSet is necessary to utilize these features.  
Follow the procedure below to install PROSet.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
2. The [Windows Explorer] dialog starts.  
* The procedure in the case of the standard start menu  
Click Start menu and click [Windows Explorer].  
* The procedure in the case of the classic start menu  
Click Start menu, point to [Programs], [Accessories] and click [Windows Explorer].  
3. Run "PROSET.EXE" in the following directory.  
<CD-ROM DriveLetter>:\WINNT\DOTNET\BC5\PROSET\WS03XP32  
The [Intel(R) PROSet - InstallShield Wizard] dialog starts.  
4. Click [Next].  
5. Choose "I accept the terms in the license agreement" and click [Next].  
6. Choose "Typical" and click [Next].  
7. Click [Install].  
8. When [InstallShield Wizard Completed] window is displayed, click [Finish].  
9. Restart the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-15  
Network Driver  
Specify the details of network driver.  
One standard network driver that is mounted will be installed automatically, but the link speed and  
Duplex mode need to be specified manually.  
[When PROSet is not installed]  
1. The [Local Area Connection Properties] dialog box appears.  
* The procedure in the case of the standard start menu  
1. Click Start menu, Click [Control Panel], Click [Network Connections], and Click  
[Local Area Connection].  
* The procedure in the case of the classic start menu  
1. Click Start menu, Click [Settings] and Click [Network Connections].  
The [Network Connections] dialog box appears.  
2. Right-click [Local Area Connection] and click [Properties] from pop-up menu.  
2. Click [Configure].  
The property dialog box for network adapter appears.  
3. Click the [Advanced] and specify the [Link Speed & Duplex] value the same as the value  
specified for HUB.  
4. Click [OK] on the property dialog box for network adapter.  
[When PROSet is installed]  
1. The [Intel(R) PROSet for Wired Connections] dialog box appears.  
* The procedure in the case of the standard start menu  
Click Start menu, point to [Control Panel] and click [Intel(R) PROSet Wired].  
* The procedure in the case of the classic start menu  
1. Click Start menu, point to [Settings] and click [Control Panel].  
2. Double-click [Intel(R) PROSet Wired] on the [Control Panel] window.  
2. Click [(Network Adapter Name)] in the list.  
3. Click the [Speed] and specify the [Link Speed & Duplex Settings] value the same as the  
value specified for HUB.  
4. Click [Apply] and click [OK].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-16 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Also, add or delete any protocols and services if necessary.  
You can operate the process on the property dialog box for local area network which can be  
appeared from [Network and Dial-up Connection].  
NOTE: We recommend you to add [Network Monitor] at [Adding  
Services]. [Network Monitor] can monitor the frame (or the  
packet)that the computer installing [Network Monitor] sends or  
receives. This tool is valuable when analyzing network trouble. For  
information on how to install the tool, see the "Setting for Solving  
Problems" described later in this chapter.  
Optional Network Board Driver  
If you want to utilize optional Network Board (N8104-86/88/111/103/109/112/113/115), install the  
driver stored in NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM.  
In case of utilizing (N8104-86/88/111)  
"<CD-ROM Drive Letter>:\WINNT\DOTNET\BC5\PRO100\WS03XP32"  
In case of utilizing (N8104-103/109/112/113/115)  
"<CD-ROM Drive Letter>:\WINNT\DOTNET\BC5\PRO1000\WS03XP32"  
If the procedure of installation is not clear, refer to the installation procedure described in the  
section "Installation of the Optional Network Board Driver".  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-17  
Installation of the Optional Network Board Driver  
1. Start Device Manager.  
2. Click [Network adapters] and Double-Click [(Network Adapter Name)].  
[(Network Adapter Name) Properties] appears.  
NOTE: [(Intel(R) PRO/1000...)] is the name of On-Board adapter.  
All other names show the Optional Network Board.  
3. Click [Driver] tab and click [Update Driver...]. [Hardware Update Wizard] appears.  
4. Select the [Install from a list or specific location(Advanced)] radio button and click  
[Next].  
5. Select the [Search for the best driver in these locations] radio button and check off the  
[Search removable media (floppy, CD-ROM...)] check box.  
6. Check the [Include this location in the search] check box and when using [(N8104-  
86/88/111)], specify  
[<CD-ROM driveletter>:\WINNT\DOTNET\BC5\PRO100\WS03XP32].  
And when using [(N8104-103/109/112/113/115)], specify  
[<CD-ROM driveletter>:\WINNT\DOTNET\BC5\PRO1000\WS03XP32].  
Then click [Next].  
7. Click [Finish].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-18 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Adapter Fault Tolerance (AFT)/Adaptive Load Balancing (ALB)  
Adapter Fault Tolerance (AFT) is a feature that creates a group containing more than one adapter  
and automatically converts the process of the working adapter to the other adapter in the group  
when any trouble occurred on that adapter.  
Adaptive Load Balancing (ALB) is a feature that creates a group containing more than one adapter  
and enhance the through put by operating packet transmission from the server by all the adapters.  
This feature includes AFT feature.  
IMPORTANT:  
AFT/ALB setup must be operated after installing the drivers and  
restarting the system.  
All the adapters specified as a group of Adapter Teaming must  
exist on the same LAN. If they are connected to the separate  
switches, they will not work normally.  
If you want to utilize AFT/ALB feature, follow the procedure below to setup.  
1. Double-click [Intel(R) PROSet Wired] on the [Control Panel] dialog box.  
The [Intel(R) PROSet Wired] dialog box appears.  
2. Put the mouse cursor on "Intel(R) PRO/1000 MT Dual Port Network Connection" in the  
list and right-click.  
Pull-down menu appears.  
3. Select [Add to Team>] and then click [Create New Team...].  
The [Teaming Wizard] dialog box appears.  
4. Select "Adapter Fault Tolerance" or "Adaptive Load Balancing" and click [Next].  
5. Check the adapter to join the team and click [Next].  
6. Click [Finish].  
7. The setup will go back to [Intel(R) PROSet for Wired Connections] dialog box, so click  
[OK].  
8. Restart the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-19  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-65F)  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-65F), install it according to the following procedure:  
1. Start [Device Manager] from [Start] menu [Control Panel][Administrative Tools] →  
[Computer Management].  
2. Double-click the SCSI Controller driver which Device Manager lists as Other device.  
3. Click [Update Driver].  
4. When the "Update Device Driver Wizard" appears, select "Install from a list or specific  
location [Advanced]" and click [Next].  
5. Select "Don't search. I will choose the driver to install" and click [Next].  
6. Click [Have Disk..].  
7. Insert "Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy  
disk drive, enter "a:\" into "copy manufacturer's file from:" and click [OK].  
8. Specify the following driver and click [Next].  
[INITIO INI-A10XU2W PCI SCSI Controller] (When N8103-65F board is installed.)  
The installation of the driver is completed.  
Restart the system according to the message appeared on the screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-20 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-75)  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-75), install it according to the following procedure:  
<In the case of use of Windows Server 2003 SevicePack1 or Windows Server 2003  
R2>  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-75), update your system with NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM attached to your system.  
The SCSI controller driver will be installed automatically.  
<In the case of Windows Server 2003 which has not installed SevicePack1>  
1. Start [Device Manager] from [Start] menu [Control Panel] [Administrative Tools]→  
[Computer Management].  
2. Double-click the SCSI Controller driver which Device Manager lists as Other device.  
3. Click [Update Driver].  
4. When the "Update Device Driver Wizard" appears, select "Install from a list or specific  
location [Advanced]" and click [Next].  
5. Select "Don't search. I will choose the driver to install" and click [Next].  
6. Click [Have Disk..].  
7. Insert "Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy  
disk drive, enter "a:\" into "copy manufacturer's file from:" and click [OK].  
8. Specify the following driver and click [Next].  
[Adaptec SCSI Card 29320ALP -Ultra320 SCSI] (When N8103-75 board is installed.)  
The installation of the driver is completed.  
Restart the system according to the message appeared on the screen.  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-56/-95/N8190-126)  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-56/95 or N8190-126), update your system with NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM attached to your system.  
The SCSI controller driver will be installed automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-21  
Installing Disk Array Controller Driver (N8103-80F/81F)  
To additionally install the N8103-80F/81F in a system containing Windows Server 2003, connect  
the controller and take the following steps to install the driver:  
<In the case of use of Windows Server 2003 SevicePack1 or Windows Server 2003  
R2>  
1. Start [Device Manager] from [Start] menu [Control Panel] [Administrative Tools]  
[Computer Management].  
2. Double-click [LSI Logic Megaraid SCSI 320-1/2] which Device Manager lists.  
3. Click the [Driver] tab and click [Update Driver...].  
4. When the "Update Device Driver Wizard" appears, select "Install from a list or specific  
location [Advanced]" and click [Next].  
5. Select the "Search for the best driver in these locations." and check the "Search removable  
media [floppy, CD-ROM...]" check box.  
6. Insert "Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy  
disk drive, and click [Next].  
7. Copying of the driver is completed, and the [Completing the Hardware Update Wizard]  
dialog box below appears. Click [Finish].  
<In the case of Windows Server 2003 which has not installed SevicePack1>  
1. Start [Device Manager] from [Start] menu [Control Panel] [Administrative Tools]  
[Computer Management].  
2. Double-click the SCSI Controller driver which Device Manager lists as Other device.  
3. Click the [Driver] tab and click [Update Driver...].  
4. When the "Update Device Driver Wizard" appears, select "Install from a list or specific  
location [Advanced]" and click [Next].  
5. Select the "Search for the best driver in these locations." and check the "Search removable  
media [floppy, CD-ROM...]" check box.  
6. Insert "Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy  
disk drive, and click [Next].  
7. Copying of the driver is completed, and the [Completing the Hardware Update Wizard]  
dialog box below appears. Click [Finish].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-22 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Graphics Accelerator Driver  
Standard graphics accelerator drivers that are mounted will be installed automatically.  
The following is the procedure when it is necessary to install manually.  
If you want to utilize optional Graphics Accelerator Driver board, follow the document attached to  
the board to install the driver.  
*
For the graphics accelerator driver, the use of a remote KVM console that installs the advanced  
N8115-02 remote management card is supported by the standard.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
2. Click Start menu, point to [Programs], [Accessories] and click [Windows Explorer]  
3. Run "SETUP.EXE" in the following directory.  
<CD-ROM Drive Letter>:\WINNT\DOTNET\VIDEO\SETUP.EXE  
4. Follow the message to continue the installation.  
5. Remove the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive, follow the  
direction on the screen and restart the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-23  
Available switch options for Windows Server 2003 Boot.ini file.  
Many different switches will be available if you edit Boot.ini file.  
For the available switch options, refer to the following information:  
Microsoft Knowledge Base - Article ID: 833721  
"Available switch options for the Windows XP and the Windows Server 2003 Boot.ini  
files"  
If your system has a memory capacity in excess of 4GB in its installing, adding /PAE switch in  
Boot.ini file will enable the system to be installed with over 4GB of memory.  
However, the Microsoft operating system products which support /PAE switch option are limited.  
Refer to the following article in Microsoft Knowledge Base to check the supported products.  
Microsoft Knowledge Base - Article ID: 291988  
"A description of the 4GB RAM tuning feature and the Physical Address Extension  
switch"  
Below is the example on how to add /PAE switch to Boot.ini file.  
1. Click [Start], point to [Settings], and then click [Control Panel].  
2. In [Control Panel], double-click [System].  
3. Click the [Advanced] tab, and then click [Settings] under [Setup and Recovery].  
4. Under [System Setup], click [Edit] to open [Boot.ini].  
5. Add "/PAE" to [Operating Systems] section in [Boot.ini] file, and then save it.  
<Example of Boot.ini file>  
[boot loader]  
timeout=30  
default=multi(0)disk(0)rdisk(0)partition(2)\WINDOWS  
[operating systems]  
multi(0)disk(0)rdisk(0)partition(2)\WINDOWS="Windows Server 2003" /fastdetect  
multi(0)disk(0)rdisk(0)partition(2)\WINDOWS="Windows Server 2003, PAE" /fastdetect  
/PAE  
C:\CMDCONS\BOOTSECT.DAT="Microsoft Windows Recovery Console" /cmdcons  
This is the end of editing Boot.ini file.  
NOTE: If you choose one of the items in the "Default operating  
system" drop-down list box in [Setup and Recovery] group box, you  
can make your system start automatically from the switch you  
specified.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-24 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Setting for Solving Problems  
Setup the following issue in advance so that your computer can recover from any trouble precisely  
and as soon as possible when it should occur.  
Memory Dump (Debug Information)  
This section describes the procedures for collecting memory dump (debug information) in the  
server.  
IMPORTANT: Cautions for the Memory Dump  
The staff of maintenance service representative is in charge of  
collecting memory dump. Customers need only to specify the  
memory dump.  
If any trouble occur after specifying the process below, the  
message to inform that the system is in short of virtual memory  
may appear, but continue to start the system. If you restart the  
system in such case, memory dump may not be stored correctly.  
Follow the procedure below to specify.  
1. Select [Control Panel] and click [System].  
The [System Properties] dialog box appears.  
2. Select [Advanced] tab.  
3. Click [Settings] on the [Startup and Recovery] group box.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-25  
IMPORTANT:  
Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
To specify "Complete Memory Dump" to write the debug  
information is recommended.  
If the mounted memory size is larger than 2GB, "Complete  
Memory Dump" cannot be specified so that specify "Kernel  
Memory Dump" instead.  
Specify the drive where there is a free area more than the size of  
"the memory capacity mounted on Express server + 1MB".  
In case the mounted memory size exceeds 2GB due to the added  
memory, change the write debugging information to [Kernel  
Memory Dump] before adding memory. The size of debugging  
information (memory dump) to be taken also changes due to  
adding memory. Verify the size of the empty space in the  
debugging information (memory dump) write destination drive.  
Windows Server 2003  
To specify "Complete Memory Dump" to write the debug  
information is recommended.  
If the mounted memory size is larger than 2GB, "Complete  
Memory Dump" cannot be specified so that specify "Kernel  
Memory Dump" instead.  
Specify the drive where there is a free area more than the size of  
"the memory capacity mounted on Express server + 12MB"  
(In case the memory capacity is more than 2GB, a free area of  
"2048+12MB" or more).  
In case the mounted memory size exceeds 2GB due to the added  
memory, change the write debugging information to [Kernel  
Memory Dump] before adding memory. The size of debugging  
information (memory dump) to be taken also changes due to  
adding memory. Verify the size of the empty space in the  
debugging information (memory dump) write destination drive.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-26 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
4. Specify "Complete memory dump" and modify [Dump file:] in the [Write debugging  
information] group box.  
e.g. Write the debug information in D drive write the file name "MEMORY.DMP".  
D:\MEMORY.DMP  
5. Click [Settings] on the [Performance] group box.  
The [Performance Options] window appears.  
6. Click [Advanced] tab on the [Performance Options] window.  
7. Click [Change] on the [Virtual memory] group box.  
8. Modify [Initial Size] in the [Paging file size for selected drive] box to the value larger than  
[Recommended], and click [Set].  
IMPORTANT:  
The above-mentioned paging file size is recommended for  
collecting debug information (memory dump).  
The paging file with initial size large enough to store the dump file  
in the boot drive is required.  
Correct debug information might not be able to be collected due to  
virtual memory shortage when the paging file is insufficient, so set  
an enough size of the paging file with the entire system.  
For more information on "Recommended" value, see "Partition  
Size to be Created" described earlier.  
In case the memory is expanded, re-specify the paging file to suit  
the new memory size.  
9. Click [OK].  
The message to restart the system may appear according to the modified specification.  
In such case, follow the message to restart the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-27  
Windows Dr. Watson  
Windows Dr. Watson is a debugger for application errors. If any application error is detected, Dr.  
Watson diagnoses the server and logs diagnostic information (log). Follow the procedure below  
and specify Dr. Watson to collect diagnostic information.  
1. Click [Run] on Start menu.  
2. Type "drwtsn32.exe" in the [Open] box, and click [OK].  
The [Dr. Watson for Windows] dialog box appears.  
3. Specify the location to store the diagnostic information in the [Log File Path] box.  
The diagnostic information will be stored with the file name "DRWTSN32.LOG".  
NOTE: You can not specify network pass. Specify the pass on local  
computer.  
4. Specify the location of crash dump file in the [Crash Dump] box.  
NOTE: "Crash Dump File" is a binary file that can be read with  
Windows Debugger.  
5. Check the following check box on the [Option] box.  
Dump Symbol Table  
Dump All Thread Contexts  
Add To Existing Log File  
Create Crash Dump File  
For more information on each function above, refer to Online Help.  
6. Click [OK].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-28 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Network Monitor  
Utilizing Network Monitor helps you to investigate and manage with network trouble. To utilize  
Network Monitor, you need to restart the system after the installation has completed, so we  
recommend to install Network Monitor before any network trouble may occur.  
1. Point to [Settings] from Start menu and click [Control Panel].  
The [Control Panel] dialog box appears.  
2. Double-click [Add/Remove Programs].  
The [Add/Remove Programs] dialog box appears.  
3. Click [Add/Remove Windows Component].  
The [Windows Components Wizard] dialog box appears.  
4. Check the [Management and Monitoring Tools] check box of the component ON and click  
[Next].  
5. If the setup asks to install the disk, insert Windows Server 2003 CD-ROM into CD-ROM  
drive and click [OK].  
6. Click [Complete] in the [Windows Component Wizard] dialog box.  
7. Click [Close] in the [Add/Remove Application] dialog box.  
8. Close the [Control Panel] dialog box.  
To start Network Monitor, point to [Program] [Administrative Tools] and click [Network  
Monitor]. For information on how to operate Network Monitor, refer to Online Help.  
Installing Maintenance Utilities  
Various maintenance utilities are contained in your NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM. See  
Chapter 6 for installing the utilities to your server or management workstations.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-29  
Updating the System - Installing Service Pack -  
IMPORTANT: If you install Windows Server 2003 CD-ROM which  
contains Service Pack 1 to your system, you do not have to apply  
Service Pack 1 again.  
Update the system in the situation below:  
Modified system configuration.  
Recovered the system using recovery process.  
Log on to the system with the account that has administrative authority (e.g. Administrator) and  
insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of the server.  
[Setup] in [Master Control Menu] screen appears, so left-click the item. Click [Update the  
System] from the menu and the setup will start. After that, follow the message to continue the  
setup process.  
Making Backup Copies of System Information  
The system information includes the current BIOS settings and any specific information for the  
server.  
Save the information after completing the system setup.  
Without the backup data, you will not be able to recover the information.  
You can save the information by the following process.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive and reboot the  
system.  
2. Select [Tools].  
3. Select [Off-line Maintenance Utility].  
4. Select [System Information Management].  
5. Insert a floppy disk into the floppy disk drive.  
6. Select [Save].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-30 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Exceptional Setup  
This section explains how to set up the server by the exceptional way. You usually do not have to do  
as follows. If you want to install the other boards by using a driver floppy disk ("OEM-FD for Mass  
storage device"), except ones listed in Chapter 5, set the server as follows. The detailed information  
is provided by the manual of the Mass storage device.  
Installation of Mass storage device not to be supported by Express Setup  
If you want to install the Operating system when the server has new mass storage device not to be  
supported by NEC EXPRESSBUILDER, follow the steps below.  
1. Read the manual supplied with the mass storage device before setting the server.  
2. If the mass storage device is disk array controller, configure the RAID system before  
running the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
3. Boot the system from NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM.  
4. (a) When the message "Do you want to use the parameters file..." appears, select "Yes"..  
(b) When the dialog of Disk array configuration appears, check "Use Existing Array".  
(c) Check "Apply OEM-FD for Mass storage device".  
5. Copy the driver for the mass storage device in the Express Setup.  
Insert the floppy disk attached the mass storage device into the floppy disk drive.  
Continue the Express Setup, referring to messages displayed on the display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-31  
Microsoft Windows 2000  
This subsection provides information on installing Microsoft® Windows® 2000 in the server.  
Read instruction in this section before proceeding the installation.  
NOTE: If you install Windows 2000 without using Express Setup, see  
Appendix E.  
Installation Notice  
This section explains precautions and matters you should be aware of before beginning installation  
in order to install Windows 2000 correctly.  
Supported OS on this model  
The server supports the following edition:  
Microsoft Windows 2000 Server / Microsoft Windows 2000 Advanced Server (hereinafter,  
referred to as "Windows 2000")  
On installing other OS, contact sales dealer or the maintenance service representative.  
BIOS Settings  
Before installing Windows 2000, confirm if the BIOS settings are correct. On the BIOS settings,  
there are some items to specify for the new functions provided by Windows 2000 (Plug and Play,  
support for USB interface and so on). See Chapter 4 to confirm the settings.  
NEC ESMPRO Agent  
NEC ESMPRO Agent requires to install the necras.sys driver on your Windows system.  
If you install the Windows without using the Express Setup, run the "Update Express5800 system"  
in Master Control Menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-32 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Optional Board Supported by NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
The NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM attached to your system supports the following optional  
boards;  
NOTE: If you want to install the other boards by using a driver floppy  
disk ("OEM-FD for Mass storage device"), except ones listed below,  
see "Exceptional setup" and "Installing Optional Mass Storage Driver"  
of "Configuration Diskette Creator" in Chapter 6.  
Supporting installation of OS in NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
– N8103-80F Disk Array Controller (SCSI 1ch)  
– N8103-81F Disk Array Controller (SCSI 2ch)  
– N8103-86 Disk Array Controller (0ch)  
– Adaptec HostRAID(SCSI) (Controller on the I/O board)  
Other optional boards  
– N8103-56 SCSI Controller  
– N8103-65F SCSI Controller  
– N8103-75 SCSI Controller  
– N8103-95 SCSI Controller  
– N8190-126 SCSI Controller  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-33  
Windows 2000  
Express Setup can install Windows 2000 operating system. Confirm below notes before installing  
the Windows.  
IMPORTANT:  
Before starting the installation, complete all the process of adding  
the optional device and the setup of Express server mainframe  
(BIOS and optional board specification)  
The document for installing Windows 2000 is also attached to the  
other software package which is sold separately from NEC, but  
refer to this document when you install Windows 2000 on this  
model.  
After completing Express Setup, see "Setup for Solving Problems"  
described later to specify the settings for trouble recovery such as  
"Specifying Memory Dump".  
Installing on the Mirrored Volume  
If you want to install Windows 2000 on the volume that is mirrored using "Disk Management",  
invalid the mirroring before operating the installation to set back to the basic disk, and valid the  
mirroring again after the installation has completed.  
Creating, invalid, delete mirror volume can be operated from "Disk Management" in "Computer  
Management".  
Connecting MO Device  
If you operate installing Windows 2000 with MO device connected, the installation may not be  
completed normally. In such case, detach MO device and then re-install the system from the  
beginning.  
Media such as DAT  
During the OS installation, do not attach the unnecessary media for OS installation to the system,  
such as DAT.  
Connecting Hard Disk Drive  
Connect the hard disk drive that OS is not going to be installed after installing OS.  
If you create multiple logical drives in your system, refer to "Re-installing the operation system  
when multiple logical drives exist" (Appendix E).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-34 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
About Maintenance Partition (the area displayed as "MAINTE_P")  
The maintenance partition for server maintenance is reserved in the head of Hard Disk Drive (a  
partition of approximately 55MB).  
This area is for saving some maintenance utilities.  
Do not delete the maintenance partition.  
Creating Partition Size  
The size for the partition that the system is to be installed can be calculated from the following  
formula.  
Size necessary to install the system + Paging File Size + Dump File Size  
+ Application Size  
Size necessary to install the system = 1000MB  
Paging File Size (Recommended) = Mounted Memory Size * 1.5  
Dump file Size  
Application Size  
= Mounted Memory Size + 12MB  
= Required Size  
IMPORTANT:  
The above-mentioned paging file size is recommended for  
collecting debug information (memory dump). The paging file  
with initial size large enough to store the dump file in the boot  
drive is required.  
Correct debug information might not be able to be collected due to  
virtual memory shortage when the paging file is insufficient, so set  
an enough size of the paging file with the entire system.  
The maximum paging file size which can be set on one partition is  
4095MB. If the above paging file size exceeds 4095MB, specify  
4095MB for the paging file size.  
The maximum dump file size for the system with more than 2GB  
memory mounted is '2048MB + 12MB'.  
If you install any application program or the like, add necessary  
space to the partition to install these programs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-35  
For example, if the mounted memory size is 512MB, the partition size will be calculated by the  
above formula as follows:  
1000MB + (512MB * 1.5) + (512MB + 12MB) + Application Size  
= 2292MB + Application Size  
Dividing into the partition of the recommended size into multiple disks as written below will solve  
problem that it cannot be reserved in one disk.  
1. Set the "Size required for installation + Paging file size".  
2. See Chapter 5 and set that debugging information (equivalent to the dump file size) is to  
be written to a separate disk.  
(If the disk does not have enough free space to enable the dump file size to be written,  
then after installing the system using the "Size required for installation + Paging file size",  
install an additional new disk.)  
NOTES:  
If you want to install using Express Setup, calculate the minimally  
required partition size as follows:  
If you do not apply Windows 2000 Service Pack  
The larger value of either one: 'Minimum Partition Size' described  
above, or '4095MB'.  
If you want to apply Windows 2000 Service Pack  
The larger value of either one: 'Minimum Partition Size' described  
above + 850MB or '4095MB'.  
Re-installing to the hard disk drive which has been upgraded to Dynamic Disk  
You cannot re-install Windows 2000 with the current partition of the hard disk drive upgraded to  
Dynamic Disk kept remained.  
If you want to keep the current partition remained, see Appendix D to re-install the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-36 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
The Flow of Setup  
This section shows the flow of the Express Setup.  
: Process that proceeds automatically  
: Process that needs to input or select  
Do you want to use the parameters file in order to set up  
the Express server ?  
Yes  
Read notes and restrictions  
No  
Confirmed  
Insert floppy disk into the floppy disk drive  
Confirmed  
Confirmed  
New File  
(Select Setup Parameter File)  
Existing File  
Checking the Setup Parameter File  
Correct  
Skipped  
Select whether or not to confirm/modify the setting  
Confirmed  
Disk Array Configuration Dialogue-box appears  
Creating Maintenance Partition and Installing Utilities  
Operating System Installation Menu appears  
Creating a working partition  
Confirm Setup File Create New File  
Choose the Windows category  
No Floppy Disk  
In case [Skip] is selected  
Confirm or input parameters for the Windows installation  
Remove the Floppy Disk and CD-ROM  
from the Drive  
Copying NEC Modules  
Copying Selected Application Modules  
Insert Windows CD-ROM  
Agree Software License Agreement  
Insert SP CD-ROM  
(If you selected [Yes] on [Apply Service Pack].)  
Install OS Automatically  
Log on Automatically  
After restarting the computer, the  
installation is completed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-37  
Installing the Windows 2000  
Express Setup proceeds the setup by specifying the necessary information on the wizard. You can  
also save the setup information created on the wizard in a floppy disk as a setup file.  
NOTE: Prepare a floppy disk to use as Configuration Disk if you  
want to save the parameters or use the drivers located on the "OEM-  
Disk for Mass Storage Device" that ships with optional boards. When  
using the floppy disk, the Express setup can continue the setup  
without specifying the parameters.  
1. Turn the power of peripheral device on, and then turn on the server.  
NOTES:  
If you operate installing Windows 2000 with MO device connected,  
the installation may not be completed normally. In such case,  
detach MO device and then re-install the system from the  
beginning.  
Connect the hard disk drive that OS is not going to be installed  
after installing OS.  
If you create multiple logical drives in your system, refer to  
"Reinstalling the operation system when multiple logical drives  
exist" (Appendix D).  
2. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of the server.  
3. Press Ctrl, Alt, and Delete to reboot from the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
The system boots from the CD-ROM and NEC EXPRESSBUILDER starts.  
4. Click [Express Setup].  
5. The message, "Do you want to use the parameter file in order to set up the Express Server  
or Workstation?", will be displayed.  
If you want to use the parameters file, click [Yes].  
If not, click [No].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-38 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
6. "NOTE" appears. Click [Confirm] after reading that.  
NOTE: If some operating system has been installed on the hard disk  
drive already, the message which asks if you continue the installation  
appears.  
7. If you select "Yes" at step 5, place a floppy disk into the floppy disk drive mounted on the  
server.  
If not, go on the next step.  
NOTE: If you set the floppy disk at this step, do not remove the  
floppy disk from the server until the message as removing the floppy  
disk appears.  
[Using the existing Configuration Disk]  
The parameters files in the floppy disk is listed in dialogue-box.  
1) Select a parameters file to use in the Express Setup.  
After the parameters file is specified, the message "Do you want to review or modify  
the Setup File parameters?" appears.  
2) If you want to modify or confirm the parameters file, click [Review]. If not, click  
[Skip].  
Click [Review] Go on the next step.  
Click [Skip] Go on the step 9.  
NOTE: If you do not use disk array controller, go on the step 9. After  
that, the dialog-box appears.  
[Using a blank disk]  
1) Click the box under [Setup File Name: (A)] or press A.  
The dialog box appears.  
2) Input the file name and click [Use].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-39  
8. Confirm or modify the parameters of disk array configuration.  
NOTE: If you do not use disk array controller, go on the next step.  
If a Disk array controller is connected to the server or the HostRAID is enabled, the  
[Configure RAID] dialogue-box appears. Confirm the parameters, modify if necessary,  
and then click [OK].  
When the dialogue-box is closed, the Express setup automatically performs the RAID  
configuration, creating Maintenance partition and installing several utilities.  
9. Select the installing Operating system.  
Select "Windows" from the menu.  
10. Select the Windows family.  
Select "Microsoft Windows 2000 Server / Microsoft Windows 2000 Advanced Server"  
category.  
NOTE: If you select "Skip" at step 8, this menu does not appear.  
Go on the step 13.  
11. Next, [Basic Information] wizard appears. Confirm the parameters, modify if necessary,  
and then click [Next].  
After that, click [Next], [Back], or [Help] on the screen to continue. Modify the  
parameters each time if necessary.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-40 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
IMPORTANT:  
Reserve the partition to install the OS more than the minimally  
required size.  
If you select "Use Existing Array" at "New/Existing RAID  
Configuration", the information included in the first partition  
(excluding maintenance partition) will all be formatted and deleted.  
The information included in the other partition will be retained.  
In the figure below, describes the partition which information will  
be deleted when maintenance partition exists.  
First Partition  
<Maintenance Partition>  
Retained  
Second  
Partition  
Deleted  
Third  
Partition  
Retained Retained  
Fourth  
Partition  
You can not re-install the system with the existing partition that is  
upgraded to Dynamic Disk remained. Do not select "Use  
Existing Array" at "New/Existing RAID Configuration".  
If "Create New Partition" at "New/Existing RAID Configuration"  
is selected, do not specify the value for the partition more than the  
actual area size.  
If you specify other than 4095MB for the "Installing Partition", it  
is necessary to convert to NTFS.  
If "Use Existing Array" at "New/Existing RAID Configuration" is  
selected but the partition other than the one to install Windows  
2000 does not exist (excluding maintenance partition), Express  
Setup will reserve the maximum area of the hard disk drive to  
install Windows 2000.  
You can not go to the next screen if the specification is incorrect.  
NOTES:  
If you click [Cancel] in [Basic Information] screen, the screen will  
go back to select the OS. [Cancel] exists only in [Basic  
Information] screen.  
If you click [OK] in [Role of Computer] screen, the setup  
automatically selects default value for the later specification to  
continue the installation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-41  
12. Copy the modules for the optional mass storage driver.  
If you want to install the optional mass storage driver, insert the floppy disk attached to  
mass storage driver into the floppy disk drive and follow the message to operate the  
installation.  
NOTE: You can use this function only when the floppy disk drive is  
attached to the system.  
13. Remove the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive according to  
the message.  
If you proceed the setup by using setup parameter file, remove the floppy disk from the  
floppy disk drive.  
Insert Windows 2000 CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
[Agree Software License Agreement] screen appears.  
14. Read the contents carefully and click [I agree.] or press F8 if you do agree. If you do not  
agree, click [I disagree] or press F3.  
IMPORTANT:  
If you do not agree to this agreement, the setup terminates and  
Windows 2000 will not be installed.  
If "NetWare Gateway (and Client) Service" is specified to install,  
the window to specify the details of "NetWare Gateway (and  
Client) Service" pops up on the first logon. Specify the  
appropriate value.  
15. If you selected [Yes] on [Apply Service Pack] at Basic Information, follow the procedure  
below.  
1) Follow the message to take Windows 2000 CD-ROM out of the CD-ROM drive.  
2) Follow the message to insert Windows 2000 Service Pack 4 or later into the CD-  
ROM drive.  
Windows 2000 and the specified application will be installed automatically and logon to  
the system. Install and configure the device drivers.  
Now the Setup using Express Setup has completed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-42 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Installing and Setting Device Drivers  
Follow these steps to install and configure the device drivers.  
PROSet  
PROSet is a utility that confirms the function of network contained in network driver. Be sure to  
install. Utilizing PROSet enables the following issues:  
Confirm detailed information of the adapter.  
Diagnose loop back test, packet transmission test and so on.  
Specify teaming.  
Configuring several network adapters as one team provides the server an environment tolerant on  
any trouble and enhance throughput between the switches.  
PROSet is necessary to utilize these features.  
Follow the procedure below to install PROSet.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
2. Click Start menu, point to [Program], [Accessory] and click [Explorer].  
3. Run "PROSET.EXE" in the following directory.  
<CD-ROM Drive Letter>:\WINNT\W2K\BC5\PROSET\WIN2K  
The [Intel(R) PROSet - InstallShield Wizard] dialog starts.  
4. Click [Next].  
5. Choose "I accept the terms in the license agreement" and click [Next].  
6. Choose "Typical" and click [Next].  
7. Click [Install].  
8. When [InstallShield Wizard Completed] window is displayed, click [Finish].  
9. Restart the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-43  
Network Driver  
[When PROSet is not installed]  
1. Click Start menu and click [Network and Dial-Up Connection].  
The [Network and Dial-Up Connection] dialog box appears.  
2. Right-click [Local Area Connection] and click [Properties] from pop-up menu.  
The [Local Area Connection Properties] dialog box appears.  
3. Click [Configure].  
The property dialog box for network adapter appears.  
4. Click the [Advanced] and specify the [Link Speed & Duplex]value the same as the value  
specified for HUB.  
5. Click [OK] on the property dialog box for network adapter.  
6. Click [OK] on the [Local Area Connection Properties] dialog box.  
Also, add or delete any protocols and services if necessary. You can operate the process from  
[Network and Dial-up Connection] to display the property dialog box for local area network.  
NOTE: We recommend you to add [Network Monitor] at [Adding  
Services]. [Network Monitor] can monitor the frame (or the packet)  
that the computer installing [Network Monitor] sends or receives. This  
tool is valuable when analyzing network trouble. For information on  
how to install the tool, see the "Setting for Solving Problems"  
described later in this chapter.  
[When PROSet is installed]  
1. Double-click [Intel(R) PROSet Wired] on the [Control Panel] window.  
The [Intel(R) PROSet for Wired Connections] dialog box appears. Double-click the  
[Intel(R) PROSet Wired] icon.  
2. Put the cursor to the network driver in the list.  
3. Click the [Advanced] and specify the [Link Speed & Duplex] value the same as the value  
specified for HUB.  
Also specify the other network driver with the same progress above.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-44 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Optional Network Board Driver  
If you want to utilize optional Network Board (N8104-86/88/111/103/109/112/113/115) install the  
driver stored in NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM.  
Refer to the re-installation procedure described in Appendix F.  
Network Driver for (N8104-86/88/111)  
[<CD-ROM DriveLetter>:\WINNT\W2K\BC5\PRO100\WIN2K]  
Network Driver for (N8104-103/109/112/113/115)  
[<CD-ROM DriveLetter>:\WINNT\W2K\BC5\PRO1000\WIN2K]  
Adapter Fault Tolerance (AFT)/Adaptive Load Balancing (ALB)  
Adapter Fault Tolerance (AFT) is a feature that creates a group containing more than one adapter  
and automatically converts the process of the working adapter to the other adapter in the group  
when any trouble occurred on that adapter.  
Adaptive Load Balancing (ALB) is a feature that creates a group containing more than one adapter  
and enhance the through put by operating packet transmission from the server by all the adapters.  
This feature includes AFT feature.  
IMPORTANT:  
AFT/ALB setup must be operated after installing the drivers and  
restarting the system.  
All the adapters specified as a group of Adapter Teaming must  
exist on the same LAN. If they are connected to the separate  
switches, they will not work normally.  
If you want to utilize AFT/ALB feature, follow the procedure below to setup.  
1. Double-click [Intel (R) PROSet Wired] on the [Control Panel] dialog box.  
The [Intel(R) PROSet for Wired Connections] dialog box appears.  
2. Put the mouse cursor on "Intel(R) PRO/1000 MT Dual Port Network Connection" in the  
list and right-click.  
Pull-down menu appears.  
3. Select [Add to Team] and then click [Create New Team...].  
The [Teaming Wizard] dialog box appears.  
4. Select "Adapter Fault Tolerance" or "Adaptive Load Balancing" and click [Next].  
5. Check the adapter to join the team and click [Next].  
6. Click [Finish].  
7. The setup will go back to [Intel(R) PROSet for Wired Connections] dialog box, so click  
[OK].  
8. Restart the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-45  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-65F/75)  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-65F/75), install it according to the following procedure:  
1. Start [Device Manager] from [Start] menu [Control Panel][Administrative Tools] →  
[Computer Management].  
2. Double click the SCSI Controller driver which Device Manager lists as unknown device.  
3. Click [Update Driver].  
4. When the "Update Device Driver Wizard" appears, select "Install from a list or specific  
location [Advanced]" and click [Next].  
5. Select "Don't search. I will choose the driver to install" and click [Next].  
6. Click [Have Disk..].  
7. Insert "Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy disk  
drive, enter "a:\" into "copy manufacturer's file from:" and click [OK].  
8. Specify the following driver and click [Next].  
[INITIO INI-A10XU2W PCI SCSI Controller] (When N8103-65F board is installed.)  
[Adaptec SCSI Card 29320ALP -Ultra320 SCSI] (When N8103-75 board is installed.)  
The installation of the driver is completed.  
Restart the system according to the message appeared on the screen.  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-56/-95/N8190-126)  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-56/-95/N8190-126), update your system with NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM attached to your system.  
The SCSI controller driver will be installed automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-46 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Installing RAID Controller Driver (N8103-80F/81F)  
To additionally install the N8103-80F/81F in a system containing Windows 2000, connect the  
controller and take the following steps to install the driver:  
1. When the [Found New Hardware Wizard] dialog box appears, click [Next].  
2. When the [Install Hardware Device Drivers] dialog box appears, select [Search for a  
suitable driver for my device (Recommended)], and click [Next].  
3. When the [Locate Driver Files] dialog box appears, select [Floppy disk drives], insert  
"Windows Server 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy disk  
drive, and click [Next].  
4. When the [Driver Files Search Results] dialog box appears, click [Next].  
5. Copying of the driver is completed, and the [Completion of the new hardware detection  
wizard] dialog box below appears. Click [Complete].  
Graphics Accelerator Driver  
Standard graphics accelerator drivers that are mounted will be installed automatically.  
The following is the procedure when it is necessary to install manually.  
If you want to utilize optional Graphics Accelerator Driver board, follow the document attached to  
the board to install the driver.  
*
For the graphics accelerator driver, the use of a remote KVM console that installs the advanced  
N8115-02 remote management card is supported by the standard.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
2. Click Start menu, point to [Programs], [Accessories] and click [Windows Explorer].  
3. Run "SETUP.EXE" in the following directory.  
<CD-ROM Drive Letter>:\WINNT\W2K\VIDEO\SETUP.EXE  
4. Follow the message to continue the installation.  
If the dialog message "Digital Signature could not been found." appears, select [Yes] to  
continue. If the dialog message "Direct X Ver.8 isn't installed." appears, select [continue]  
to continue.  
5. Remove the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive, follow the  
direction on the screen and restart the system.  
USB 2.0 Driver  
USB 2.0 Driver is pre-installed.  
When restoring the system or re-installing the system, the driver is automatically installed in the  
process of updating the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-47  
Available switch options for Windows 2000 Boot.ini file.  
Many different switches will be available if you edit Boot.ini File.  
For the available switch options, refer to the following information:  
Microsoft Knowledge Base - Article ID: 170756  
"Available Switch Options for the Windows NT Boot.ini File"  
If your system has a memory capacity in excess of 4GB in its installing, adding /PAE switch in  
Boot.ini file will enable the system to be installed with over 4GB of memory.  
However, the Microsoft operating system products which support /PAE switch option are limited.  
Refer to the following article in Microsoft Knowledge Base to check the supported products.  
Microsoft Knowledge Base - Article ID: 291988  
"A description of the 4GB RAM tuning feature and the Physical Address Extension  
switch"  
Below is the example on how to add /PAE switch to Boot.ini file.  
1. Click [Start], point to [Programs], point to [Accessories], and then click [Notepad].  
2. On the [File] menu, click [Open...].  
3. In the [Open] dialog box, in the [Look in] drop-down list box, click "%systemroot%"  
drive.  
4. In the [Open] dialog box, in the [Files of type] drop-down list box, click "All Files" and in  
the [File name] drop-down list box, enter "Boot.ini". And then, click [Open].  
The content of Boot.ini file will be displayed.  
5. Add "/PAE" to [Operating Systems] section in [Boot.ini] file, and then save it.  
<Example of Boot.ini file>  
[boot loader]  
timeout=30  
default=multi(0)disk(0)rdisk(0)partition(1)\WINNT  
[operating systems]  
multi(0)disk(0)rdisk(0)partition(1)\WINNT="Windows 2000 Server" /fastdetect  
multi(0)disk(0)rdisk(0)partition(1)\WINNT="Windows 2000 Server, PAE" /fastdetect /PAE  
This is the end of editing Boot.ini file.  
NOTE: If you choose one of the items in the "Default operating  
system" drop-down list box in [Setup and Recovery] group box, you  
can make your system start automatically from the switch you  
specified.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-48 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Setting for Solving Problems  
Setup the following issue in advance so that your computer can recover from any trouble precisely  
and as soon as possible when it should occur.  
Memory Dump (Debug Information)  
This section describes the procedures for collecting memory dump (debug information) in the  
server.  
IMPORTANT: Cautions for the Memory Dump  
The staff of maintenance service representative is in charge of  
collecting memory dump. Customers need only to specify the  
memory dump.  
If any trouble occur after specifying the process below, the  
message to inform that the system is in short of virtual memory  
may appear, but continue to start the system. If you restart the  
system in such case, memory dump may not be stored correctly.  
Follow the procedure below to specify.  
1. Point to [Settings] in Start menu and click [Control Panel].  
The [Control Panel] dialog box appears.  
2. Double-click [System].  
The [System Properties] dialog box appears.  
3. Click [Advanced].  
4. Click [Startup and Recovery].  
5. Enter the location to write the debug information to the text box.  
e.g. Write the debug information in D drive with the file name "MEMORY.DMP".  
D:\MEMORY.DMP  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-49  
IMPORTANT:  
To specify "Complete Memory Dump" to write the debug  
information is recommended. If the mounted memory size is larger  
than 2GB, "Complete Memory Dump" cannot be specified so that  
specify "Kernel Memory Dump" instead.  
Specify the drive where there is a free area more than the size of  
"the memory capacity mounted on Express server + 12MB"  
(In case the memory capacity is more than 2GB, a free area of  
"2048+12MB" or more).  
In case the mounted memory size exceeds 2GB due to the added  
memory, change the write debugging information to [Kernel  
Memory Dump] before adding memory. The size of debugging  
information (memory dump) to be taken also changes due to  
adding memory. Verify the size of the empty space in the  
debugging information (memory dump) write destination drive.  
6. Click [Performance Options].  
7. Click [Change] on the [Virtual Memory] dialog box.  
8. Modify [Initial Size] in the [Paging File Size for Selected Drive] box to the value larger  
than [Recommended Size], and click [Specify].  
IMPORTANT:  
The above-mentioned paging file size is recommended for  
collecting debug information (memory dump).  
The paging file with initial size large enough to store the dump file  
in the boot drive is required.  
Correct debug information might not be able to be collected due to  
virtual memory shortage when the paging file is insufficient, so set  
an enough size of the paging file with the entire system.  
For more information on "Recommended" value, see "Partition  
Size to be Created" described earlier.  
In case the memory is expanded, re-specify the paging file to suit  
the new memory size.  
9. Click [OK].  
The message to restart the system may appear according to the modified specification.  
In such case, follow the message to restart the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-50 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Windows 2000 Dr. Watson  
Windows 2000 Dr. Watson is a debugger for application errors. If any application error is detected,  
Dr. Watson diagnoses the server and logs diagnostic information (log). Follow the procedure  
below and specify Dr. Watson to collect diagnostic information.  
1. Click [Run] on Start menu.  
2. Type "drwtsn32.exe" in the [Open] box, and click [OK].  
The [Dr. Watson for Windows 2000] dialog box appears.  
3. Specify the location to store the diagnostic information in the [Log File Path] box.  
The diagnostic information will be stored with the file name "DRWTSN32.LOG".  
NOTE: You can not specify network pass. Specify the pass on local  
computer.  
4. Specify the location of crash dump file in the [Crash Dump] box.  
NOTE: "Crash Dump File" is a binary file that can be read with  
Windows Debugger.  
5. Check the following check box on the [Option] box.  
Dump Symbol Table  
Dump All Thread Contexts  
Add To Existing Log File  
Create Crash Dump File  
For more information on each function above, refer to Online Help.  
6. Click [OK].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-51  
Network Monitor  
Utilizing Network Monitor helps you to investigate and manage with network trouble. To utilize  
Network Monitor, you need to restart the system after the installation has completed, so we  
recommend to install Network Monitor before any network trouble may occur.  
1. Point to [Settings] from Start menu and click [Control Panel].  
The [Control Panel] dialog box appears.  
2. Double-click [Add/Remove Programs].  
The [Add/Remove Programs] dialog box appears.  
3. Click [Add/Remove Windows Component].  
The [Windows Components Wizard] dialog box appears.  
4. Check the [Management and Monitoring Tools] check box of the component ON and click  
[Next].  
5. If the setup asks to install the disk, insert Windows 2000 CD-ROM into the CD-ROM  
drive and click [OK].  
6. Click [Complete] in the [Windows Component Wizard] dialog box.  
7. Click [Close] in the [Add/Remove Application] dialog box.  
8. Close the [Control Panel] dialog box.  
To start Network Monitor, point to [Program] [Administrative Tools] and click [Network  
Monitor]. For information on how to operate Network Monitor, refer to Online Help.  
Installing Maintenance Utilities  
Various maintenance utilities are contained in your NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM. See  
Chapter 6 for installing the utilities to your server or management workstations.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-52 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
Updating the System - Installing Service Pack -  
IMPORTANT: This system does not support Windows 2000 Service  
Pack 1 - 3.  
If you install Windows 2000 CD-ROM which contains Service Pack 4  
to your system, you do not have to apply Service Pack 4 again.  
Update the system in the situation below:  
Modified system configuration.  
Recovered the system using recovery process.  
Log on to the system with the account that has administrative authority (e.g. Administrator) and  
insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of the server.  
[Setup] in [Master Control Menu] screen appears, so left-click the item. Click [Update the System]  
from the menu and the setup will start. After that, follow the message to continue the setup  
process and apply Service Pack.  
Making Backup Copies of System Information  
The system information includes the current BIOS settings and any specific information for the  
server.  
Save the information after completing the system setup.  
Without the backup data, you will not be able to recover the information.  
You can save the information by the following process.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive and reboot the  
system.  
2. Select [Tools].  
3. Select [Off-line Maintenance Utility].  
4. Select [System Information Management].  
5. Insert a floppy disk into the floppy disk drive.  
6. Select [Save].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-53  
Exceptional Setup  
This section explains how to set up the server by the exceptional way. You usually do not have to do  
as follows. If you want to install the other boards by using a driver floppy disk ("OEM-FD for Mass  
storage device"), except ones listed in Chapter 5, set the server as follows. The detailed information  
is provided by the manual of the Mass storage device.  
Installation of Mass storage device not to be supported by Express Setup  
If you want to install the Operating system when the server has new mass storage device not to be  
supported by NEC EXPRESSBUILDER, follow the steps below.  
1. Read the manual supplied with the mass storage device before setting the server.  
2. If the mass storage device is disk array controller, configure the RAID system before  
running the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
3. Boot the system from NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM.  
4. (a) When the message "Do you want to use the parameters file..." appears, select "Yes".  
(b) When the dialog of Disk array configuration appears, check "Use Existing Array".  
(c) Check "Apply OEM-FD for Mass storage device".  
5. Copy the driver for the mass storage device in the Express Setup.  
Insert the floppy disk attached the mass storage device into the floppy disk drive.  
Continue the Express Setup, referring to messages displayed on the display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-54 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
HostRAID  
The following explains the overview of HostRAID and the setup procedure.  
Overview of HostRAID  
HostRAID provides RAID feature through the onboard serial ATA or SCSI interface in your system.  
HostRAID consists of the driver that controls disk arrays and "Adaptec Storage Manager  
(hereinafter abbreviated to ASM) for Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition or that "Adaptec Storage  
Manager- Browser Edition (hereinafter abbreviated to ASMBE) for Windows Server 2003 and  
Windows 2000. ASM and ASMBE are disk array management utilities.  
The software products are mandatory for HostRAID to function normally. Be sure to install both  
software products (driver and utility). For the driver, refer to the setup procedure explained in this  
manual. For ASMBE, refer to the "Adaptec Storage Manager- Browser Edition User's Guide."  
For ASM, refer to the "Adaptec Storage ManagerUser's Guide."  
Overview of the specifications  
Hard disk drive:  
RAID level:  
SCSI HostRAID:  
Four hard disk drives for each channel + 2 spare drives  
SCSI HostRAID:  
RAID0 or RAID1 or RAID10 (0+1)  
Operating system:  
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 Standard x64  
Editions/Enterprise x64 Editions  
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 Standard Edition/Enterprise  
Edition  
Microsoft Windows 2000 Server/Advanced Server  
Configuration Method of disk arrays: BIOS utility, NEC EXPRESSBUILDER and ASMBE or  
ASM  
Features  
HostRAID supports the hot swap rebuild function for the hot plug insertion (Hot-Swap) of  
hard disk drives (when SCSI HostRAID is installed).  
HostRAID enables the BIOS utility to select the disk array/standard SCSI for each  
channel (when SCSI HostRAID is installed).  
Since the JAVA-based management utility ASMBE uses the browser (IE5.5 or later), the  
software does not need to be installed into each client PC for management. (The software  
must be installed in each server.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Operating System with Express Setup 5-55  
Notes  
The following explains general notes on HostRAID:  
<SCSI HostRAID>  
Only a hard disk drive can be connected to a channel with which HostRAID is enabled  
through SCSI BIOS.  
To connect a device other than a hard disk drive, disable HostRAID and use it as the  
standard SCSI.  
If you replace a hard disk drive being used with HostRAID, let 60 seconds or more pass  
after removing the hard disk drive, and then install a new hard disk drive.  
If the interval is too short, an unexpected event may occur. (You should install a new hard  
disk drive after confirming the removal of the old hard disk drive on the ASMBE or ASM  
window.)  
After rebuilding by using hot spare, do the rebuilding again to make the installation  
positions of hard disk drives and the configuration of an array using the disks same as  
those before the configuration of the array. Without the operation, the boot priority may be  
changed. The priority can be changed by the SCSISelect Utility.  
The timeout message below may be recorded into the event log if I/O operation is delayed  
while HostRAID is running with a high load applied. However, HostRAID internal  
processing retries the I/O processing, and the delay does not influence AP and system  
operations.  
Event source: a320raid.sys  
Event ID:  
9
Description: The device \Device\Scsi\a320raid* did not respond within timeout period.  
(*: Arbitrary)  
When Hot Spare Rebuild is performed, please perform Rebuild again to become the  
original hard disk drive mounting position and the same position. If this work is not done,  
a boot priority may change. A boot priority can be changed in BIOS.  
<Common NOTES>  
In addition to driver installation, ASMBE or ASM installation is mandatory for using  
HostRAID functions. For the installation of ASMBE or ASM, refer to the "Adaptec  
Storage Manager- Browser Edition User's Guide" or "Adaptec Storage Manager,"  
respectively.  
HostRAID does not permit the use of the standby/hibernation mode of ACPI functions.  
Use ASMBE or ASM to maintain HostRAID, but do not use any other utilities.  
Create at least one OS partition in the array you have created. If the OS partition does not  
exist, the Verify may be executed for the array at the system boot.  
If the following messages are included in the application log or log generated by the  
ASMBE, your RAID system operates normally.  
– Spare test failed for pool spare (bus=%2, ch=%3, id=%4)  
– Test of all spares completed with %1 failures  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-56 Installing the Operating System with Express Setup  
HostRAID Setup Flow  
The flowchart below shows the HostRAID system setup procedure.  
Start  
Is HostRAID used as  
boot disk?  
Yes  
Enable the HostRAID  
feature and create RAID by  
using SCSISelect Utility  
Refer to SCSISelect  
Utility User's Manual.  
*1  
Install driver  
(install OS).  
See Appendix D or E of  
this guide.  
Update system.  
See this chapter.  
Install ASMBE or ASM.  
See ASMBE/ASM User's  
*2  
Guide  
.
Install Standby/Hibernation  
Lock driver.  
See appendix of  
ASMBE/ASM User's  
*2  
Guide  
.
End  
*1 You can create RAID by using the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER. In this case, only you need to do is to  
set the HostRAID feature to "Enabled" by using SCSISelect Utility.  
*2 For Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition: Adaptec Storage ManagerUser's Guide  
For Windows Server 2003 and Windows 2000: Adaptec Storage Manager- Browser Edition User's  
Guide  
You may view or print these documents from the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM.  
Migration of Hard Disk Drive (Migration)  
When you want the system SCSI hard disk drive using SCSI controller on the I/O board migrate to  
RAID1 of SCSI HosRAID, the "Migration" must be executed.  
For details, please refer to "Express5800 SCSI HostRAID Migration procedure (Windows)" of  
online documents.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 6  
Installing and Using Utilities  
This section describes how to use the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM that comes with your  
server and to install the utilities stored on the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6-2 Installing and Using Utilities  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER is an automated software integration tool to help simplify the process of  
installing and configuring your server. Shipped with all NEC servers, the NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM provides a flexible, guided installation process for system  
administrators to install Microsoft Windows Server 2003, Microsoft Windows 2000 or other  
operating systems (contact your service representative for the server certified operating systems).  
NOTE: Before using NEC EXPRESSBUILDER for initial setup,  
complete the hardware configuration.  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER includes three distinct programs. One can be booted under DOS for  
initial setup, and one is for use under Windows operating system.  
DOS-based with local console  
Used to set up the server at the first time. This program is also used to diagnose the  
server and to install/uninstall the management utilities on the maintenance partition of the  
system drive.  
DOS-based with remote console  
Used to set up the server from the management workstation by accessing the server over  
the network or via serial port B.  
NOTE: No keyboard connected to the server is permitted to run this  
program.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing and Using Utilities 6-3  
Windows-based  
This program is called as "Master Control Menu" that can run under the Microsoft  
Windows system (Windows 95 or later and Windows NT 4.0 or later). You can install  
the several applications and read the documentation from the menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-4 Installing and Using Utilities  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER for DOS-Based with Local Console  
This subsection describes the procedures for using NEC EXPRESSBUILDER for DOS-based with  
local console.  
Starting NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
The following procedure instructs you to start NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
IMPORTANT: Do not remove the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-  
ROM while NEC EXPRESSBUILDER is running.  
1. Turn on peripheral devices and the server in this order.  
2. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM supplied with your server into the CD-  
ROM drive of your server.  
3. Ensure that the floppy disk drive is empty.  
4. Press the RESET switch or press Ctrl, Alt, and Delete to reboot from the NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER. (You may also turn off and then on again to reboot the server.)  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER boots up displaying the top menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing and Using Utilities 6-5  
Express Setup  
"Express Setup" is intended for initial setup of the server. Its automatic installation mode guides  
the user easily through the process by detailing specific hardware features and providing screen  
prompts for software selection and configuration. The program loads the utilities and drivers,  
applies RAID settings, partitions the disk, and installs the desired operating system.  
If you install Windows Server 2003 or Windows 2000, after a few tasks are completed, all that  
remains to be done is to remove the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM and install the Windows  
CD-ROM, input a product ID number, and acknowledge the license agreement.  
IMPORTANT:  
Express Setup does not support the installation of Windows Server  
2003 x64 Editions.  
The Express Setup is intended for the initial setup of the server  
system and, therefore, the Express Setup clears the contents of the  
hard disk drive.  
Once Express setup is started, do not remove "Configuration  
Diskette" from the floppy disk drive without any directions.  
Tools  
"Tools" is also intended for initial setup of the server. It provides more installation options than  
Express Setup and permits the user to quickly create utility support disks, run the Off-line  
Maintenance Utility and system diagnostic utility, set up a maintenance partition, and update the  
various BIOS programs.  
Tools Menu  
RAID Board: Present  
Total Drives: 1  
Drives in Group: 1  
Hot Spares: 1  
RAID Level: 7  
Write Mode: WRITE_THRU  
Maint Part: Present  
Save/Restore RAID Configuration Data  
Off-line Maintenance Utility  
System Diagnostics  
Create Support Disk  
Setup Maintenance Partition  
BIOS/FW/etc. Update  
Initialize Remote Management Card  
System Management  
Help  
Return to the Top Menu  
Save/Restore RAID Configuration Data  
The item allows the configuration information on the disk array system to be saved or  
restored from the floppy disk.  
If the HostRAID and LSI-Logic disk array controllers are used together, the configuration  
information of HostRAID is saved or restored. If the Adaptec Zero channel raid controller  
(ZCR) and LSI-Logic disk array controller are used together, the configuration  
information of ZCR is saved or restored.  
IMPORTANT: In these cases, If you want to save or restore the  
configuration information of LSI-Logic disk array controller, refer to  
the "Power Console Plus User's Guide".  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-6 Installing and Using Utilities  
– Save Disk Array Configuration Data  
The configuration information on the disk mirroring controller is saved into the floppy  
disk. If you set or change RAID, always use this function to save the configuration  
information into a floppy disk.  
IMPORTANT: Some Disk Array Controllers do not support this  
function. In that case, this menu will not be shown.  
– Restore Disk Array Configuration Data  
The configuration information saved in a floppy disk is restored to NVRAM and hard  
disk drive on the disk mirroring controller.  
If the configuration information is broken or changed by mistake, restore the  
configuration information.  
When the defected disk array controller is replaced, the configuration information on  
the hard disk drive must be saved into the disk array controller.  
However, if the configuration information on the new disk mirroring controller is saved  
into a hard disk drive, use this function to restore the configuration information.  
IMPORTANT:  
Some Disk Array Controllers do not support this function. In that  
case, this menu will not be shown.  
This is a function for maintenance. Please do not use it except  
maintenance.  
Off-line Maintenance Utility  
Off-line Maintenance Utility is an OS-independent maintenance program that performs  
preventive maintenance and error analysis for your server. See Chapter 8 or online help  
for details.  
System Diagnostics  
Executes various tests on the server system to check if the server functions are normal and  
if the connection between the server and additional board is normal.  
After the System Diagnostics is executed, a system check program assigned to each model  
starts. See Chapter 7 for details.  
Create Support Disk  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM contains a number of device drivers and utilities  
that you can put on floppy disks and load onto your system.  
Using this menu creates a support disk by copying from the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
CD-ROM. If your system has the Windows operating system, you may find it more  
convenient to use NEC EXPRESSBUILDER for Windows-based to make support disks  
Write the displayed title on the floppy disk label, which is useful for management in the  
future. Customers are to provide a floppy disk to create a support disk.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing and Using Utilities 6-7  
– Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
Creates a support disk for installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions.  
– Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
Creates a support disk for installing Windows Server 2003 Standard Edition and  
Windows Server 2003 Enterprise Edition. (No need to create this disk when installing  
the operating system with the Express Setup.)  
– Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
Creates a support disk for installing Windows 2000 Server and Windows 2000  
Advanced Server. (This disk is utilized for Windows 2000 clean installation and for  
Recovery for Windows 2000 system.) (No need when installing the operating system  
with the Express Setup.)  
– ROM-DOS Startup FD  
Creates a support disk for starting the ROM-DOS system.  
– Off-line Maintenance Utility Bootable FD  
Creates a support disk for activating the Off-line Maintenance Utility.  
– System Management FD  
Creates a support disk for activating the System Management.  
Setup Maintenance Partition  
Maintenance partition is a specific partition for the server and created on your system disk.  
About 55MB of the maintenance partition includes the various maintenance utilities and  
executable commands.  
In this menu, you can create the maintenance partition, install the various utilities, and  
update the utilities. The maintenance utilities installed in the maintenance partition are  
system diagnostics, System Management, and Off-line Maintenance Utility.  
IMPORTANT:  
Do not reset or turn off the server while the running this menu. If  
the processing is discontinued, the system becomes unable to start.  
The existence of the maintenance partition may be identified from  
the operating system. In order to retain the Configuration Data,  
do not delete the partition.  
NOTES:  
The maintenance partition, once created, will not be recreated  
again.  
When the maintenance partition does not exist, some menu items  
do not appear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-8 Installing and Using Utilities  
– Create Maintenance Partition  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER creates about 55MB of the maintenance partition on the  
system disk (or disk array system) as work area. The various utilities are installed  
when the maintenance partition is created successfully or when the maintenance  
partition is already created.  
– Install Maintenance Partition Utilities  
Various utilities are installed in the maintenance partition from the CD-ROM.  
– Update Maintenance Partition Utilities  
Various utilities are copied in the Maintenance Partition from the update disk. This  
menu is only used when the update disk is supplied from your service representative or  
attached with your system.  
– FDISK  
Execute FDISK command of ROM-DOS system. You can create/delete partitions,  
etc.  
BIOS/FW/etc. Update  
This menu allows you to update the software module such as BIOS and firmware of the  
server by using the update disk (3.5-inch floppy disk) that is distributed from NEC  
customer service representative.  
After rebooting the system, an update program is started automatically from the floppy  
disk, and the various BIOS and firmware programs are updated.  
IMPORTANT: Do not turn off the server while the update program  
is running. If the update processing is discontinued, the system  
becomes unable to start.  
Initialize Remote Management Card  
"Initialize Remote Management Card" is used to configure the Remote Management Card  
with correct parameters of the system installed it.  
System Management  
The parameters of BMC (Baseboard Management Controller) are set for remote control  
and alert.  
Help  
Displays explanations about various functions of NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
Return to the Top Menu  
Choosing this menu returns to the Top Menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing and Using Utilities 6-9  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER for DOS-based with Remote Console  
This subsection describes the procedures for using NEC EXPRESSBUILDER for DOS-based with  
remote console.  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER contains the remote console feature that allows the system administrator  
to set up the server from the management workstation (management PC) via the network or the  
server's COM B (serial) port.  
IMPORTANT:  
Do not use this feature on any other computer than the server, or  
on any other server obtained without the NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER. Doing so may cause a failure of the  
server.  
When a keyboard is connected to the server, the remote console  
feature is disabled. The NEC EXPRESSBUILDER determines  
that the server has a console. (Nothing is displayed on the  
management PC.)  
If you fail to configure the disk array controller N8103-80F or 81F  
from the remote console, try again using the server console.  
The system may fail to operate with the transfer rate of 115.2 Kbps  
for serial console redirection. Specify any other transfer rate than  
115.2 Kbps.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-10 Installing and Using Utilities  
Starting  
The following two methods are available to start the server.  
Running NEC EXPRESSBUILDER from the management PC via LAN  
Running NEC EXPRESSBUILDER from the management PC via direct connection  
(COM B)  
For the procedure for starting NEC EXPRESSBUILDER for DOS-based with Remote Console, see  
"NEC DianaScope".  
IMPORTANT:  
Do not change the boot device order in BOOT menu in BIOS  
SETUP. NEC EXPRESSBUILDER cannot be used if the CD-  
ROM drive is not the first device to launch the system.  
To use this feature, you need 3.5-inch floppy disk. Please prepare  
the floppy disk.  
NOTE: The following items of BIOS setup information will be set as  
shown below.  
LAN Controller:  
[Enabled]  
Serial Port A:  
Base I/O Address:  
Interrupt:  
[Enabled]  
[3F8]  
[IRQ 4]  
Serial Port B:  
Base I/O Address:  
Interrupt:  
[Enabled]  
[2F8]  
[IRQ 3]  
BIOS Redirection Port: [Serial B]  
Baud Rate:  
[19.2K]  
Flow Control:  
Console Type:  
[CTS/RTS]  
[PC ANSI]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing and Using Utilities 6-11  
Top Menu  
Shown below are the top menu items.  
Setup  
Automatically sets up the server.  
Tools  
Launch the features of NEC EXPRESSBUILDER individually.  
Help  
Help message on NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
Quit  
Quit NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
Setup  
The NEC EXPRESSBUILDER checks the hardware configuration of the server. The disk array  
and maintenance partition are automatically configured.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-12 Installing and Using Utilities  
Tools  
When you select the [Tools] on the Top Menu, the following screen appears.  
The menu items available only in remote console operation among those described in section "NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER for DOS-based with Local Console" are displayed. See the previous  
subsection for detailed explanation of menu items.  
IMPORTANT: The following is varied from the [Tools] menu in the  
local console mode.  
Test items and operation method of System Diagnostics. See  
Chapter 7 for details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing and Using Utilities 6-13  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER for Windows-Based (Master Control Menu)  
The Master Control Menu is used to,  
Read the User's Guide or the other documents,  
Update the NEC Express5800 system, and  
Install the management software.  
NOTES:  
Master Control Menu requires Microsoft Windows 95 (or later) or  
Windows NT 4.0 (or later).  
Some documents are provided in the PDF format. Use the Adobe  
Acrobat Reader to read these documents.  
Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive. Master Control Menu  
appears on the screen automatically. If the Autorun function is invalid in your system, run the  
\MC\1ST.EXE file in the CD-ROM directly. Some items are grayed-out when the logon user does  
not have the authority of the administrator or the item is not proper for the system.  
To use Master Control Menu,  
Click on [Online Document], [Setup] or [Quit], or  
Click the right mouse button on Master Control Menu window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-14 Installing and Using Utilities  
CONFIGURATION DISKETTE CREATOR  
"Configuration Diskette Creator" is a tool to create [Configuration Diskette] that is used for  
configuring the server with the Express Setup (see Chapter 5 for details).  
If you use the Configuration Diskette created by the Express Setup and Configuration Diskette  
Creator to operate the setup, you can setup from the installation of OS to several utilities  
automatically except for a few key input to confirm the specification. Also, you can install the  
system with the same specification as before when re-installing the system. We recommend you to  
create [Configuration Diskette] to setup the servers from NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
IMPORTANT: You can not create [Configuration Diskette] for  
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions.  
NOTE: You can install Windows Server 2003 and Windows 2000  
without [Configuration Diskette]. Also, you can modify/newly create  
[Configuration Diskette] during the setup with NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER.  
Creating Configuration Diskette  
This section describes about specifying setup information that is necessary for OS installation and  
creating [Configuration Diskette]. Follow the procedure below.  
NOTE: In the procedure below, the folder name that is specified when  
installing Trekking command is assumed as [Configuration Diskette  
Creator].  
1. Start the OS.  
2. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
Master Control Menu will appear.  
3. Right-click on the screen or left-click [Setup]. The menu will appear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing and Using Utilities 6-15  
4. Click [Configuration Diskette Creator].  
Configuration Diskette Creator window is displayed.  
5. Click [Create New Information files] from the [File] menu.  
The [Disk Environment] dialog box will be displayed.  
6. Specify each item and click on [OK].  
The dialog boxes to specify setup information will be displayed in order, such as [Disk  
Environment] dialog box.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-16 Installing and Using Utilities  
7. Follow the message to specify each item on the dialog box and click [Next].  
NOTE: If you click on [Cancel], all the input value will be deleted.  
When completing the specification of setup information, the [Save Setup Information]  
dialog box will appear.  
8. Confirm that the [Configuration Diskette] check box is checked, and input file name for  
the Setup File in [File Name].  
9. Insert the floppy disk formatted by 1.44MB into the floppy disk drive and click [OK].  
Now [Configuration Diskette] has been created. [Configuration Diskette] is used when  
you install Windows Server 2003 or Windows 2000. Put a label and keep it where it will  
not be lost.  
NOTE: For the information on the contents of each specifying item,  
refer to the Help.  
If you want to modify the information file that already exists, click [Modify information  
files] on Configuration Diskette Creator window. Refer to the Help to modify the inf file.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing and Using Utilities 6-17  
Installing Optional Mass Storage Driver  
To install optional Mass Storage Driver that is supported by the Express Setup, follow the procedure  
below to create [Configuration Diskette].  
1. Display Configuration Diskette Creator window.  
2. From the [File] menu, click [Create new information files].  
[Disk Environment] dialog box will be displayed.  
3. Specify each item and click on [OK].  
The dialog boxes to specify setup information will be displayed in order, such as [Disk  
Environment] dialog box.  
4. Follow the message to specify each item on the dialog box and click on [Next].  
NOTE: If you click on [Cancel], all the input value will be deleted.  
5. When [User and application setup] is displayed, check [Apply OEM-FD for mass storage  
device].  
6. When the [Save Setup Information] dialog box is displayed, confirm that the  
[Configuration Diskette] check box is checked, and input file name for the Setup File in  
[File Name].  
7. Insert the floppy disk formatted by 1.44MB into the floppy disk drive and click on [OK].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-18 Installing and Using Utilities  
NEC ESMPRO  
The NEC ESMPRO (referred to as ESMPRO hereafter) lets a system administrator manage remote  
servers across a network. ESMPRO monitors server hardware and software configurations,  
failures, and performance. With log data collected by ESMPRO, a system administrator can track  
long-term and short-term performance, monitor server usage, create graphs to record trends, and  
check server failure rates. The administrator can use the information collected to create more  
efficient data routing procedures and optimize server usage.  
IMPORTANT: For installation procedure and detailed explanations on  
NEC ESMPRO, refer to the online document in the NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM.  
Functions and Features  
The ESMPRO offers many functions and features for managing remote servers across a network.  
These features help the system administrator perform daily system operation, system extension, and  
transfer tasks. Some features of ESMPRO Manager include:  
Hardware and software server configuration  
– Hardware resources mounted in servers, such as the CPU, memory, disks, disk arrays,  
and LAN boards.  
– Software resources, such as operating system information and drivers running on each  
server.  
Server failures  
– On-screen real-time displays provide the system administrator with the failure type,  
location, cause, and suggested corrective action.  
– Failure data includes hardware failure information such as system board temperature,  
memory failure, crashes, and software failure information.  
Performance  
– ESMPRO monitors server performance and displays server usage on the screen and  
displays information, such as the rate of CPU load, memory usage, disk usage, and  
LAN traffic. Usage threshold values can help the system administrator monitor and  
prevent server overloads.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing and Using Utilities 6-19  
Adaptec Storage Manager- Browser Edition  
Adaptec Storage Manager- Browser Edition (hereinafter abbreviated to ASMBE) is a  
management utility for the HostRAID system and provides RAID functions through the SCSI  
interface in your server. You can use the following functions for HostRAID by installing ASMBE in  
your system.  
IMPORTANT: Be sure to use ASMBE on the system other than  
Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition. To monitor and manage  
HostRAID on Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition, use Adaptec Storage  
Manager(hereinafter abbreviated to ASM).  
Features  
Maintaining ZCR and HostRAID storage system  
Making a consistency check on redundant disk arrays  
Recording ZCR and HostRAID events into the event log  
Omitting the installation of client software into each management PC if the previously  
mentioned browser is installed. This is because ASMBE uses the browser (Internet  
Explorer 5.5 or later).  
Before attempting to operate ASMBE, read the "Adaptec Storage ManagerTM - Browser Edition  
User's Guide" included in NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM. The manual explains the ASMBE  
installation procedure and notes on operating ASMBE.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-20 Installing and Using Utilities  
Adaptec Storage Manager  
Adaptec Storage Manager(hereinafter abbreviated to ASM) is an application that locally or  
remotely manages HostRAID storage system and provides RAID functions through the SCSI  
interface on the Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition in your server. You can use the following  
functions for HostRAID by installing ASM in your system.  
Features  
Creating disks at a level of RAID0, RAID1, or RAID10  
Creating Hot Spare disks that are to be used for automatically executing Rebuild if a  
redundant disk array enters the Degraded state  
Making a consistency check on redundant disk arrays  
Recording HostRAID events into the event log  
Before attempting to operate ASM, read the "Adaptec Storage ManagerUser's Guide" included in  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM. The manual explains the ASM installation procedure and  
notes on operating ASM.  
IMPORTANT: You cannot install ASM with EXPRESS Setup. Install  
ASM manually.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing and Using Utilities 6-21  
MegaRAID Storage Manager(Server)  
MegaRAID Storage Manager(hereinafter abbreviated to MSM) is an application to manage or  
monitor the N8103-91 disk array controller. You can use MSM for management of arrays and error  
notification by event monitoring while the system is running.  
Before attempting to operate MSM, read the "MegaRAID Storage ManagerUser's Guide"  
included in NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM. The manual explains the MSM installation  
procedure and notes on operating MSM.  
Setup with Express Setup  
You can install MSM with Express Setup contained in NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM. When  
you start the Express Setup, a dialog to specify an application appears. Select [MSM] on the dialog.  
Manual Setup  
See the online document "MegaRAID Storage ManagerUser's Guide contained in NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM for details.  
MegaRAID Storage Manager(Management PC)  
Install the MegaRAID Storage Manager(hereinafter abbreviated to MSM) in a management PC  
that manages servers via the network.  
Before attempting to operate MSM, read the "MegaRAID Storage ManagerUser's Guide"  
included in NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM. The manual explains the MSM installation  
procedure and notes on operating MSM.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-22 Installing and Using Utilities  
Power Console Plus  
Power Console Plus is a utility to control the RAID system of the disk array controller (MegaRAID  
controller) produced by LSI Logic. Use of Power Console Plus enables operations (e.g., monitoring  
and maintenance) of RAID systems that are constructed on local NEC Express servers and NEC  
Express servers connected through networks (TCP/IP). The operations can be done online on  
graphical screens without the system being stopped.  
Major Functions  
Power Console Plus has the following features:  
Supporting the Wizard function to facilitate configuration  
Enabling the change of RAID levels  
Being compatible with SAF-TE  
Supporting the performance monitor  
Supporting enclosure functions such as temperature monitoring, power monitoring, and  
fan monitoring  
Enabling the settings of Write, Read, and Cache policies for each logical drive  
Supporting the save and restore functions for configuration  
Enabling the display of the SCSI transfer rate  
Components  
Power Console Plus consists of the following five components:  
SNMP Agent  
This function is not yet supported. Do not install SNMP Agent.  
MegaRAID Service Monitor  
Enables NEC ESMPRO to monitor the MegaRAID controller by registering event logs.  
Install MegaRAID Service Monitor in the NEC Express server in which the MegaRAID  
controller is mounted.  
MegaRAID Client  
Controls the RAID system on graphical screens. Install MegaRAID Client in the NEC  
Express server in which the MegaRAID controller mounted or in the management PC that  
is connected through the NEC Express server and network.  
MegaRAID Server  
Enables control of the MegaRAID controller via the network. Install MegaRAID Server in  
the NEC Express server in which the MegaRAID controller mounted.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing and Using Utilities 6-23  
MegaRAID Registration Server  
Enables control of the MegaRAID controller via the network. Install in one of NEC  
Express servers and management PCs that are connected through network. The above  
components must be installed correctly for establishing the environment to use Power  
Console Plus.  
Power Console Plus components to be installed are different between the target servers and  
management PC.  
Server:  
NEC Express server in which the MegaRAID controller is mounted  
Install the following three components in this server:  
– MegaRAID Service Monitor  
– MegaRAID Server  
– MegaRAID Client  
Management PC:  
Management PC that monitors and controls servers via the network (TCP/IP)  
When managing array on Terminal Server working on Windows NT Server Version 4.0  
Terminal Server Edition, prepare PC, and install Management PC component.  
Management PC does not guarantee operation on Client, which used Terminal Server,  
Terminal Server Emulator, WBT.  
Start Power Console Plus of management PC, after the Power On machine that installed  
"Server" and "Management Server".  
Install the following component in this PC:  
– MegaRAID Client  
Management server:  
Machine that manages all servers that are monitored and controlled by management PCs  
Install the following component in one of the servers or management PCs:  
– MegaRAID Registration Server  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-24 Installing and Using Utilities  
Server Setup  
This section explains Power Console Plus setup in the NEC Express server in which the MegaRAID  
controller is mounted.  
Operating Environment  
This section explains the operating environment required for Power Console Plus to operate on a  
server.  
Hardware  
– Machine:  
NEC Express5800 series connected with the AMI disk array controller (A)  
– Memory:  
Size large enough for OS operation + 8MB or more  
– Free space of the hard disk drive:  
5MB or more  
– Display unit:  
Screen size 1024 × 768 or larger  
– Required peripheral equipment:  
Network Interface card  
CD-ROM unit  
Pointing device such as a mouse  
Software  
– Microsoft Windows NT version 4.0  
(Windows NT Version 4.0 Service Pack 5 or later + Internet Explorer 4.01 Service  
Pack 2 or later)  
– Microsoft Windows 2000  
– Microsoft Windows Server 2003  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing and Using Utilities 6-25  
Management PC Setup  
This section explains Power Console Plus setup in a computer that manages servers via the network  
(TCP/IP).  
Operating Environment  
This section explains the operating environment required for Power Console Plus to operate on a  
management PC.  
Hardware  
– Machine:  
NEC Express5800 series  
PC/AT-compatible machine (which contains Intel Pentium or a CPU at least equivalent  
to it)  
– Memory:  
Size large enough for OS operation + 8MB or more  
– Free space of the hard disk drive:  
5 MB or more  
– Display unit:  
Screen size 1024 × 768 or larger  
– Required peripheral equipment:  
Network Interface card  
CD-ROM unit  
Pointing device such as a mouse  
Software  
– Microsoft Windows NT Version 4.0  
(Windows NT Version 4.0 Service Pack 5 or later + Internet Explorer 4.01 Service  
Pack 2 or later)  
– Microsoft Windows 2000  
– Microsoft Windows 95/98/Me  
– Microsoft Windows Server 2003  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-26 Installing and Using Utilities  
NEC DianaScope  
NEC DianaScope is software for the remote management of the NEC Express5800 series.  
See the online documents for details on the functions and installation of NEC DianaScope.  
NOTE: You need the server license to activate DianaScope for this  
product.  
The server license below is attached to this product.  
DianaScope Additional Server License (1)  
Notes  
The online documents explain general information about servers to be managed by NEC  
DianaScope. This section explains specific notes on managing this product remotely from NEC  
DianaScope.  
This product can be managed remotely from NEC DianaScope only when it is equipped  
with a remote management card or advanced remote management card.  
This product does not support the remote FD function.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 7  
Maintenance  
This chapter describes the daily maintenance of the server and precautions when relocating or  
storing the server.  
MAKING BACKUP COPIES  
NEC recommends you make backup copies of your valuable data stored in hard disk drives of the  
server on a regular basis. For backup storage devices suitable for the server and backup tools,  
consult with your service representative.  
When you have changed the hardware configuration or BIOS configuration, select "System  
Information Management" and then "Save" of the Off-line Maintenance Utility to make a backup  
copy of the system information.  
Also make a backup copy of the disk array configuration data if your system is in the array  
configuration. When your hard disk drives have been auto-rebuilt due to a failure, it is  
recommended to make a backup copy of the configuration data. To make a backup copy of the  
configuration data, use the configuration utility that is resident in the FLASH memory on the  
optional disk array controller board. Refer to the manual supplied with the board.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-2 Maintenance  
CLEANING  
Clean the server on a regular basis to keep the server in a good shape.  
WARNING  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may result in death or serious personal injury. See pages  
1-3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not disassemble, repair, or alter the server.  
Do not look into the CD-ROM drive.  
Do not remove the lithium battery.  
Disconnect the power plug before working with the server.  
CAUTION  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may cause a fire, personal injury, or property damage. See  
pages 1-3 to 1-8 for details.  
Avoid installation in extreme temperature conditions.  
Make sure to complete board installation.  
Protect the unused connectors with the protective cap.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance 7-3  
Cleaning the Server  
For daily cleaning, wipe the external surfaces of the server with a dry soft cloth. Follow the  
procedure below if stains remain on the surfaces:  
IMPORTANT:  
To avoid altering the material and color of the server, do not use  
volatile solvents such as thinner and benzene to clean the server.  
The power receptacle, the cables, the connectors on the rear panel of  
server, and the inside of the server must be kept dry. Do not  
moisten them with water.  
1. Make sure that the server is off-powered (the POWER/SLEEP LED goes off).  
2. Unplug the power cord of the server from a power outlet.  
3. Wipe off dust from the power cord plug with a dry cloth.  
4. Soak a soft cloth in neutral detergent that is diluted with cold or lukewarm water, and  
squeeze it firmly.  
5. Rub off stains on the server with the cloth prepared in Step 4.  
6. Soak a soft cloth in water, squeeze it firmly, wipe the server with it once again.  
7. Wipe the server with a dry cloth.  
8. Wipe off dust from the fan exhaust opening on the rear of the server with a dry cloth.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-4 Maintenance  
Cleaning the Interior  
One of the most important items in a good maintenance program is regular and thorough cleaning of  
the interior of the server, especially around the mother board.  
Dust buildup inside the server can lead to several problems. As dust acts as a thermal insulator, a  
buildup can prevent proper system cooling. Excessive heat will shorten the life of server  
components. Also, dust may contain conductive or corrosive materials that can cause short circuits  
or corrosion of electrical contacts.  
How often you should clean the interior of the server depends on the environment in which it is  
located. For most office environments, you probably should clean the server every 12 months.  
For more severe environments, clean the interior every 6 months.  
Cleaning the interior of the server entails powering off the server and removing the left side cover.  
You will need a small vacuum cleaner (with plastic tipped nozzle and electrostatic protection),  
computer grade canned air, and a small brush for cleaning the interior.  
Follow the procedure below to clean the interior of the server.  
WARNING  
Unplug all power cords.  
Unplug all power cords before performing any maintenance. Voltage is present  
inside the server and display unit even after the power is turned off. All voltage  
is removed only when the power cord is unplugged.  
1. Turn off the server and unplug all power cables.  
2. Remove the logic cover and drive cover. (See Chapter 9.)  
3. Use a small brush to loosen any dust and debris on the mother board.  
4. Use computer grade canned air to blow dust off components on the mother board.  
5. Use a small vacuum cleaner with plastic tip to vacuum out dust and debris from the  
interior of the server.  
6. Reinstall the left side cover. (See Chapter 9.)  
7. Reconnect all power cables and turn on the server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance 7-5  
Cleaning the Keyboard/Mouse  
Make sure that the server and peripheral devices are all off-powered (the POWER/SLEEP LED  
goes off), and then wipe the keyboard surface with a dry cloth.  
The mouse operation depends on the degree of smoothness of the internal ball rotation. To keep  
the mouse ball clean, use the mouse in a place with little dust. Follow the steps below to clean the  
mouse regularly:  
1. Prepare cold or lukewarm water, neutral detergent, alcohol, two dry soft clothes, and  
cotton swabs.  
2. Make sure that the server is off-powered (the POWER/SLEEP LED goes off).  
3. Turn the mouse upside down, and rotate the mouse ball cover counterclockwise to remove  
it.  
4. Take out the ball from the mouse. Cover the bottom of the mouse with your hand, and  
turn your hand holding the mouse (the mouse is on your palm with the button upward).  
The mouse ball is released onto your palm.  
Mouse ball  
Mouse ball cover  
Roller  
Bottom View  
5. Soak a soft cloth in neutral detergent that is diluted with cold or lukewarm water, and  
squeeze it firmly.  
6. Rub off stains on the mouse ball. Softly wipe the mouse ball with the cloth prepared in  
Step 5.  
7. Wipe the mouse ball with a dry soft cloth.  
8. Wipe three small rollers inside the mouse with a cotton swab soaked with alcohol. Wipe  
stains slowly and carefully by rotating rollers with the tip of the cotton swab.  
9. Blow out any dust from the mouse. Protect your eyes from the dust.  
10. Put the mouse ball back into the mouse.  
11. Place the mouse ball cover, and rotate it clockwise until it is locked.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-6 Maintenance  
Cleaning CD-ROM  
A dusty CD-ROM or dust-accumulated tray causes the device to fail to read data correctly.  
Follow the procedure below to clean the tray and CD-ROM regularly:  
1. Make sure that the server is powered (the POWER/SLEEP LED is lit).  
2. Press the CD tray Open/Close button on the front of the CD-ROM drive.  
The tray opens.  
3. Hold the CD-ROM lightly and take it out from the tray.  
NOTE: Do not touch the signal side of the CD-ROM with your hand.  
4. Wipe the tray with a dry soft cloth.  
IMPORTANT: Do not wipe the lens of the CD-ROM drive. Doing  
so may damage the lens and may cause a malfunction of the drive.  
5. Push on the tray front to close the tray.  
6. Wipe the signal side of the CD-ROM with a dry soft cloth.  
IMPORTANT: Wipe CD-ROMs from the center to the outside. Use  
only CD-ROM cleaner if necessary. Cleaning a CD-ROM with record  
spray/cleaner, benzene, or thinner causes damage to the CD-ROM  
contents. At worst, inserting the CD-ROM into the server may cause  
failure.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance 7-7  
SYSTEM DIAGNOSTICS  
The System Diagnostics runs several tests on the server.  
Use the System Diagnostics program in the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER provided with the server to  
diagnose the server.  
Test Items  
The following items are tested in system diagnostics.  
Memory  
CPU cache memory  
Hard disk drive used as a system  
IMPORTANT: When executing the System Diagnostics, make sure to  
remove the LAN cable. Executing the System Diagnostics with the  
LAN cable connected, the network may be influenced.  
NOTE: On checking the hard disk drive, no data is written into the  
disk.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-8 Maintenance  
Starting and Ending the System Diagnostics  
There are two ways to diagnose the server: to use the local console (keyboard) of the server itself,  
and to use the management PC via serial port (remote console).  
IMPORTANT: Two methods of LAN and the serial port are  
mentioned in Chapter 6 "NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" in the way of  
communicating in remote console. Use the serial port to execute  
System Diagnostics with remote console. The LAN connection is not  
for System Diagnostics.  
Procedures to start the diagnostics program is as follows:  
1. Shutdown the OS, and turn off the server. Then, unplug the power cord.  
2. Disconnect all the LAN cables from the server.  
3. Plug the power cord and turn on the server.  
4. Use the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM to reboot the server.  
See the Chapter 6 "NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" for details.  
The following menu appears when started the server using the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
Local console  
Remote console  
5. Select [Tools].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance 7-9  
6. Select [System Diagnostics].  
The System Diagnostics starts and completes in approximately three minutes.  
When the diagnosis completes, the screen of the display changes in the following  
indication.  
Diagnosis tool title  
Test windows title  
TeDoLi(TEst & Diagnosis On Linux) Ver001.00(Build020901.1.1m)  
Test result  
Test End  
Start10:06:58 End 10:09:58 Pass 000:03:00 TestTime 000:03:00  
Test End : NormalEnd  
03  
AbnormalEnd 00 ForceEnd 00  
<System>  
MEM  
CACHE  
<SCSI>  
Memory  
Cache  
16 count  
49 count  
NormalEnd  
NormalEnd  
HDD_02:000 DK32DJ-36W  
89 count  
NormalEnd  
[Enter] Detail Information  
[ESC] Return to Enduser Menu  
Guide line  
Test window  
Diagnosis tool title: shows a name of this diagnosis and Version information.  
Test windows title: shows the progress of diagnosis. When it completes, it shows "Test  
End"  
Test Result:  
shows the information including time of start, end and progress, and  
result of the diagnosis.  
Guide line:  
shows a description of keys to navigate the window.  
Test window:  
Move the cursor and press Enter to view the detail of the diagnosis.  
If an error is detected during the System Diagnostics, the test result shows "Abnormal  
End" in red color. Move the cursor and press Enter on the diagnosis which error  
occurred. Take a note of the error message showed, and contact your service  
representative.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-10 Maintenance  
7. Follow the Guide line showed in the bottom of the screen and press ESC to show the End  
user Menu showed below.  
TeDoLi (TEst & Diagnosis On Linux) Ver001.00 (Build020901.1.1m)  
Enduser Menu  
<Test Result>  
<Device List>  
<Log Info>  
<Option>  
<Reboot>  
Please choose a function by the arrow key and push Enter key.  
<Test Result> shows the screen of the diagnosis completed aforementioned.  
<Device List> shows the information of all the devices connected.  
<Log Info>  
shows the log information and error messages of the diagnosis. It can be  
saved to a floppy disk. To save the log information to a floppy disk,  
insert a formatted floppy disk to a floppy disk drive and select  
<Save(F)>.  
<Option>  
<Reboot>  
change where to output log.  
Restarts the Express Server.  
8. Select <Reboot> in the End user Menu above.  
The Express Server restarts, and NEC EXPRESSBUILDER boot the system.  
9. Exit the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER, and remove the CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive.  
10. Turn off the server and unplug the power cord from the receptacle.  
11. Reconnect all the LAN cables to the server.  
12. Plug the power code.  
This completes the System Diagnostics.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance 7-11  
RELOCATING/STORING THE SERVER  
Follow the procedure below to relocate or store the server:  
CAUTION  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may cause a fire, personal injury, or property damage. See  
pages 1-3 to 1-8 for details.  
Never attempt to lift the server only by yourself.  
Do not install the server in any place other than specified.  
Do not connect/disconnect any interface cable with the power cord of the  
server plugged to a power source.  
IMPORTANT:  
If the server needs to be relocated/stored due to a change in the floor  
layout to a great extent, contact the service representative.  
Make sure to make a backup copy of your valuable data in the hard  
disk drive, if any.  
Make sure not to apply a shock to hard disk drives to relocated the  
server if the contains any.  
1. Take a floppy disk and a CD-ROM out of the server, if any.  
2. Power off the server (the POWER/SLEEP LED goes off).  
3. Unplug the power cord of the server from a power outlet.  
4. Remove all the cables from the server.  
5. Hold the server by its bottom with at least three persons to carry the server.  
IMPORTANT: Do not hold the front door to lift the server. The  
front door may be disengaged from the server, causing personal injury.  
6. Protect the server with the shock-absorbing materials, and pack it securely.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-12 Maintenance  
(This page is intentionally left blank.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 8  
Troubleshooting  
If your server does not operate as expected, read this chapter before assuming a failure.  
NOTE: For provision against an unexpected failure, it is  
recommended to install the maintenance utility, NEC ESMPRO, to the  
server and client computers.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8-2 Troubleshooting  
SYSTEM VIEWERS  
Monitor the occurrence of fault by NEC ESMPRO during the system operation.  
Especially take note on whether any alert is reported to NEC ESMPRO Manager on the  
management PC. Check whether any alert is reported on the Operation Window, Data Viewer, or  
Alert Viewer of NEC ESMPRO Manager.  
[Example]  
NEC ESMPRO Manager  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-3  
LEDS  
The server includes LEDs to indicate the server states by a variety of colors and display patterns on  
the front panel, hard disk drive, and power supply.  
Chapter 2 "Status Indicators" lists the LED displays and their meanings and the actions taken at  
occurrences of failures.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-4 Troubleshooting  
ERROR MESSAGES  
If an error occurs in the server, an error message appears on the display unit connected to the server.  
Error Messages after Power-on  
Powering on the server automatically starts the self-diagnostic program, POST (Power On Self-  
Test). When the POST detects any error, it displays an error message and its measure on the  
display unit.  
Follow the table below to troubleshoot such errors. However, even when there is no hardware  
failure, use of the keyboard or mouse at the following timing causes the POST to assume a  
keyboard controller error and stop processing.  
Immediately after the server is powered  
Immediately after the system is rebooted in response to a keyboard instruction  
(simultaneous key entry of Ctrl + Alt + Delete)  
Immediately after the system is rebooted in response to an OS instruction  
During hardware initialization following restart of the POST  
When the POST detects a hardware failure due to the above reason, restart the server once again.  
If the same error message reappears, you may assume there is no hardware error. To ensure  
normal operation of the server, however, make sure to follow the following restrictions.  
Do not make any keyboard entry or use the mouse before the memory count appears on  
the screen following the server power-on.  
Do not make any keyboard entry or use the mouse before the start-up message of the SCSI  
Configuration Utility appears on the screen following the server reboot.  
IMPORTANT: Take a note on the on-screen message before  
contacting your service representative. The alarm indication would be  
a great help for maintenance.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-5  
POST Error Messages  
When POST detects an error, it displays an error message on the display unit screen. The  
following table lists error messages and actions to take.  
IMPORTANT: Take a note on the messages displayed before  
consulting with your service representative. Alarm messages are  
useful information for maintenance.  
Error  
Error message  
Recommended Action  
code  
0200  
0210  
0213  
Failure Fixed Disk.  
Stuck Key.  
Keyboard locked - Unlock key switch.  
Contact your service representative.  
Disconnect the keyboard and connect it again.  
Release the lock of the key switch. If the  
error cannot be corrected in spite of the  
release of the lock, contact your service  
representative.  
0220  
Monitor type does not match CMOS - Run  
SETUP.  
Start the SETUP. If the error cannot be  
corrected in spite of the start of SETUP,  
contact your service representative.  
0230  
0231  
0232  
0250  
System RAM Failed at offset.  
Shadow Ram Failed at offset.  
Extended RAM Failed at address line.  
System battery is dead - Replace and run  
SETUP.  
Contact your service representative.  
Contact your service representative to replace  
the battery. (After restarting the computer,  
start the SETUP to provide the setting again.)  
0251  
System CMOS checksum bad - Default  
configuration used.  
The default values have just been set. Start  
the SETUP to provide the setting again. If  
the error cannot be corrected, contact your  
service representative.  
0252  
Password checksum bad - Passwords  
cleared.  
The password has just been cleared. Start  
the SETUP to provide the setting again.  
0260  
0270  
0271  
System timer error.  
Real time clock error.  
Check date and time setting.  
Start the SETUP to set the date and time  
again. If the same error occurs successively  
in spite of the resetting, contact your service  
representative.  
02B0  
Diskette drive A error.  
Start the SETUP to set the "Legacy Floppy A"  
in the Main menu again. If the same error  
occurs successively in spite of the resetting,  
contact your service representative.  
02B2  
02D0  
Incorrect Drive A type - run SETUP.  
System cache error - Cache disabled.  
Start the SETUP to provide the setting again.  
If the error cannot be corrected, contact your  
service representative.  
The cache cannot be used. Contact your  
service representative.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-6 Troubleshooting  
Error  
code  
Error message  
Recommended Action  
02D1  
System Memory exceeds the CPU's caching Contact your service representative.  
limit.  
02F4  
02F5  
02F6  
02F7  
0B22  
0B28  
EISA CMOS not write able.  
DMA Test Failed.  
Software NMI Failed.  
Fail-safe Timer NMI Failed.  
Processors are installed out of order.  
Unsupported Processor detected on  
Processor 1.  
Unsupported Processor detected on  
Processor 2.  
Request the maintenance to replace the CPU.  
Make sure that the server supports the CPU.  
If you are not sure, contact your service  
representative to request the maintenance.  
0B29  
0B30  
0B31  
0B32  
0B33  
0B34  
0B35  
0B36  
0B37  
0B5F  
FAN1 Alarm occurred.  
FAN2 Alarm occurred.  
FAN3 Alarm occurred.  
FAN4 Alarm occurred.  
FAN5 Alarm occurred.  
FAN6 Alarm occurred.  
FAN7 Alarm occurred.  
FAN8 Alarm occurred.  
Contact your service representative to replace  
the fan.  
Forced to use Processor with error  
Because an error is detected in every CPU,  
the system is forcibly started. Contact your  
service representative.  
0B60  
0B61  
0B62  
0B70  
DIMM group #1 has been disabled  
DIMM group #2 has been disabled  
DIMM group #3 has been disabled  
The error occurred during temperature  
sensor reading.  
Contact your service representative.  
Contact your service representative.  
0B71  
0B74  
System Temperature out of the range.  
Contact your service representative to replace  
the fan.  
Contact your service representative.  
The error occurred during voltage sensor  
reading.  
0B75  
0B80  
0B81  
0B82  
0B83  
0B8B  
0B8C  
0B8D  
0B8E  
System voltage out of the range.  
BMC Memory Test Failed.  
BMC Firmware Code Area CRC check failed.  
BMC core Hardware failure.  
BMC 1BF or 0BF check failed.  
BMC progress check timeout.  
BMC command access failed.  
Could not redirect the console - BMC Busy -  
Could not redirect the console - BMC Error -  
Turn off the power once and then on again to  
start the server. If the error cannot be  
corrected, contact your service representative.  
Turn off the power once and then on again to  
start the server. If the error cannot be  
corrected, contact your service representative.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-7  
Error  
code  
Error message  
Recommended Action  
0B8F  
Could not redirect the console - BMC  
Parameter Error -  
Turn off the power once and then on again to  
start the server. If the error cannot be  
corrected, contact your service representative.  
0B90  
0B91  
0B92  
BMC Platform Information Area corrupted.  
BMC update firmware corrupted.  
Internal Use Area of BMC FRU corrupted.  
This is not a fatal error. Turn off the power  
once and then on again to restart the server.  
If the error cannot be corrected, contact your  
service representative.  
0B93  
0B94  
BMC SDR Repository empty.  
Turn off the power once and then on again to  
restart the server. If the error cannot be  
corrected, contact your service representative.  
This is not a fatal error. Turn off the power  
once and then on again to restart the server.  
If the error cannot be corrected, contact your  
service representative.  
IPMB signal lines do not respond.  
0B95  
BMC FRU device failure.  
This is not a fatal error. Turn off the power  
once and then on again to restart the server.  
If the error cannot be corrected, contact your  
service representative.  
0B96  
0B97  
0B98  
0B99  
0B9A  
BMC SDR Repository failure.  
BMC SEL device failure.  
BMC RAM test error.  
BMC Fatal hardware error.  
Management controller not responding.  
Turn off the power once and then on again to  
start the server. If the error cannot be  
corrected, contact your service representative.  
Update the RMC firmware. If the error cannot  
be corrected, contact your service  
representative.  
0B9B  
0B9C  
0B9D  
0B9E  
0B9F  
0BB0  
0BB1  
8100  
8101  
8102  
None  
Private I2C bus not responding.  
BMC internal exception.  
BMC A/D timeout error.  
SDR repository corrupt.  
SEL corrupt.  
SMBIOS – SROM data read error.  
SMBIOS – SROM data checksum bad.  
Memory Error detected in DIMM group #1.  
Memory Error detected in DIMM group #2.  
Memory Error detected in DIMM group #3.  
Expansion ROM not initialized – PCI Mass  
Turn off the power once and then on again to  
start the server. If the error cannot be  
corrected, contact your service representative.  
Contact your service representative.  
Contact your service representative to replace  
the DIMM in the relevant group.  
Disable initialization of the optional device  
Storage Controller in slot n (n: slot number) expansion ROM by using the BIOS SETUP  
utility (see Chapter 4).  
Use the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER to  
configure the remote management card (see  
Chapter 6).  
H/W Configuration of BMC is corrupted.  
!! Update BMC F/W Configuration by  
configuration tool !!  
!! Refer to BMC configuration manual !!  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-8 Troubleshooting  
Processor 1  
Processor 2  
DIMM #1  
Group #1  
DIMM #2  
DIMM #3  
Group #2  
DIMM #4  
DIMM #5  
Group #3  
DIMM #6  
DIMM #7  
Group #4  
DIMM #8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-9  
Beep Codes  
If an error occurs during the POST, the server beeps, indicating the type of error.  
Each number indicates the number of short beeps, and a hyphen indicates a pause. For example,  
the beep interval 1-5-2-2 indicates 1 beep, pause, 2 beeps, pause, 2 beeps, pause, and 3 beeps  
notifying that no processor is detected on the mother board.  
Beep code  
Description  
Recommended action  
1-2  
Option ROM initialization  
error  
1. Check if the optional add-in card is properly  
installed.  
2. Run the BIOS SETUP utility to check the IRQ  
assignment.  
3. Ask your service representative to replace the add-  
in card or mother board..  
3-3  
ROM checksum error  
Replace the mother board.  
1-2-2-3  
1-3-1-1  
DRAM refresh test error  
1. Check if the DIMM is properly installed.  
2. Remove the DIMM once, and then re-install it to  
check if it operates normally.  
3. Ask your service representative to replace the failed  
DIMM or mother board.  
1-3-1-3  
1-3-3-1  
Keyboard controller error  
1. Check if the keyboard is properly connected.  
2. Replace the mother board.  
1. Check if the DIMM is properly installed.  
2. Remove the DIMM once, and then re-install it to  
check if it operates normally.  
No memory or capacity  
check error  
DRAM address error  
DRAM test Low Byte  
error  
1-3-4-1  
1-3-4-3  
3. Ask your service representative to replace the failed  
DIMM or mother board..  
1-4-1-1  
DRAM test High Byte  
error  
1-5-1-1  
1-5-2-1  
1-5-4-4  
CPU startup error  
No CPU installed  
Abnormal voltage  
1. Check if the CPU is properly installed.  
2. Remove the CPU once, and then re-install it to  
check if it operates normally.  
3. Ask your service representative to replace the failed  
CPU.  
2-1-2-3  
2-2-3-1  
BIOS ROM copyright test Replace the mother board.  
error  
Unexpected interrupt test  
error  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-10 Troubleshooting  
SOLVING PROBLEMS  
When the server fails to operate as expected, see the following to find out your problem and follow  
the instruction given before asking for repair.  
If the server still fails to operate successfully after solving your problem, take a note on the on-  
screen message and contact your service representative.  
Problems with the Server  
Fail to power on the server:  
T Is the server is properly supplied with power?  
Check if the power cord is connected to a power outlet (or UPS) that meets the  
power specifications for the server.  
Make sure to use the power cord provided with the server. Check the power cord  
for broken shield or bent plugs.  
Make sure the power breaker for the connected power outlet is on.  
If the power cord is plugged to a UPS, make sure the UPS is powered and it  
outputs power. See the manual that comes with the UPS for details.  
Power supply to the server may be linked with the connected UPS using the BIOS  
setup utility of the server.  
<Menu to check: [Server] - [AC-LINK]>  
T Did you press the POWER switch?  
Press the POWER switch on the front of the server to turn on the power (the  
POWER LED lights).  
Fail to power off the server:  
T Is the POWER switch enabled?  
Restart the server and start the BIOS setup utility.  
<Menu to check: [Security] - [Power Switch Inhibit]>  
T Is the server running in the Secure Mode?  
The POWER switch is disabled in the Secure Mode. (Forced shutdown is also  
not available.) To release the Secure Mode, enter the password specified with the  
BIOS SETUP utility.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-11  
No screen display appears with beep:  
Check whether DIMMs are connected to the mating connectors firmly.  
Check whether DIMMs of different specifications are installed in the specific bank.  
See Chapter 9 for the specifications of DIMMs.  
DIMMs must be populated in pairs and in the following order:  
#5 and #6, #3 and #4, then #1 and #2.  
Installed DIMMs must be the same speed and must all be registered.  
Take a note of beep code pattern, and take appropriate action according to the table  
listed earlier in "Beep Codes".  
POST fails to complete:  
T Is the DIMM board installed?  
At least two DIMM boards are required for operation.  
DIMMs must be populated in pairs and in the following order:  
#5 and #6, #3 and #4, then #1 and #2.  
Installed DIMMs must be the same speed and must all be registered.  
T Is the memory size large?  
The memory check may take a few seconds if the memory size is large. Wait for  
a while.  
T Did you perform any keyboard or mouse operation immediately after you started the  
server?  
If you perform any keyboard or mouse operation immediately after start-up, POST  
may accidentally detect a keyboard controller error and stops proceeding. In  
such a case, restart the server once again. Do not perform any keyboard or  
mouse operation until the BIOS start-up message appears when you restart the  
server.  
T Does the server have contains appropriate memory boards or PCI devices?  
Operation of the server with unauthorized devices is not guaranteed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-12 Troubleshooting  
Fail to access to internal or external devices (or such devices fail to operate):  
T Are cables properly connected?  
Make sure that the interface cables and power cord are properly connected. Also  
make sure that the cables are connected in the correct order.  
T Is the power-on order correct?  
When the server has any external devices connected, power on the external  
devices first, then the server.  
T Did you install drivers for connected optional devices?  
Some optional devices require specific device drivers. Refer to the manual that  
comes with the device to install its driver.  
T Is BIOS configuration correct?  
When the server has PCI devices connected, make sure to set the PCI device  
interrupt and others with the BIOS SETUP utility of the server. (Most PCI  
devices generally do not require any change to the configuration, but some boards  
do require specific settings. Refer to the manual that comes with the board for  
details to make correct settings.  
<Menus to check: [Advanced] - [PCI Configuration] - [PCI Slot xx ROM]  
x: PCI slot number>  
Some devices connected to the serial or parallel port may require I/O port address  
or operation mode settings. Refer to the manual that comes with the board for  
details to make correct settings.  
<Menu to check: [Advanced] - [Peripheral Configuration]>  
The POWER switch and sleep feature are disabled:  
T Is the server in the Secure Mode?  
In the Secure Mode, the POWER switch and sleep feature are disabled. To  
release the Secure Mode, enter the password specified with the BIOS SETUP  
utility.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-13  
The keyboard or mouse fails to operate:  
T Is the cable properly connected?  
You must use the provided keyboard/mouse branch cable (Y cable) for this server.  
Make sure that the provided cable is connected to the correct connector on the rear  
of the server.  
The keyboard or mouse does not operate if it is connected when the server is  
powered (not applicable to USB devices). Power of the server first and connect  
it properly.  
T Is BIOS configuration correct?  
The keyboard and mouse may be disabled with the BIOS SETUP utility of the  
server. Check the settings with the BIOS SETUP utility.  
<Menus to check: [Advanced] - [Numlock]>  
T Are the server drivers installed?  
Refer to the manual that comes with your OS to check that the keyboard and  
mouse drivers are installed. (These drivers are installed along with the OS.)  
Some OS's allow you to change the keyboard and mouse settings. Refer to  
manual that comes with your OS to check that the keyboard and mouse settings  
are correct.  
T Is the server in the Secure Mode?  
In the Secure Mode, the keyboard and mouse are disabled. To release the Secure  
Mode, enter the password specified with the BIOS SETUP utility.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-14 Troubleshooting  
Fail to access (read or write) to the floppy disk:  
T Does the floppy disk drive contain a floppy disk?  
Insert a floppy disk into the floppy disk drive until it clicks.  
T Is the floppy disk write-protected?  
Place the write-protect switch on the floppy disk to the "Write-enabled" position.  
T Is the floppy disk formatted?  
Use a formatted floppy disk or format the floppy disk in the floppy disk drive.  
Refer to the manual that comes with the OS for formatting a floppy disk.  
T Is BIOS configuration correct?  
The floppy disk drive may be disabled with the BIOS SETUP utility of the server.  
Check the setting with the BIOS SETUP utility.  
<Menus to check:  
[Main] - [Floppy A]  
[Security] - [Diskette Write Protect]  
T Is the server in the Secure Mode?  
In the Secure Mode, write access to the floppy disk may be disabled. To release  
the Secure Mode, enter the password specified with the BIOS SETUP utility.  
Fail to access to the CD-ROM:  
T Is the CD-ROM properly set in the CD-ROM drive tray?  
The tray is provided with a holder to secure the CD-ROM. Make sure that the  
CD-ROM is placed properly in the holder.  
T Is the CD-ROM applicable to the server?  
The CD-ROM for Macintosh is not available for use.  
T Is the flex bay installed correctly?  
Reinstall the flex bay (see Chapter 9).  
Inserted the correct CD-ROM but the message like the following is displayed:  
The CD-ROM is not inserted or the wrong CD-ROM is inserted.  
Please insert the correct CD-ROM.  
OK  
T Is the data side of the CD-ROM dirty or injured?  
Take the CD-ROM out of the CD-ROM drive, confirm that it is not dirty or  
injured, reset and click [OK].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-15  
Fail to access the hard disk drive:  
(Refer to the documentation supplied with the disk array controller.)  
T Is the hard disk drive applicable to the server?  
Operation of any device that is not authorized by NEC is not guaranteed.  
T Is the hard disk drive properly installed?  
Make sure to lock the hard disk drive with the lever on its handle. The hard disk  
drive is not connected to the internal connector when it is not completely installed  
(see Chapter 9).  
Fail to access the (internal or external) SCSI devices:  
T Is the SCSI device applicable to the server?  
Operation of any SCSI device that is not authorized by NEC is not guaranteed.  
T Are SCSI devices properly configured?  
When the server has external SCSI devices connected, hard disk drive settings,  
including SCSI ID and terminator, are required. Refer to the manual that comes  
with the SCSI device for details.  
T Are the SCSI controllers (including optional controllers) properly configured?  
Use the SCSI BIOS setup utility for proper configuration of SCSI devices  
connected to the SCSI connector on the mother board. When the server has an  
optional SCSI controller installed and SCSI devices connected to it, use the SCSI  
BIOS setup utility that comes with the optional SCSI controller for proper  
configuration. See the manual that comes with the optional SCSI controller for  
details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-16 Troubleshooting  
The server is not found on the network:  
T Is the LAN cable connected?  
Make sure to connect the LAN cable to the network port on the rear of the server.  
Also make sure that the LAN cable to use conforms with the network interface  
standard.  
T Is BIOS configuration correct?  
The internal LAN controller may be disabled with the BIOS SETUP utility of the  
server. Check the setting with the BIOS SETUP utility.  
<Menus to check:  
[Advanced] - [PCI Configuration] - [Onboard NIC] - [Embedded NIC (Dual  
Gbit)]>  
T Have the protocol and service already configured?  
Install the distinctive network driver for the server. Make sure that the protocol,  
such as TCP/IP, and services are properly specified.  
T Is the transfer speed correct?  
Open the network property dialog box in control panel to specify the "Link Speed  
& Duplex" value the same as the value specified for HUB.  
Wake on LAN does not start from standby state.  
T Is Hub set to Auto-Negotiation? Or, Is the client set to Auto-Negotiation/optimum  
speed?  
For both hub and client, Wake on LAN does not start from the standby state if the  
speed is fixed to 1000Mbps.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-17  
Problems with Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
There are some cases that an event log is registered as follows when you install Windows  
Server 2003 x64 Editions.  
Source:  
DCOM  
Error  
Category  
Event ID  
10016  
Description: The application-specific permission settings do not grant Local Activation  
permission for the COM server application with CLSID {555F3418-D99E-  
4E51-800A-6E89CFD8B1D7} to the user {NT AUTHORITY\LOCAL  
SERVICE} SID {S-1-5-19}.  
This security permission can be modified using the component Services administrative  
tool.  
It is not a problem in operating the system.  
There are some cases that an event log is registered as follows when you install Windows  
Server 2003 x64 Editions.  
Event Source: Service Control Manager  
Event Type: Error  
Event ID:  
7011  
Description: Timeout (30000 milliseconds) waiting for a transaction response from the  
IMAP4Svc service.  
When this event is not registered by rebooting the system, it is not a problem in  
operating the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-18 Troubleshooting  
Problems with Windows Server 2003 R2  
There are some cases that an event log is registered as follows when you operate Windows  
Server 2003 R2.  
Source:  
Type:  
IPMIDRV  
Error  
Event ID:  
1001  
Description: The IPMI device driver attempted to determine if the system supported an IPMI BMC  
device. The driver attempted to detect the presence of the IPMI BMC by searching the  
SMBIOS for Type 38 record. But either no record was found or the record was not  
compatible with the version of the device driver.  
If a SMBIOS Type 38 record was detected, the Dump Data field of the event contains  
a binary representation of the record.  
If you use "Hardware Management" which is provided by Windows Server 2003  
R2, above-shown event log will be registered.  
For more details, refer to "Enabling the Hardware Management Feature bundled in  
Windows Server 2003 R2" on the following site.  
[NEC Express5800 Web Site]  
http://www.nec.co.jp/express/download/W2K3_R2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-19  
Problems with Windows Server 2003 and Windows 2000  
Cannot install the operating system correctly.  
T Did you confirm the notes on installing the operating system?  
See Chapter 6.  
During Windows 2000 installation, the following warning is registered in the System Log of the  
Event Viewer:  
Error detected on the device \Device\CdRom0  
during the paging operation.  
There is no problem on this issue.  
Fail to start the OS:  
T Is a floppy disk in the floppy disk drive?  
Take out the floppy disk and restart the server.  
T Is the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM in the CD-ROM drive?  
Take out the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM and restart the server.  
T Is the OS broken?  
Use recovery process to recover the system. (See "Recovery for Windows 2000  
System" in this Chapter.)  
The event log after every logon to Windows 2000 includes the following error log:  
Description (D)  
The CPUs in this multiprocessor system are not all the same revision level.  
To use all processors the operating system restricts itself to the features of  
the least capable processor in the system. Should problems occur with  
this system, contact the CPU manufacture to see if this mix of processors  
is supported.  
T Has the CPU been expanded?  
If the different revision (stepping) of the processor is installed in the  
multiprocessor system, Windows logs the above information every startup. If  
this message is logged, it is no problem for operation.  
The OS presents unstable operation:  
T Did you update the system?  
Installing a network drive after installation of the OS may cause unstable  
operation. Use the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM to update the system.  
(See Chapter 6.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-20 Troubleshooting  
The system does not restart automatically when a stop error occurs, though the system is  
adjusted to automatically restarting.  
When the system does not restart automatically, restart it manually.  
The system restarts automatically when a stop error occurs, though the system is NOT  
adjusted to automatically restarting.  
There is no problem about this issue.  
Check the System Event Log to confirm that STOP error occurred.  
Cannot turn the power OFF at the blue screen:  
If you want to turn off the power at the blue screen, execute forced shutdown  
(forced shutdown: continue to press POWER switch for 4 seconds). The power  
will not be turned off if you press the switch for less than 3 seconds.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-21  
Problems with NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
When the server is not booted from the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM, check the following:  
T Did you set the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER during POST and restart the server?  
If you do not set the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER during POST and restart the  
server, an error message will appear or the OS will boot.  
T Is BIOS configuration correct?  
The boot device order may be specified with the BIOS SETUP utility of the server.  
Use the BIOS SETUP utility to change the boot device order to boot the system  
from the CD-ROM drive first.  
<Menu to check: [Boot]>  
T Is an error message appeared?  
When an error occurs while the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER is in progress, the  
following message appears. After this message appears, check the error and take  
the appropriate corrective action according to the message listed in the table  
below.  
Message  
Cause and Remedy  
This machine is not supported.  
This NEC EXPRESSBUILDER version is not  
designed for this server. Execute the NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER on the compliant server.  
NvRAM access error  
Hard disk access error  
An access to the nonvolatile memory  
(NvRAM) is not acceptable.  
The hard disk drive is not connected or it is  
failed.  
Check whether the hard disk drive is correctly  
connected.  
The system-specific information  
The system-specific information can't be  
does not exist on the baseboard. acquired in the mother board exchange and  
so on.  
Please restore the backup data  
or write the data by using  
[System Information  
Management] of the Off-line  
Maintenance Utility.  
Only the authorized personnel  
are allowed to do this operation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-22 Troubleshooting  
Problems with Express Setup  
Express Setup can not be used  
Express Setup do not support the installation of Microsoft Windows Server 2003  
x64 Editions.  
If you want to perform re-setup, see Appendix D and perform "Manual Setup".  
Following message appeared when you tried to install Express Setup to the hard disk drive  
that has smaller capacity than the specified partition size:  
The specified partition size has exceeded the capacity of the hard disk.  
The setup created the partition at the maximum size that can be reserved on the hard disk.  
Setup will continue the process.  
OK  
It is not an abnormal condition. Press Enter to continue the installation.  
The message can not be displayed correctly when copying the files from CD-ROM or checking  
CD-ROM:  
Press R. When the message appears again even if you press R, restart the Express  
Setup from the beginning. In case the same result occurred after the restart of  
installation, contact Maintenance Service Company and ask them to check the CD-  
ROM drive.  
Express Setup terminated and asks to input setup information.  
There are some errors on the specified setup information.  
Follow the instruction to input the correct value. It is not necessary to cancel the  
installation. On Windows 2000, you might be asked to press Enter again after the  
last reboot of the setup.  
[Complete] appears on the [Role of Computer] screen.  
If you click [Complete] here, the setup will select the default value of Express Setup  
for the later specification to continue the process.  
<The Default Value>  
The specification of network protocol  
Protocol :  
Service :  
Client :  
TCP/IP[DHCP Specified]  
Select sharing Microsoft network files and printer.  
Microsoft network client.  
Component : SNMP, IIS (Excluding Windows Server 2003)  
Application : NEC ESMPRO Agent  
Power Console Plus  
(if N8103-80/81 RAID controller is installed in the system)  
MegaRAID Storage Manager  
(if N8103-91 RAID controller is installed in the system)  
Adaptec Storage Manager (When using HostRAID)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-23  
The following error log is included in the event log while operating the system:  
Event ID:  
Source:  
Type:  
16  
iANSMiniport  
Error  
Category:  
None  
Description: Team #0:The last adapter has lost link.  
Network connection has been lost.  
Though the above error is included in the event log when specifying the teaming, the  
LAN driver can work properly.  
[Complete] does not appear on [Role of Computer] screen.  
The [Complete] does not appear if the Setup File that has already been created is  
loaded.  
[Complete] appears only when you first entered the [Role of Computer] screen.  
Once you go to the next screen from [Role of Computer], the [Complete] will not  
appear even if you enter [Back] to go back to the [Role of Computer] screen.  
Select [Use Existing Array] at [New/Existing RAID Configuration], but the OS is installed in the  
whole area of the disk.  
Is there any other partition than the partition to re-use (excluding maintenance area)?  
If the partition other than the one to re-use does not exist, the setup will reserve the  
whole area of the disk to install Windows 2000.  
Specified to join the Domain, but the system is installed as Workgroup.  
When the setup fails to join the Domain during the installation, it will install the  
system as Workgroup. Open [System] in Control Panel to specify joining the  
Domain.  
Specified large value as partition size, but when Windows 2000 is actually started, the system  
partition is created by 4095MB.  
Is the [Partition Size] specified by the value larger than the real area? If you want to  
create one partition in all area of the hard disk drive (excluding the maintenance area)  
to install the OS, specify [All Area].  
<For Windows 2000>  
Are you specifying over 200GB for the partition size?  
Be sure to specify less than 200GB for the partition size.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-24 Troubleshooting  
Windows 2000 started with different display resolution from the specified value.  
If the specified display resolution can not be used, the system will use the nearest  
value or the default value of the driver.  
Entered the incorrect Product ID/CD key.  
Even if you entered the incorrect Product ID/CD key, Express Setup will start.  
However, the setup will stop and asks you to re-enter the correct value. Also in this  
case, input request will occur when rebooting after GUI setup completed during  
Express Setup. If these 2 inputs are done correctly, there is no problem on Windows  
2000 setup.  
Unable to specify the details of Network adapter.  
In Express Setup, you can not specify the details of Network adapter. Specify them  
from Control Panel after starting Windows 2000.  
Windows 2000 is started with Network adapter that has not been specified during Express  
Setup  
Windows 2000 will install the recognized Network adapter specified as default value.  
If you want to modify the specification, it can be done from Control Panel after  
starting Windows 2000. Also, the Network adapter that has been specified during  
Express Setup but that is not connected will not be setup, though the protocol will  
only be installed.  
Connected more than two Network adapter and specified different protocol for each adapter,  
but all the protocols are specified on either adapter.  
It's a design. Each adapter is specified so that all the installed protocols can be used.  
The value that can not be specified during Express Setup will all be specified by  
default value.  
When more than two Network adapter are specified, the detailed specification of TCP/IP  
protocol are all set to use DHCP.  
When more than two Network adapter are specified, the detailed specification of the  
protocol may all be set by default value. Re-specify the details from Control Panel.  
Not more than two Network adapter is connected, but the detailed specification of the protocol  
are all set by default.(e.g. Specified IP Address on TCP/IP, but DHCP is specified)  
Are you specifying more than two protocols?  
In this case, the situation will be the same as connecting more than two Network  
adapter, so the detailed specification of the protocol are all set by default.  
Re-specify the details from Control Panel after starting the OS.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-25  
The following message appears on the screen and the setup is suspended while the Express  
Setup is executing:  
Bad Command or filename  
Insufficient disk space  
Follow the procedure described below and check the BIOS settings for the SCSI  
controller.  
As for the procedure on the SCSI controller which is not described in this User's  
Guide, refer to the manual accompanied with the controller and check the setting for  
"Int13 Extensions".  
<In case the SCSI Controller is AIC-7892>  
1. Press Ctrl + A when POST displays "AIC-7892".  
2. Select "Configure/View Host Adapter Settings".  
3. Select "Advanced Configuration Options" and press Enter.  
4. Change the setting of "BIOS Support for Int13 Extensions" to "Enabled".  
5. Exit from BIOS setup menu and restart the system.  
6. Start the Express Setup.  
Setup is interrupted at "Creating a working partition" process during the Express Setup.  
T Did you connect the hard disk drive that OS is not going to be installed?  
Disconnect the hard disk drive that OS is not going to be installed, and perform  
the Express Setup.  
Problems with Master Control Menu  
The master control menu fails to appear:  
T Is your system Windows NT 4.0 or later, or Windows 95 or later?  
The menu is only able to run on Windows NT 4.0 (or later) or Windows 95 (or  
later).  
T Is Shift pressed?  
Setting the CD-ROM with Shift pressed down cancels the Autorun feature.  
T Is the system in the proper state?  
The menu may not appear depending on the system registry setting or the timing  
to set the CD-ROM. In such a case, start the Explorer and run \MC\1ST.EXE in  
the CD-ROM.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-26 Troubleshooting  
Problems with Configuration Diskette Creator  
The bit map of the Configuration Diskette Creator window is not displayed correctly  
during setting of setup information. (When the Trekking command is used)  
If the specified number of colors is fewer than 256 in the display setting, the bit map  
is not displayed correctly, but the setup information can be displayed correctly.  
The Point to Point tunneling protocol cannot be set.  
The protocol is not supported at present. After installation, set the protocol through  
Control Panel. In this case, rebooting is not necessary.  
The details of a network adapter cannot be set.  
Configuration Diskette Creator is unable to set the details of network adapters. Start  
Windows 2000/Windows Server 2003, and set the details through Control Panel.  
More than one network board is connected during setting of setup information, but  
TCP/IP cannot be set for each network.  
Perform the installation procedure during DHCP setting. To create a temporary IP  
configuration, perform the installation procedure during DHCP setting, and then set  
TCP/IP again through Control Panel.  
Problems with Disk Array Configuration  
Refer to the manual that comes with the disk array controller for any trouble occurred on disk array  
in this system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-27  
COLLECTING EVENT LOG  
This section describes on how to collect the log of various events that occurred on the server.  
IMPORTANT: If STOP error, system error, or stall occurred, follow  
the procedure below after restarting the system.  
NOTE: The different revision processor may be mixed in additional  
CPU kit. When Windows 2000 is used, following message may be  
appeared in the System Log of the Event Viewer after extension the  
different revision of two or more CPUs in the NEC Express server. If  
this message is logged, it is no problem for operation.  
1. Click [Management Tool] [Event Viewer] from the Control Panel.  
2. Select the type of the log to collect.  
On [Application Log], the events related to the running application is archived. On  
[Security Log], the events related to the security is archived. On [System Log], the  
events occurred at the item which configures Windows 2000 system is archived.  
3. Click [Save as...] in the [Run] menu.  
4. Input the file name of archived log in the [File Name] box.  
5. Select the type of the log file you want to save in the [File Type] list box and click [OK].  
For more information, refer to Windows 2000 Online Help.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-28 Troubleshooting  
COLLECTING CONFIGURATION INFORMATION  
This section describes on how to collect the information on hardware configuration and inside  
specification.  
In order to collect information, "Diagnostic Program" is used.  
IMPORTANT: If STOP error, system error, or stall occurred, follow  
the procedure below after restarting the system.  
<For Windows Server 2003>  
Refer to Windows online help.  
<For Windows 2000>  
1. Point to [Settings] in Start menu, and click [Control Panel].  
The [Control Panel] dialog box appears.  
2. Double-click [Management Tool], and double-click [Computer Management].  
The [Computer Management] dialog box appears.  
3. Click [System Tool] [System Information].  
4. Click [Save as System Information File] in the [Operation] menu.  
5. Input the file name to save in the [File Name] box.  
6. Click [Save].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-29  
COLLECTING DR. WATSON DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION  
Dr. Watson collects diagnostic information related to application errors. The location to save the  
information can be specified as you like. For more information, refer to Chapter 5.  
MEMORY DUMP  
If an error occurs, the dump file should be saved to acquire necessary information.  
If you saved the dump to DAT, write down that it is saved as "NTBackup" or "ARCServe" on the  
label. You can specify the location to save the diagnostic information as you like.. For more  
information, refer to "Specifying Memory Dump (Debug Information (refer to Chapter 5 for  
detail)".  
IMPORTANT:  
Consult with your service representative before dumping the  
memory. Dumping the memory while the server is in the  
successful operation may affect the system operation.  
Restarting the system due to an error may display a message  
indicating insufficient virtual memory. Ignore this message and  
proceed. Restarting the system may result in dumping improper  
data.  
Preparing for Memory Dumping  
Memory dumping with the DUMP switch may disable the server to restart. In such a case, it is  
required to force the server to shut down. This forced shutdown, however, is not available if  
"Enable" is selected for "Power Switch Inhibit" on the Security menu of the BIOS setup utility,  
SETUP, because this setting disables POWER switch operation.  
Follow the procedure below to change the setting to enable the forced shutdown and restart of the  
server.  
1. Power on the server and start the BIOS setup utility, SETUP.  
2. Select "Disable" for "Power Switch Inhibit" in the Security menu.  
3. Save the configuration data and exit the SETUP.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-30 Troubleshooting  
Saving the Dump File  
Press the DUMP switch to save the dump file when an error occurs. Insert a metal pin (a  
straightened large paper clip will make a substitute) into the switch hole to press the DUMP switch.  
DUMP  
switch  
Pressing the DUMP switch saves the dump file in the specified directory. (Memory dumping may  
not be available when the CPU stalls.)  
IMPORTANT: Do not use a toothpick or plastic stick that is easy to  
break.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-31  
RECOVERY FOR Windows 2000 SYSTEM  
If any file necessary for running the OS is damaged, use the following procedures to recover the  
system.  
IMPORTANT:  
After recovering the system, see "Updating the System" in Chapter  
5 and be sure to update the system.  
Also on Windows 2000, you need to update all the drivers after the  
system update. For more information, see "Installing and Setting  
Device Drivers" in Chapter 5.  
Concerning Windows 2000, see "Installing and Setting Device  
Drivers" and "Updating the System" in Chapter 5 and be sure to  
update both the drivers and the system.  
If the hard disk drive can not be recognized, you can not recover the  
system.  
Follow the procedure below and use the information in the disk, not system recovery disk, to  
recover the system.  
1. Turn on the system power.  
2. Insert the Windows 2000 CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
3. Press Ctrl + Alt + Delete to reset the system.  
After a bootable operating system has been installed on the hard disk drive, press Enter  
while the message "Press any key to boot from CD..." is displayed at the top of the screen.  
If no bootable operating system exists on the hard disk drive, this step is unnecessary.  
The Windows 2000 setup screen will appear.  
If the screen is not displayed, Enter was not pressed properly.  
Begin after turning on the system power again.  
4. Press F6 in a few seconds when the window is in either of the following states.  
"Setup is inspecting your computer's hardware configuration ..." is displayed.  
A screen with a solid blue background is displayed.  
IMPORTANT: There is no visible indication on screen when F6 has  
been pressed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-32 Troubleshooting  
5. When the following message is displayed, press S.  
Setup could not determine the type of one or more mass storage devices  
installed in your system, or you have chosen to manually specify an adapter.  
Currently, Setup will load support for the following mass storage devices.  
The following message is displayed.  
Please insert the disk labeled  
manufacturer-supplied hardware support disk  
into Drive A:  
*Press ENTER when ready.  
6. Insert the Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER into the floppy disk  
drive, and press Enter.  
A list of mass storage devices is displayed.  
SCSI Model: Select the [Adaptec Ultra320 SCSI Cards (Win2000)] and press Enter.  
Then, it returns to the screen of Procedure 5.  
7. Select the proper SCSI Adapter and press Enter.  
– Adaptec HostRAID U320 Driver Ver 1.02 For Windows 2000/XP/2003  
(When SCSI HostRAID is installed.)  
– MegaRAID SCSI 320-1 Controller Driver (When N8103-80F board is installed.)  
– MegaRAID SCSI 320-2 Controller Driver (When N8103-81F board is installed.)  
– Adaptec I2O RAID Driver Disk for 32bit Windows 2000/XP/2003  
(When N8103-86 board is installed.)  
8. Press R to select the recovery option.  
9. If you are requested, press R to select system recovery procedure.  
10. If you are requested, select either of the procedure below:  
[Manual Recovery] (Press M)  
Do not select this option unless you are a high-level user or a system administrator.  
If you use this option, you can recover the problems of system files, partition boot  
sector, and start-up environment.  
[Quick Recovery] (Press F)  
This option is very easy to use and the user does not need to do anything during the  
procedure. If you select this option, the system recovery disk program starts to  
recover the problems concerning system files, partition boot sector of system disk,  
and start-up environment (if multiple operating systems are installed on the system).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-33  
11. Follow the instruction displayed on the screen, and then press L at the screen which  
request you to insert system recovery disk. The system will be restarted once.  
NOTE: Starts the procedure without system recovery disk.  
12. Repeat steps 4 to 11.  
The recovery procedure will be started.  
During the recovery, the missing files and the damaged files are replaced either to the files  
in C:\ I386 folder of hard disk drive or the files in systemroot\ Repair of the system  
partition. These replaced files do not reflect the changes of the configuration after the  
setup at all.  
13. Follow the instruction displayed on the screen.  
If you take a note of any file name in which trouble is detected during the procedure, it is  
useful to diagnose how the system has been damaged.  
14. Terminates the procedure if the recovery is successful.  
You can verify that the replaced files are correctly copied to the hard disk drive if the  
computer is restarted normally.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-34 Troubleshooting  
OFF-LINE MAINTENANCE UTILITY  
The Off-line Maintenance Utility is an OS-independent maintenance program. When you are  
unable to start the OS-dependent NEC ESMPRO to troubleshoot a problem, the Off-line  
Maintenance Utility can be used.  
IMPORTANT:  
The Off-line Maintenance Utility is intended for use of your service  
representative. The NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM and the  
Off-line Maintenance Utility Bootable FD you have created contain  
a file that describes operation of the utility, but do not attempt to use  
the utility by yourself. Contact your service representative and  
follow instructions.  
Starting the Off-line Maintenance Utility disables any access from a  
client to the server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-35  
Starting the Off-line Maintenance Utility  
The Off-line Maintenance Utility may be started in the following ways.  
From the CD-ROM  
Set the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM in the CD-ROM drive and reboot the  
system.  
After the menu is displayed on the screen, select "Tools" - "Off-line Maintenance Utility".  
The Off-line Maintenance Utility program starts from the CD-ROM.  
From the floppy disk  
Set the Off-line Maintenance Utility Bootable FD in the floppy disk drive and reboot the  
system.  
The Off-line Maintenance Utility program starts from the boot disk.  
The Off-line Maintenance Utility Bootable FD is created by selecting "Tools" - "Create  
Support FD" on the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
Manual start (by pressing F4)  
When the Off-line Maintenance Utility is installed, press F4 while the start-up screen of  
the server is on screen. The Off-line Maintenance Utility starts from the hard disk drive.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-36 Troubleshooting  
Features of Off-line Maintenance Utility  
The Off-line Maintenance Utility provides the following features. (Available features vary  
depending on the way you started the Off-line Maintenance Utility.)  
IMPORTANT: See the on-line help for details of the Off-line  
Maintenance Utility. For further information, ask your service  
representative.  
IPMI Information Viewer  
Provides the functions to view the system event log (SEL), sensor data record (SDR), and  
field replaceable unit (FRU) and to make a backup copy of them.  
Using this feature, you can find system errors and events to determine a maintenance part.  
BIOS Setup Viewer  
Provides the functions to export the current configuration data defined with the SETUP  
utility to a text file.  
System Information Viewer  
Provides the functions to view information on the processor and the BIOS and export it to  
a text file.  
System Information Management  
Provides the function to make a back-up copy of your data.  
Without the backup data, the system-specific information and/or configuration may not be  
restored.  
Only the authorized personnel is allowed to restore the backup data.  
Start of Utilities  
With the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER, you can start the following utilities installed in the  
maintenance partition.  
System Management  
System Diagnostics  
Maintenance Partition Update  
Chassis Identify  
This function can distinguish the machine with the LED or buzzer of the machine. This is  
convenient if you have to distinguish a machine among many machines on the rack.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting 8-37  
RESETTING THE SERVER  
If the server halts before starting the OS, press and hold Ctrl and Alt and press Delete.  
This restarts the server.  
IMPORTANT: Resetting the server clears the DIMM memory and the  
data in process. To reset the server when it is not frozen, make sure  
that no processing is in progress.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-38 Troubleshooting  
FORCED SHUTDOWN  
Use this function when an OS command does not shut down the server, the POWER switch does not  
turn off the server, or resetting does not work.  
Press and hold the POWER switch on the server for at least four seconds. The power is forcibly  
turned off. To turn on the power back again, wait approximately 10 seconds after turning off the  
power (forced shutdown).  
POWER switch  
IMPORTANT: If the remote power-on function is used, cycle the  
power once to load the OS, and turn off the power again in the normal  
way.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 9  
Upgrading Your Server  
This chapter describes internal optional devices available for the server, procedures for install or  
removing such optional devices, and notes on using them.  
IMPORTANT:  
Optional devices described in this chapter may be installed or  
removed by any user. However, NEC does not assume any liability  
for damage to optional devices or the server or malfunctions of the  
server resulted from installation by the user. NEC recommends you  
ask your service representative for install or removing any optional  
devices.  
Make sure to use only optional devices and cables authorized by  
NEC. Repair of the server due to malfunctions, failures, or damage  
resulted from installing such devices or cables will be charged.  
When you made any change to the hardware configuration, make  
sure to update the system (see Chapter 5 for details.).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
9-2 Upgrading Your Server  
SAFETY NOTES  
Observe the following notes to install or remove optional devices safely and properly.  
WARNING  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may result in death or serious personal injury. See pages 1-3  
to 1-8 for details.  
Do not disassemble, repair, or alter the server.  
Do not look into the CD-ROM drive.  
Do not remove the lithium battery.  
Disconnect the power plug before working with the server.  
CAUTION  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may cause a fire, personal injury, or property damage. See  
pages 1-3 to 1-8 for details.  
Do not lift the server only by a single person.  
Make sure to complete board installation.  
Do not install the server on the rack leaving the cover removed.  
Do not install the server on the rack halfway.  
Do not pinch your fingers with mechanical component.  
Avoid installation in extreme temperature conditions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-3  
ANTI-STATIC MEASURES  
The server contains electronic components sensitive to static electricity. Avoid failures caused by  
static electricity when installing or removing any optional devices.  
Wear a wrist strap (an arm belt or anti-static glove).  
Wear a wrist strap on your wrist. If no wrist strap is available, touch an unpainted metal  
part of the cabinet before touching a component to discharge static electricity from your  
body.  
Touch a metal part regularly when working with components to discharge static  
electricity.  
Select a suitable work space.  
Work with the server on the anti-static or concrete floor.  
When you work with the server on a carpet where static electricity is likely to be  
generated, make sure take anti-static measures beforehand.  
Use a work table.  
Place the server on an anti-static mat to work with it.  
Cloth  
Do not wear a wool or synthetic cloth to work with the server.  
Wear anti-static shoes to work with the server.  
Take off any jewels (a ring, bracelet, or wrist watch) before working with the  
server.  
Handling of components  
Keep any component in an anti-static bag until you actually install it to the server.  
Hold a component by its edge to avoid touching any terminals or parts.  
To store or carry any component, place it in an anti-static bag.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-4 Upgrading Your Server  
PREPARING FOR INSTALLATION AND REMOVAL  
Follow the procedure below to prepare for installing or removing components.  
1. Shut down the OS.  
2. Remove the front bezel from the chassis if installed.  
3. Press the POWER switch to power off the server (the POWER LED goes off).  
4. Remove all cables and power cords from the server.  
Prepare a Phillips screwdriver and a flat-head screwdriver to install or remove the component.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-5  
CONFIRMATION AFTER INSTALLATION/REMOVAL  
Confirm the following after installing an additional option and removing a component:  
Installing removed components exactly as they were  
Install the components and cables, which were removed and disconnected for addition of  
an option, exactly as they were. Assembling without a component being installed or a  
cable being disconnected causes the server to malfunction.  
Confirming that no parts such as screws are left in the server  
Confirm that particularly conductive parts such as screws are not left in the server.  
Turning on the power with a conductive part on the mother board or cable terminal causes  
the server to malfunction.  
Confirming the cooling effect in the server  
Confirm that the ventilating holes are not covered with an internally connected cable.  
Insufficient cooling effect raises the internal temperature, which causes the server to  
malfunction.  
Confirming operation with a tool  
Some additional devices require the diagnostic utility or BIOS SETUP utility to check if  
they are installed correctly. For details, see the procedure for additionally installing the  
target device.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-6 Upgrading Your Server  
DEVICE INSTALLATION OR REMOVAL PROCEDURE  
Install or remove a component from the server in the following procedure.  
Hard Disk Drive  
The server has six device bay slots to install hard disk drives with the SCA2 interface (Ultra 320  
SCSI) in the disk bay of the front of the server.  
IMPORTANT:  
Do not use any hard disk drives that are not authorized by NEC.  
Installing a third-party hard disk drive may cause a failure of the  
server as well as the hard disk drive. Purchase hard disk drives of  
the following models:  
<SCSI>  
N8150-163F (73.2 GB, 10,000 rpm, Ultra 320)  
N8150-171F (146 GB, 10,000 rpm, Ultra 320)  
N8150-192 (300 GB, 10,000 rpm, Ultra 320)  
N8150-165F (36.3 GB, 15,000 rpm, Ultra 320)  
N8150-172F (73.2 GB, 15,000 rpm, Ultra 320)  
N8150-193 (146 GB, 15,000 rpm, Ultra 320)  
<SAS: when N8154-10 SAS back panel is installed>  
N8150-199 (36.3 GB, 15,000 rpm, SAS)  
N8150-200 (73.2 GB, 15,000 rpm, SAS)  
N8150-201 (146 GB, 15,000 rpm, SAS)  
To make array configuration, specify RAID0, RAID1, or RAID5 as  
the RAID level.  
Up to six hard disk drives can be installed in standard mode. If  
using the flex bay, you can install up to seven hard disk drives.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-7  
SCSI ID / SAS Port  
The hard disk drive bay may contain up to six hard disk drives. The SCSI IDs or SAS port numbers  
are factory-assigned to hard disk drives as shown below.  
SCSI ID 0  
SAS Port 0  
SCSI ID 3  
SAS Port 3  
SCSI ID 1  
SAS Port 1  
SCSI ID2  
SAS Port 2  
SCSI ID 4  
SAS Port 4  
SCSI ID 5  
SAS Port 5  
The hard disk drive bays are connected to the SCSI connector on the mother board when the server  
is shipped. To use the hard disk drives in a disk array configuration, run the SCSI BIOS utility (see  
Chapter 4). If you have an optional RAID controller, install it to your server and reconnect the cable  
from the connector on the mother board to the RAID controller connector. For the cable  
reconnection, see "Disk Array Controller".  
A dummy block is installed in the hard disk drive bays except the one with SCSI ID0 or SAS Port 0  
defined. The purpose of a dummy block is to increase the cooling effect in the server. Install a  
dummy block in slots not containing a hard disk drive.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-8 Upgrading Your Server  
Installation  
Take the following steps to install a hard disk drive. This procedure applies to all the hard disk drive  
bays.  
NOTE: Any hard disk drive can be installed or removed in or from the  
server only by removing the front bezel.  
IMPORTANT: In the disk array configuration, use the hard disk drives  
having the same specification including the capacity.  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
2. Unlock the front bezel with the security key and remove the front bezel.  
3. Locate the slot in which you are going to install a hard disk drive.  
The server has six slots. Install hard disk drives in ascending order of the SCSI ID or SAS  
port numbers. The SCSI IDs or SAS port numbers assigned to the slots are all determined.  
4. Remove the dummy block.  
A dummy block is installed in the hard disk drive bays except the one with SCSI ID0 or  
SAS Port 0.  
IMPORTANT: Keep the dummy block for future use.  
5. Unlock the lever of the hard disk drive carrier and open the handle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-9  
6. Align the drive carrier with the bay guide rail.  
7. Slide the drive carrier into the bay until it locks with the SCSI backplane connector.  
IMPORTANT:  
Push the hard disk drive carrier until the hook of the handle hits the  
frame.  
Hold the hard disk drive carrier with both hands securely and  
carefully.  
Hook  
8. Close the lever ensuring the drive is secured.  
The handle is locked when a distinct "click" is heard.  
IMPORTANT: Be careful not to get your finger caught between the  
handle and tray. Push the drive further to check if it is firmly secured.  
NOTE: Confirm that the handle is hooked to the frame when having  
inserted the hard disk drive.  
9. Install the front bezel you removed in step 2.  
There are tabs on the left side of the front bezel. Engage the tabs with the server frame,  
install the front bezel, and lock it with the security key.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-10 Upgrading Your Server  
Removal  
Take the following steps to remove a hard disk drive:  
NOTE: If removing a failing hard disk drive, confirm the slot in which  
the DISK LED of the hard disk drive is amber before starting the  
removal.  
DISK LEDs  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
2. Unlock the front bezel with the security key, and remove the front bezel.  
3. Push the lever to unlock, and put the handle down.  
4. Firmly hold the handle and hard disk drive, and pull out the hard disk drive.  
5. If using the server with the hard disk drive removed, install the dummy block in the empty  
slot.  
2
1
6. Install the front bezel you removed in step 2.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-11  
When the hard disk drives are in the disk array configuration, you can restore the state before an  
error using the auto-rebuild feature that stores the data in the old hard disk drive into a new one.  
The auto-rebuild feature is available for the RAID1, RAID5, or RAID10 disk array configuration.  
NOTE: Onboard RAID controller (HostRAID) supports RAID levels  
RAID0 and RAID1.  
Auto-rebuild is carried out when you hot-swap a failed hard disk drive with a new one (replace the  
disk while the server is powered). While auto-rebuild is in progress, the DISK LED flashes green  
and amber alternatively to indicate it.  
IMPORTANT:  
When auto-rebuild fails, the DISK LED lights in amber. Remove  
and install the hard disk drive again to restart auto-rebuild.  
If the disk array monitoring utility is installed, it may display or act  
as follows. If the DISK LED does not light in amber after auto-  
rebuild, however, auto-rebuild has completed successfully.  
Displays "Rebuild was cancelled" on the screen while auto-  
rebuild is in progress.  
Appears to stop and restart auto-rebuild.  
Observe the following notes for auto-rebuild.  
Do not power off the server in the period between a hard disk drive error and completion  
of auto-rebuild.  
When you removed a hard disk drive, wait at least 90 seconds before installing the hard  
disk drive back again.  
Do not replace another hard disk drive while rebuilding is in progress. (The DISK LED  
flashes in green and amber alternatively while rebuilding the hard disk drive.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-12 Upgrading Your Server  
Power Supply Unit  
Your server contains one or two power supplies.  
The second power supply is optional and provides a redundant configuration that ensures continued  
operation of the system in the unlikely event one of the power supplies fails.  
Installation  
Take the following steps to install a power supply unit:  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
IMPORTANT: Be sure to turn off the power. Failure to do so causes  
the server to malfunction or fail.  
2. Pull the cable arm toward the rear of the server, and confirm the slot for installing an  
optional power supply unit.  
3. Hold and pull the lever of the blank cover and remove the blank cover.  
IMPORTANT: Keep the removed blank cover for future use.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-13  
4. Insert the power supply unit.  
IMPORTANT: Do not touch the terminals of the power supply unit.  
Gold-plated  
connectors  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-14 Upgrading Your Server  
5. Grasp the handle and firmly push the power supply.  
The power supply unit is locked when a distinct "click" is heard.  
6. Connect two power cords.  
Use the power cord provided with the standard power supply unit and the one provided  
with the system. The AC POWER LEDs flash when the power cords are connected.  
Power supply unit 2  
(Option)  
Power supply unit 1  
(Standard)  
Power cord for  
power supply unit 1  
Power cord for  
power supply unit 2  
AC POWER LEDs  
7. Power on the server.  
The AC POWER LEDs go on.  
8. Confirm, by the STATUS LED or on the POST screen, that there are no errors related to  
the power supply units.  
See Chapter 8 for details on the error messages.  
If the AC POWER LEDs are off, reinstall the power supply units. If the same error  
message still appears, contact your service representative.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-15  
Replacing a Failing Power Supply Unit  
Replace only a failing power supply unit.  
IMPORTANT: Do not remove a power supply unit operating  
normally.  
NOTE: If one power supply unit fails while the server contains two  
power supply units in a redundant configuration, the failing power  
supply unit can be replaced with the system operating (power-on state).  
(Skip step 2.)  
1. Locate the failing power supply unit by the AC POWER LED on the rear of each power  
supply unit. (The LED of the failing power supply unit is amber.)  
2. Shutdown the system, and press the POWER switch to turn off the power.  
3. Disconnect the power cord from the failed power supply.  
4. Hold the handle of the failing power supply.  
5. While pressing the lever, pull the power supply to remove if from the chassis.  
1
2
6. If operating the server with a single power supply unit without installing a new one, install  
the cover you removed in step 3 of installation procedure.  
IMPORTANT: To maintain the cooling effect in the server, install the  
blank cover in the vacant slot.  
7. Install the new power supply unit taking steps 4 to 8 of "Installation", and confirm that the  
power supply unit is installed normally.  
NOTE: If one of the two power supply units of the server is replaced  
while the power is on, the POWER LED of the new power supply unit  
goes on. (If it is replaced while the power is off, the LED flashes. The  
LED goes on when the power is turned on.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-16 Upgrading Your Server  
Server (Pull-out from the Rack)  
The server needs to be pulled out from the rack for installing/removing any components other than  
the hard disk drives and power supply units.  
CAUTION  
Observe the following instructions to use the server safely. Failure to follow  
these instructions may result in death or serious personal injury. See pages 1-3  
to 1-8 for details.  
Do not install the server on a rack with leaving covers removed.  
Do not pinch your finger with mechanical components.  
Note high temperature.  
Do not pull out a device from the rack if the rack is unstable.  
Do not leave more than one device being pulled out from the rack.  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
2. Unlock the front bezel with the security key and remove the front bezel.  
Security lock  
3. Loosen the two captive thumbscrews on the front panel.  
4. Hold the handles and slowly pull out the server from the rack until it locks.  
Captive thumb screws  
Handles  
When inserting the server back into the rack, push the release levers on the rails on the sides of the  
server to unlatch the server. Be very careful not to get your finger caught in doing so.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-17  
Drive Cover  
Open the drive cover when installing/removing a fan assembly, processor, and backup file device or  
reconnecting an internal cable.  
Removal  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
2. Pull out the server from the rack.  
3. Slide the drive cover toward the rear of the server while pressing the lock button on the  
cover.  
4. Lift off the drive cover from the server.  
Installation  
When installing the drive cover, confirm that the tab of the cover is securely inserted into the slot in  
the server frame.  
Slide the drive cover toward the rear of the server. The drive cover is locked when a distinct "click"  
is heard. At this time, check the release button for normal state.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-18 Upgrading Your Server  
Logic Cover  
Open the logic cover when installing/removing a DIMM, processor, and PCI add-in card or  
reconnecting an internal cable.  
Removal  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
2. Pull out the server from the rack.  
3. Loosen a captive thumbscrew at the rear of the server.  
4. Slide the logic cover toward the rear of the server and lift off the cover from the server.  
Installation  
When installing the logic cover, confirm that the tab of the cover is securely inserted into the slot in  
the server frame.  
Slide the logic cover toward the rear of the server and secure the cover with captive thumbscrew.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-19  
DIMM  
Install the additional DIMM (Dual Inline Memory Module) to the DIMM socket on the mother  
board in the server. The mother board is provided with eight DIMM board slots.  
NOTE: Up to 16GB of memory (2GB DIMM x 8) can be installed.  
(The factory-installed DIMMs need to be replaced in this case.) Two  
DIMMs of 512MB are factory-installed in DIMM slots #7 and #8.  
IMPORTANT:  
The DIMM is extremely sensitive to static electricity. Make sure to  
touch the metal frame of the server to discharge static electricity  
from your body before handling the DIMM. Do not touch the  
DIMM terminals or on-board parts by a bare hand or place the  
DIMM directly on the desk. For static notes, see the section "Anti-  
static Measures" described earlier.  
Make sure to use the DIMM authorized by NEC. Installing a third-  
party DIMM may cause a failure of the DIMM as well as the server.  
Repair of the server due to failures or damage resulted from  
installing such a board will be charged.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-20 Upgrading Your Server  
Installation Order  
DIMMs must be populated in pairs and in the following order:  
#7 and #8, #5 and #6, #3 and #4, then #1 and #2.  
Install DIMMs starting from the one having smallest capacity.  
FRONT  
REAR  
DIMM #1  
Group #1  
DIMM #2  
DIMM #3  
Group #2  
DIMM #4  
DIMM #5  
Group #3  
DIMM #6  
DIMM #7  
Group #4  
DIMM #8  
Mother board  
IMPORTANT: Install two additional DIMMs for each group*1  
because the server uses interleaved memory. If DIMMs of different  
specifications*2 are installed in a bank, the server does not operate  
normally.  
*1 A group is a unit of two DIMM slots. Each pair of DIMM slots  
#1 and #2 (group #1), #3 and #4 (group #2), #5 and #6 (group  
#3), and #7 and #8 (group #4) in the figure is a group. (The  
symbols are also printed on the mother board.)  
*2 DIMM specification is shown on the label attached to the  
DIMM as follows:  
Example: Frequency of 400 MHz, buffered, capacity of 512 MB,  
row address of 12 bits, column address of 10 bits, and  
single side  
400 / B / 512 / R12 C10  
S
Single side  
Column address  
Row address  
Capacity  
Buffered  
Frequency  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-21  
Installation  
Install a DIMM in the following procedure.  
IMPORTANT: The server supports DIMMs of only the low-profile  
type (30 mm (1.2 inches) in height). It does not support DIMMs  
exceeding the specified height.  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
2. Pull out the server from the rack.  
3. Open the logic cover.  
4. Push the DIMM straight into the socket.  
NOTE: Make sure of the orientation of the DIMM.  
Position the DIMM so that a notch in the bottom edge of the DIMM  
aligns with the keyed socket. Applying too much pressure can damage  
the socket. Keyed DIMMs insert only one way.  
IMPORTANT: To avoid damage to the socket, do not apply  
excessive force while pressing the DIMM.  
The levers automatically close when the DIMM is inserted into the socket.  
Key slot  
Key  
5. Install the components you removed in steps 1 to 3.  
6. Power on the server and verify that POST displays no error messages.  
If POST displays an error message, take a note on the message and see the POST error  
messages listed in Chapter 8.  
7. Start the SETUP and select [Advanced] [Memory Configuration] to verify that the  
installed DIMM shows the status "Normal". (See Chapter 4 or details.)  
8. Select "Yes" for [Reset Configuration Data] on the [Advanced] menu.  
This setting is required to change the hardware configuration data. See Chapter 4 for  
details.  
9. If the Windows operating system is in use, set the paging file size to the recommended  
value (total memory size × 1.5) or a greater value. See Chapter 5 for details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-22 Upgrading Your Server  
Removal  
Remove the DIMM depending on the following procedure.  
NOTES:  
To remove the failed DIMM, check the error message appearing in  
POST or NEC ESMPRO to identify the DIMM socket (group) in  
which the failed DIMM is installed.  
The server operates only when at least two DIMMs are installed.  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
2. Pull out the server from the rack.  
3. Open the logic cover.  
4. Open the levers at both sides of the socket from which you remove the DIMM.  
The DIMM is unlock and ready for removal.  
5. Reinstall all parts removed in Step 2.  
Power on the server and verify that POST displays no error messages.  
If POST displays an error message, take a note on the message and see the POST error  
messages listed in Chapter 8.  
6. Start the SETUP and select [Advanced] [Memory Configuration] [Memory Retest]  
[Enabled] to clear the error information of the removed DIMM. (See Chapter 4 for  
details.)  
7. Select "Yes" for [Reset Configuration Data] on the Advanced menu.  
This setting is required to change the hardware configuration data. See Chapter 4 for  
details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-23  
Processor (CPU)  
The server may have another CPU installed in addition to the standard CPU (IntelXeon  
Processor).  
IMPORTANT:  
The CPU is extremely sensitive to static electricity. Make sure to  
touch the metal frame of the server to discharge static electricity  
from your body before handling the CPU. Do not touch the CPU  
pins by a bare hand or place the CPU directly on the desk. For static  
notes, see the section "Anti-static Measures" described earlier.  
Do not operate the system until confirming that the additionally  
installed CPU is in normal state.  
Make sure to use the CPU authorized by NEC. Installing a third-  
party CPU may cause a failure of the CPU as well as the server.  
Repair of the server due to failures or damage resulted from  
installing such a board will be charged.  
Processor 1  
Processor 2  
FRONT  
REAR  
Mother board  
NOTE: If the different revision of the processor is installed in the  
multiprocessor system, Windows logs the following information every  
startup. If this message is logged, it is no problem for operation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-24 Upgrading Your Server  
Installation  
Take the following steps to install the CPU.  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
2. Pull out the server from the rack.  
3. Open the drive cover and logic cover.  
4. Remove two screws securing the support arm.  
5. Remove the support arm from the chassis.  
NOTE: When the support arm comes up, you may lose the screws.  
Press firmly the support arm before removing the screws.  
6. Remove the processor duct from the chassis.  
7. Locate the CPU socket which you are going to install CPU.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-25  
8. Raise the locking lever on the socket.  
IMPORTANT: Open the lever until it stops. The bar can be opened to  
approx. 120 degrees.  
9. Aligning the pins of the CPU with the socket, insert the CPU slowly and gently into the  
socket.  
IMPORTANT:  
Be aware of CPU direction. Pin layouts on two corners among four  
differ from others to prevent an incorrect insertion. Confirm the pin  
mark and pin layout on the socket, and insert the CPU correctly.  
The mother board has "zero insertion force" sockets. If CPU does  
not drop easily into socket holes, make sure lever is in the full-open  
position.  
Pin mark  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-26 Upgrading Your Server  
10. Push the CPU lightly to the socket, and push down the lever to secure the CPU.  
11. Put the heat sink on CPU.  
NOTE: Be aware of direction of heat sink (see figure below).  
12. Fix the heat sink clips with four screws.  
2
4
3
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-27  
13. Make sure that the heat sink is level.  
NOTES:  
If the heat sink is not level, remove it, and then install it again. The  
following probably causes the heat sink not to be level:  
– The CPU is not positioned correctly.  
– All screws are not completely tightened.  
Do not move the secured heat sink.  
14. Install the processor air duct.  
15. Install the support arm.  
NOTE: When the support arm comes up, you may lose the screws.  
Press firmly the support arm before tightening the screws.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-28 Upgrading Your Server  
16. Install the covers you removed previously.  
17. Power on the server, start the SETUP utility, and set "Processor Retest" of "Processor  
Settings" on the Main menu to "Enable".  
18. Verify that POST displays no error messages.  
If POST displays an error message, take a note on the message and see the POST error  
messages listed in Chapter 8.  
19. Set "Reset Configuration Data" on the Advanced menu to "Yes".  
This setting is required to change the hardware configuration data. See Chapter 4 for  
details.  
20. To add one or more CPUs to the server in 1-CPU configuration to operate the server with  
more than one CPU, change the driver of [Computer] in the device manager to [ACPI  
multi-processor PC] and then update the system (see Chapter 5).  
NOTE: Step 20 is required when the Hyper-threading technology  
feature is disabled in the BIOS SETUP Utility.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-29  
Removal  
To remove the CPU, prepare the removal referring to steps 1 and 6 in the installation procedure and  
do the reverse procedure of steps 12 to 8.  
IMPORTANT:  
Do not remove any CPU unless it is failed.  
After the operation, heat may make the cool seat at the bottom of  
the heat sink adhere to the CPU. To remove the heat sink from the  
CPU, first turn the heat sink to the left and right lightly to make sure  
that the heat sink can be apart from the CPU. Removing the heat  
sink with it adhering to the CPU may cause the CPU and/or socket  
to be defected.  
Do the following procedure if a CPU is removed (or replaced).  
1. Start SETUP to select menus "Main" – "Processor Settings" – "Processor Retest" in the  
order to clear the error information on the removed CPU (see Chapter 4).  
When a CPU is replaced, select menus "Main" – "Processor Settings" to confirm that the  
ID and L2 Cache of the additional CPU are defined normally (see Chapter 4).  
2. Set "Reset Configuration Data" on the Advanced menu to "Yes."  
This is required to update the hardware configuration information. See Chapter 4 for  
details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-30 Upgrading Your Server  
PCI Board  
The server has two "riser cards" on the mother board that enable installation of PCI boards. Three  
PCI boards can be installed on each riser card. (Up to six PCI boards can be installed in total.)  
Insert PCI boards for network extension and file device function extension into PCI board slots in  
each riser card.  
IMPORTANT:  
The PCI board is extremely sensitive to static electricity. Make sure  
to touch the metal frame of the server to discharge static electricity  
from your body before handling the PCI board. Do not touch the  
PCI board terminals or on-board parts by a bare hand or place the  
PCI board directly on the desk. For static notes, see the section  
"Anti-static Measures".  
Some restrictions are imposed on the combination of PCI boards  
which can be installed in the server. Contact your service  
representative for details.  
A riser card is designed for installing only low-profile PCI boards or  
full-height PCI boards. Before installing a PCI board, make sure of  
the card specification.  
Disable the option ROM (such as BIOS utility startup) for the PCI  
slot if the SCSI controller, disk array controller, LAN board  
(network booting), or FibreChannel controller has no hard disk  
drive containing an OS connected. See Chapter 4 for details.  
FRONT  
REAR  
Riser card slot  
(Dedicated to full-height PCI boards)  
Riser card slot  
(Dedicated to low-profile PCI boards)  
Mother board  
3C  
2C  
1C  
3B  
2B  
1B  
Riser card  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-31  
Notes  
Observe the following notes on installing/removing a PCI board:  
Do not touch the terminals of the riser cards and the leads of electronic components with  
your bare hand. Fingerprints and dust left on them cause the server to malfunction due to a  
connection failure or damage to the leads.  
A riser card is designed for installing only low-profile PCI boards or full-height PCI  
boards. Before installing a PCI board, make sure of the card specification.  
If any board is installed in the slot next to the component side of N8103-80F/81F disk  
array controller, you cannot connect the LED relay cable coming with the server between  
LED connector on disk array controller and DAC LED connector on mother board. (The  
DISK ACCESS LED on the front panel cannot indicate the access status of hard disk  
drives connected to the disk array controller.)  
The system searches for the PCI board in the following order:  
PCI Slot 1C 2C 3C 1B 2B 3B  
When N8116-02 is installed:  
PCI Slot 1C 2C 3C 1B 3B 2B  
The PCI devices of the same type (including onboard PCI device) may be recognized in  
different order from that described above, depending on OS or disk array BIOS utility.  
Check the slot location of PCI device by PCI bus number, device number and function  
number shown in the table below.  
Bus number Device number Function number  
Onboard NIC1  
Onboard NIC2  
Slot 1C  
Slot 2C  
Slot 3C  
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
2
5
6
3
0
1
X
X
X
0
Onboard SCSI Ch A (backup  
file/ext.)  
Onboard SCSI Ch B (HDD)  
Slot 1B  
Slot 2B  
2
3
7
8
9
1
3 *  
3 *  
3 *  
X
X
X
Slot 3B  
* The bus number may be 4 or greater depending on the board installed in Slot 1C,  
2C, or 3C.  
Set "Disabled" for the optional ROM of a LAN device not to be booted by using the BIOS  
SETUP utility.  
If an additional LAN device is installed in slot 3C or 3B, it is hard to push the catch of the  
connector with your finger that is connected to the LAN port. Disconnect the connector  
pushing the catch with a standard screwdriver. At this time, be very careful for the  
screwdriver not to damage the LAN port or other ports.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-32 Upgrading Your Server  
If a bootable PCI board (e.g., a disk array controller, SCSI controller, or LAN card) is  
additionally installed, the boot priority is changed to the default. After the additional  
installation, start the BIOS SETUP utility, select [Boot] [Boot Device Priority], and set  
the new boot priority.  
If an option operating with only 33 MHz is installed in one of the slots (1C, 2C, and 3C,  
or 1B, 2B, and 3B) on a PCI riser card, the options installed in the other slots of the same  
riser card are subjected to operation with only 33 MHz.  
Contact your service representative for the acceptable optional PCI board.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-33  
Installation  
Take the following steps to install a PCI board on the riser card:  
IMPORTANT:  
Each riser card supports low-profile or full-height PCI boards.  
Before installing a PCI board, confirm that the type of the PCI  
board.  
When installing a PCI board, confirm that the card connector  
matches the connector of the riser card.  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
2. Pull out the server from the rack.  
3. Remove the logic cover.  
4. Lift straight up and remove the riser card assembly from the server.  
5. Remove a screw securing an expansion slot cover.  
Low-profile type  
Full-height type  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-34 Upgrading Your Server  
6. Remove the extension slot cover.  
NOTE: Keep the removed extension slot cover for future use.  
Low-profile type  
Full-height type  
7. <This step is required only for a PCI board of the full-height/full-length type.>  
Before installing a PCI board of the full-height/full-length type, remove the retainer from  
the PCI board, and then unlock and open the card retainer clip on the other side of the  
guide rail.  
Retainer  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-35  
8. Install the PCI board on the riser card.  
Align the PCI board terminal section with the riser card slot, and firmly push the PCI  
board until it is fully seated.  
Slit in the PCI  
board bracket  
Slit in the PCI  
board bracket  
Embossed  
Embossed  
Top end of the  
PCI board bracket  
Guide  
rails  
Low-profile type  
Full-height type  
IMPORTANT:  
Do not touch the terminals of the riser cards and PCI boards with  
your bare hand. Fingerprints and dust left on them cause the server  
to malfunction.  
If you are unable to install a PCI board correctly, remove it, and  
then install it again. Be careful not to apply excess force to a PCI  
board or riser card. Doing so may damage the card.  
NOTES:  
Confirm that the slit in the PCI board bracket is positioned by the  
embossed part. (This applies to other card brackets and extension  
slot covers.)  
Confirm that the top end of the PCI board bracket is inserted in the  
designated slot of the riser card.  
If a full-height PCI board is installed, confirm that the PCI board  
bracket and the edge of the opposite card are inserted in the guide  
rails of the riser card.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-36 Upgrading Your Server  
9. Secure the board with a screw removed in Step 5.  
Retainer clip  
Retainer clip  
Lock tab  
Low-profile type  
Full-height type  
10. Insert the riser card into the slot on the mother board.  
Align the riser card terminal section with the slot on the mother board, and firmly push the  
riser card until it is fully seated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-37  
11. After the insertion, press the riser card down with your fingers until it is fully seated.  
12. Install the components you removed previously.  
13. Verify that POST displays no error messages.  
If POST displays an error message, take a note on the message and see the POST error  
messages listed in Chapter 8.  
14. Select "Yes" for [Advanced] [Reset Configuration Data].  
This setting is required to change the hardware configuration data. See Chapter 4 for  
details.  
15. Start the BIOS configuration utility in the installed card, and set up the card.  
Presence/absence of the utility and the start and operation methods depend on the card.  
For details, see the manual provided with the card.  
Removal  
Remove a PCI board in reverse order of the installation steps.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-38 Upgrading Your Server  
Disk Array Controller Board  
The disk array controller board is an optional PCI board provided to improve data reliability.  
Installing the disk array controller board allows you to use hard disk drives in the device bays of the  
server and those in the optional expansion disk cabinet in the disk array configuration.  
IMPORTANT:  
The disk array controller board is extremely sensitive to static  
electricity. Make sure to touch the metal frame of the Server to  
discharge static electricity from your body before handling the disk  
array controller board. Do not touch the disk array controller board  
terminals or on-board parts by a bare hand or place the disk array  
controller board directly on the desk. For static notes, see the section  
"Anti-static Measures" described earlier.  
Making hard disk drives in the disk array configuration or changing  
the RAID level initializes hard disk drives. If the hard disk drive to  
be configured in the array has your valuable data stored, make sure  
to make a backup copy of the data before installing the disk array  
controller board and configuring the array.  
The disk array configuration requires at least two hard disk drives.  
Use hard disk drives of the same capacity and performance (e.g.,  
revolution) for each pack to configure them in the array.  
NOTES:  
Before installing a disk array controller board, start the SETUP  
utility, select [Advanced] [PCI Configuration], and confirm that  
[Enabled] is set for the parameter [PCI Slot xx ROM] (xx: PCI slot  
number).  
A disk array configuration of RAID1 or RAID5 increases disk  
reliability. However, the actually available capacity becomes smaller  
than the total hard disk drive capacity in the disk array  
configuration.  
Installation  
See "PCI Board" for the installation of a disk array controller.  
Removal  
Remove a disk array controller board in reverse order of the installation steps.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-39  
Use of internal hard disk drives in a disk array configuration  
To use the internal hard disk drives in a disk array configuration in the server containing a disk array  
controller board, reconnect the SCSI cables and LED cables on the mother board.  
The internal hard disk drive interface is connected to the SCSI connector on the mother board at  
shipment.  
IMPORTANT: When using N8103-91 disk array controller, you do  
not need to connect an LED cable.  
Standard configuration  
Mother board  
REAR  
FRONT  
Internal backup  
device  
Hard disk  
drive  
SCSI ID3-5  
Hard disk  
drive  
SCSI ID0-2  
SCSI connector  
SCSI backplane  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-40 Upgrading Your Server  
With N8103-86 disk array controller connected  
Mother board  
REAR  
FRONT  
Internal backup  
device  
N8103-86  
disk array controller  
Hard disk  
drive  
SCSI ID3-5  
Hard disk  
drive  
SCSI connector  
SCSI ID0-2  
Connect the SCSI cable to the SCSI connector on  
mother board to configure the disk array.  
SCSI backplane  
With N8103-80F/81F disk array controller connected  
Mother board  
REAR  
FRONT  
Internal backup  
device  
N8103-80F/81F  
disk array controller  
Hard disk  
drive  
SCSI ID3-5  
Hard disk  
drive  
SCSI ID0-2  
To use the internal hard disk drives in disk array  
configuration, disconnect the standard SCSI cable from the  
SCSI connector on mother board, and connect it to the  
connector on disk array controller board.  
SCSI backplane  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-41  
With N8103-86 disk array controller connected and internal SCSI backup device  
connected (exclusive use with onboard SCSI connector)  
Mother board  
REAR  
FRONT  
Internal SCSI  
backup device  
N8103-86  
disk array controller  
Hard disk  
drive  
SCSI ID3-5  
Hard disk  
drive  
SCSI ID0-2  
K410-130(00)  
SCSI con ectors  
SCSI connector  
Connect the SCSI cable to the SCSI connector on  
mother board to configure the disk array.  
SCSI backplane  
With N8103-80F/81F disk array controller connected and internal SCSI backup  
device connected (exclusive use with onboard SCSI connector)  
Mother board  
FRONT  
REAR  
Internal SCSI  
backup device  
N8103-80F/81F  
disk array controller  
Hard disk  
drive  
SCSI ID3-5  
Hard disk  
drive  
SCSI ID0-2  
K410-130 (00)  
SCSI backplane  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-42 Upgrading Your Server  
With N8103-86 disk array controller connected and internal IDE backup device  
Mother board  
REAR  
FRONT  
Internal SCSI  
backup device  
N8103-86  
disk array controller  
Hard disk  
drive  
SCSI ID3-5  
Hard disk  
drive  
SCSI ID0-2  
SCSI connector  
Connect the SCSI cable to the SCSI connector on  
mother board to configure the disk array.  
SCSI backplane  
With N8103-91 disk array controller connected  
Mother board  
REAR  
FRONT  
Internal SCSI  
backup device  
N8103-91  
disk array controller  
(for internal HDD)  
SAS hard  
disk drive  
Ports 3-5  
SAS hard  
disk drive  
Ports 0-2  
Internal SAS cable  
(provided with N8154-10  
SAS back panel)  
N8154-10 SAS back panel  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-43  
With N8103-91 disk array controller connected and internal IDE backup device  
Mother board  
REAR  
FRONT  
Internal IDE  
backup device  
N8103-91  
disk array controller  
(for internal HDD)  
SAS hard  
disk drive  
Ports 3-5  
SAS hard  
disk drive  
Ports 0-2  
Internal SAS cable  
(provided with N8154-10  
SAS back panel)  
N8154-10 SAS back panel  
With N8103-91 disk array controller connected and internal SCSI backup device  
Mother board  
REAR  
FRONT  
Internal SCSI  
backup device  
N8103-91  
disk array controller  
(for internal HDD)  
SAS hard  
disk drive  
Ports 3-5  
SAS hard  
disk drive  
Ports 0-2  
SCSI connector  
Internal SAS cable  
(provided with N8154-10  
SAS back panel)  
N8154-10 SAS back panel  
K410-130 (00) internal SCSI cable  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-44 Upgrading Your Server  
SCSI cable connection  
To use the internal hard disk drives in a disk array configuration, disconnect the SCSI  
cable from the SCSI connector on the mother board, and connect it to the connector of the  
disk array controller board.  
IMPORTANT:  
To switch the internal hard disk drives into a disk array  
configuration by connecting a disk array controller to the full-height  
riser card, connect the cable before installing the riser card on the  
mother board.  
Some disk array controller boards have more than one channel  
(connector). They may have connectors for internal connection and  
external connection. However, the connectors may be under  
exclusive specification in consideration of the internal connection of  
the disk array controller board. Make sure that each connector  
(channel) is for internal connection or external connection. For the  
connectors and channels, see the manual provided with the disk  
array controller board.  
SAS cable connection (with N8154-10 SAS back panel installed)  
Connect the SAS cable provided with N8154-10 SAS back panel as shown in the figure  
below.  
Pay attention to connect the cable to proper cable connectors P2 and P3. Otherwise, the  
SAS port number for hard disk drive may not be displayed correctly.  
P3  
N8103-91  
P2  
To N8154-10  
SAS back panel  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-45  
LED relay cable connection  
To indicate the status of access to the internal hard disk drives in a disk array  
configuration, connect the LED relay cable connected on the mother board connector to  
the HDD LED connector on the mother board and to the HDD LED connector of the disk  
array controller.  
NOTES:  
When using N8103-91 disk array controller, you do not need to  
connect the LED relay cable.  
The LED relay cable is free from polarities. An end of the cable can  
be connected to either of the HDD LED connectors.  
Pin (red)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-46 Upgrading Your Server  
Pin (Red)  
N8103-80F  
N8103-81F  
Pin (Red)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-47  
Disk array configuration of internal hard disk drives  
Observe the following notes on configuring a disk array:  
– The server must contain more than one SCSI or SAS hard disk drive having the same  
capacity and the same rotational speed. (The minimum number of required disks  
depends on the configuration of RAID (Redundant Arrays of Inexpensive  
[Independent] Disks).)  
– Select/set a RAID level "RAID0", "RAID1", or "RAID5" of disk array configuration.  
When installing a system in an internal hard disk drive, you should use "Express Setup" to  
perform all the procedures for RAID configuration, OS installation, and then OS setup.  
Use Express Setup even when not installing a system. Start Express Setup, select [OS  
Selection] [Others]. The installer automatically performs all the procedures for RAID  
configuration, maintenance partition setting, and then maintenance utility installation.  
When making the setup in manual mode, use the RAID configuration utility in the chip on  
the board. You can start the utility during execution of POST that automatically starts  
immediately after you turn on the server power switch. For details, see the online  
document in the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM provided with the server. (The  
utility varies depending on the disk array controller board.) For details on the data transfer  
rate, RAID, and array configuration, see the manual provided with the disk array  
controller board as well as the online document.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-48 Upgrading Your Server  
Use of a disk expansion unit in a disk array configuration  
A disk expansion unit is an exclusive device that can install up to 14 hard disk drives. (The number  
of hard disk drives depends on the model.) The server containing a disk array controller board can  
connect one or two of these devices. For details on the number of devices connected, see the  
manuals provided with the disk array controller and disk expansion unit.  
IMPORTANT: A disk expansion unit is provided with no hard disk  
drives. You need to purchase hard disk drives separately.  
An optional cable may be required to connect with a disk expansion unit. Refer to the manual  
coming with the disk expansion unit for details.  
After connecting the disk expansion unit, use the RAID configuration utility in the chip on the board  
to set the disk expansion unit in a disk array configuration (RAID0, RAID1, or RAID5). (The utility  
varies depending on the board.) For details on settings and the setting methods, see the online  
document in the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM provided with the server or the manual  
provided with the board.  
While a disk expansion unit is set in a disk array configuration, you can use the "Auto Rebuild"  
feature of the disk array controller to restore data if one of the hard disk drives installed in the disk  
expansion unit fails. (Replace the failing hard disk drive while the power is on. (Hot swapping))  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-49  
Backup Device  
The server has one slot for installing a backup device such as a magnetic tape drive.  
IMPORTANT:  
A SCSI cable K410-130(00) is necessary for installing a SCSI  
backup device.  
Set "OFF" for the terminating resistor of the backup device you are  
going to install, and set a SCSI ID different from those of other  
devices. For the settings, see the manual provided with the server.  
Install only a backup device specified by NEC.  
The size of a backup device which can be installed in this server is  
as follows:  
Width: Up to about 9 cm (3.5 inches)  
Height: Up to about 4 cm (1.6 inches)  
Backup device  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-50 Upgrading Your Server  
Installation  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
2. Pull out the server from the rack.  
3. Open the drive cover and logic cover.  
4. While pulling the lever toward the right side of the server, pull the CD/FD out of the  
chassis.  
IMPORTANT: Do not touch any other part than release lever when  
removing the CD-ROM/floppy disk drive. Otherwise, your fingers may  
be caught.  
5. While pushing the latching tab that secures the device bay, push the device carrier out of  
front of the server.  
IMPORTANT: Be careful not to bend the latching tab by applying  
excess force. If the tab bends, straighten it out as it was.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-51  
6. Take out the device carrier from the front of the server.  
7. Push the tabs at both ends of the front panel.  
8. Remove the front panel.  
IMPORTANT: Keep the removed front panel for future use.  
9. Insert the backup device into the device carrier.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-52 Upgrading Your Server  
10. Secure the backup device with the provided screws.  
Tighten two screws on each side.  
Screw hole not used  
NOTES:  
Be sure to use the screws provided with the backup device.  
Position the backup device so that the device screw holes align with  
the screw holes in the device carrier.  
If you feel difficult to connect the cable of the long device such as  
N8151-54F internal AIT, slide the device to the front and then  
connect the cable.  
11. Connect the power extension cable and interface cable to the device.  
Power Cable  
(Attached)  
Power Cable  
(Attached)  
IDE Cable  
(Attached)  
K410-130 (00)  
SCSI Cable  
<IDE Device>  
<SCSI Device>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-53  
12. Insert the device carrier into the backup device bay halfway.  
Push the device carrier as far as it will go. It is locked when a "click" is heard.  
NOTE: Be careful not to catch the connected power extension cable in  
inserting the device carrier.  
13. Connect the interface cable and power cable to the backplane as shown in figure below.  
SCSI Connector  
<IDE device>  
<SCSI device>  
NOTE: Confirm where to place the terminator at the end of the SCSI  
cable. The terminator must be placed in the device bay. At this time,  
also confirm that the SCSI cable is not in contact with the latching tab  
of the device carrier. This is to prevent the cable from being damaged.  
14. Insert the device carrier into the device bay until it locks.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-54 Upgrading Your Server  
15. Route the SCSI cable as shown in figure below. (SCSI device only)  
Optical SCSI cable  
(K410-130 00)  
SCSI backplane connector for  
backup device  
SCSI Ch.A  
16. Install the components you removed previously.  
17. Make the setup according to "SCSI BIOS" in Chapter 4 (SCSI device only).  
18. Install the device driver.  
Refer to the manual that comes with the device.  
Removal  
Remove the backup device in reverse order of the installation steps.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-55  
Redundant Hot Swap-fan  
Your server can include four optional redundant hot-swap fans.  
Installation  
1. See the section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
2. Pull out the server from the rack.  
3. Open the drive cover.  
4. Locate the installation slot.  
Redundant hot-swap fan slot  
FRONT  
REAR  
5. Insert the hot-swap fan into the slot with its labeled side facing rear of the server until it  
locks.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-56 Upgrading Your Server  
6. Change the jumper (J11) setting as shown in figure below.  
J11  
: Strap  
Standard Redundant  
configuration  
FRONT  
REAR  
Mother board  
IMPORTANT: To avoid system malfunction, leave other jumpers at  
its default position.  
If the remote management card is installed in your server, follow these steps to configure  
the firmware program.  
7. Place the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive and reboot the  
server.  
8. Run "Initialize Remote Management Card".  
Refer to Chapter 6 for details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-57  
Removal  
Follow these steps to remove or replace the hot-swap fan.  
1. Pull out the server from the rack.  
2. Open the drive cover.  
3. Locate the failed fan.  
Fault LED on the fan turns on when a fan failure occurs. A fan failure is also indicated by  
NEC ESMPRO and system event log.  
4. While pressing release tabs on the top of the fan, pull the fan up to remove from the fan  
slot.  
5. Install the new fan into the vacant slot.  
IMPORTANT: If all the redundant fans are removed. Change the  
jumper (J11) setting described earlier in the installation procedure.  
If the remote management card is installed in your server, follow these steps to configure  
the firmware program.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-58 Upgrading Your Server  
Remote Management Card (RMC)  
Remote Management Card (RMC) is an expansion card that includes the Baseboard Management  
Controller (BMC) based on IPMI 1.5.  
See Chapter 2 for detail functions of RMC.  
IMPORTANT: The RMC is extremely sensitive to static electricity.  
Make sure to touch the metal frame of the server to discharge static  
electricity from your body before handling the RMC. Do not touch the  
RMC terminal pins by bare hand or place the RMC directly on the desk.  
For static notes, see the section "Anti-static Measures" described earlier.  
RMC connector  
FRONT  
REAR  
Mother board  
NOTE: The illustrations in this subsection might slightly differ from  
your remote management card.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-59  
Installation  
Follow these steps to replace the RMC with an optional Advanced Remote Management card  
(ARMC).  
1. See section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
2. Pull out the server from the rack.  
3. Open the logic cover.  
4. Assemble the management network card that attached to the ARMC and install the card to  
the riser card.  
5. Connect the internal cable provided with ARMC to ARMC and the management network  
card as shown in the figure below.  
The following figure shows the cable routing of the internal cable.  
6. Reassemble the server.  
7. Turn on the server and check that the no error messages other than the following message  
are displayed on the POST screen.  
H/W Configuration of BMC is corrupted.  
!!Update BMC H/W Configuration by configuration tool!!  
!!Refer to BMC configuration manual!!  
See Chapter 8 for POST error messages.  
8. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive and reboot the  
server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-60 Upgrading Your Server  
9. Run "Initialize Remote Management Card".  
See Chapter 6 for details.  
10. Run BIOS SETUP utility and check to see that the menus related to the RMC are  
displayed.  
Refer to Chapter 4 for details. If no additional menus are displayed, reinstall the RMC.  
11. In the BIOS SETUP utility, select "Yes" for [Reset Configuration Data] in the [Advanced]  
menu.  
This setting is required to change the hardware configuration data. See Chapter 4 for  
details.  
12. Reboot the server and run NEC EXPRESSBUILDER to save system information.  
Refer to Chapter 3 or 6 for details.  
13. If the advanced remote management card is installed and KVM console feature is used,  
update the graphics accelerator (see Chapter 5).  
NOTE: Refer to the manual that comes with an optional advanced  
remote management card for the monitor resolution.  
14. Override installation of NEC ESMPRO Agent if installed.  
To correct the system information and event log from the management PC, NEC  
ESMPRO Agent must be installed in the server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Upgrading Your Server 9-61  
Removal  
1. See section "Preparing for Installation and Removal" described earlier to prepare.  
IMPORTANT: The remote management card logic monitors and logs  
system voltage changes. When removing the RMC from the mother  
board, you may experience a 3 - 4 second delay from the time your  
system powering down.  
2. Pull out the server from the rack.  
3. Open the logic cover.  
4. Open the levers on the both sides of the RMC connector to unlatch the RMC.  
5. Remove the RMC from the connector.  
6. Run BIOS SETUP utility and check to see that menus related to the RMC are not  
displayed in the Server menu.  
See Chapter 4 for details.  
7. Run BIOS SETUP utility and select "Yes" for [Reset Configuration Data] in the  
[Advanced] menu.  
This setting is required to change the hardware configuration data. See Chapter 4 for  
details.  
8. Override installation of NEC ESMPRO Agent if installed.  
To correct the system information and event log from the management PC, NEC  
ESMPRO Agent must be installed in the server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-62 Upgrading Your Server  
(This page is intentionally left blank.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix A  
Specifications  
NEC Express5800/120Rh-2  
N8100- N8100- N8100- N8100- N8100-  
1062F 1063F 1100F 1125F 1126F  
Item  
N8100-  
1061F  
CPU  
Type  
Clock/Cache  
IntelXeonprocessor  
3.20DGHz 3.40DGHz 3.60GHz 3.20GHz 3.40GHz 3.80GHz  
/1MB  
/1MB  
/2MB  
/2MB  
/2MB  
/2MB  
Standard  
Maximum  
1
2
Chipset  
Memory  
E7520 (800MHz)  
1GB (512MB×2)  
Minimum  
Maximum  
16GB (The standard DIMM must be replaced.)  
2 DIMMs (512MB/1GB/2GB/4GB)  
3 times  
SDRAM DIMM (Low Profile DDR2-400 Buffered Type)  
ECC  
Expansion unit  
Expansion times  
Memory module  
Error check  
Graphics (VRAM)  
ATI RADEON 7000 (VRAM 16MB)  
Auxiliary Floppy disk (standard) 3.5-inch drive × 1  
input  
device  
Hard disk (standard)  
Hard disk (maximum)  
CD-ROM (standard)  
None  
1.8TB (300GB × 6)  
ATAPI interface × 1 (Load on tray type, x24 speed)  
Additional Hard disk drive bay  
bay  
Additional PCI (64-bit/100MHz)  
6 slots  
1 slot  
3 slots  
3 slots  
3.5-inch bay  
slot  
Low Profile PCI  
(64-bit/66MHz)  
LAN interface  
External Keyboard/mouse  
1000Base-T/100Base-TX/10Base-T (2 ports)  
MINI DIN 6-pin connector (1 port)  
4-pin (4 ports, 2 at front panel, 2 at rear panel)  
2 ports, (D-sub 9-pin)  
RJ-45 (2 ports)  
MINI D-sub 15-pin (1 port)  
Ultra 320 SCSI (1 port)  
interface  
USB  
Serial  
Network  
Display  
SCSI  
Cabinet design  
Rack-mount type (2U)  
External dimensions  
Weight (Max.)  
427 (width) × 88 (height) × 722 (depth) mm  
21 kg (30 kg)  
Power supply  
Power consumption (maximum)  
100 to 120 VAC ±10%, 200 to 240 VAC ±10%, 50/60 Hz ±1 Hz  
610 VA, 600 W  
Environmental  
requirements  
Temperature  
Humidity  
10 to 35°C (operating), -10 to 55°C (non-operating, storage)  
20 to 80% RH (no condensation)  
Others  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER supported, NEC ESMPRO provided  
in the standard configuration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A-2 Specifications  
(This page is intentionally left blank.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix B  
Other Precautions  
Transfer Rate of the On-board LAN Controller  
The mother board includes the two network interface controllers that supports 10Base-T, 100Base-  
TX, and 1000Base-T networks and a capable of full or half duplex.  
The both controllers can automatically detect and switch for network speed and transfer mode  
connected to the HUB. However, for proper network operation, specify the "Link Speed & Duplex"  
value the same as the value specified for HUB.  
Server Management Software  
The NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM that comes with the server contains the NEC ESMPRO  
utility.  
NEC recommends that you should install the NEC ESMPRO for effective use of the reliability  
enhancement features of the server.  
Floppy Disk  
The following describes use of the floppy disk.  
Floppy disk type  
The server uses 3.5-inch floppy disks. You can use the following two types of 3.5-inch floppy  
disks:  
2HD floppy disk (double-sided high-density track type)  
Stores data of 1.44MB.  
2DD floppy disk (double-sided double-density track type)  
Stores data of 720KB.  
Shutter  
Catching hole  
Insertion direction  
indicator  
Head window  
Centering hub  
Label  
Centering hole  
High-density media hole  
(2HD only)  
Write protection  
hole  
Write protection switch  
Front  
Rear  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-2 Other Precautions  
Notes on use  
The floppy disk is an important data storage media with delicate structure and requires care. Keep  
the following notes in mind to use it:  
Insert the floppy disk into the floppy disk drive gently as far as it goes.  
Attach the label to the correct position.  
Do not write anything directly onto the disk surface with a pencil or ball-point pen.  
Do not open the shutter.  
Do not use the floppy disk in a dusty place.  
Do not place anything on the floppy disk.  
Do not leave the floppy disk in a high-temperature place (e.g., place exposed to direct  
sunlight or close to a heater).  
Do not leave the floppy disk with foods and drinks, or in a place exposed to cigarette  
smoke.  
Do not leave the floppy disk near any form of liquid or a chemical or in a place where a  
chemical may be accidentally sprayed over them.  
Do not place any magnetic objects (e.g., magnet) near the floppy disk.  
Do not clip the floppy disk or drop it.  
Keep the floppy disk in a floppy disk case that protects it from magnetism and dust.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other Precautions B-3  
Write-protection  
A floppy disk has a write-protect switch that prevents the stored data from accidental  
erasure.  
You can read data from a write-protected floppy disk, but you cannot save data into the  
floppy disk or format it. NEC recommends that you should write-protect any floppy disk  
containing valuable data unless you are about to save data.  
To write-protect a 3.5-inch floppy disk, use the write-protect switch provided on its back.  
Disk format  
To write data into a floppy disk, the floppy disk must be "formatted." "Formatting" is to  
initialize the floppy disk and make it available for the system environment (operating  
system).  
IMPORTANT:  
Formatting a used floppy disk clears all the data contained in it, if  
any.  
Formatting a floppy disk from the DOS command line is not  
available with the server. Use a formatted floppy disk to work  
with it on the DOS command line.  
The format method depends on your operating system. Refer to the manual that comes  
with your operating system for details.  
Data backup  
"Data backup" is to copy data stored in a media into another media (e.g., floppy disk,  
digital audio tape, or magnet-optical disk).  
IMPORTANT: Make sure to make a back-up copy of every floppy  
disk, if provided.  
The floppy disk is a very delicate storage media. Dust or thermal changes, as well as  
operator's misconduct or server failures, may cause loss of data. To avoid loss of data,  
NEC recommends that you should make a back-up copy of your valuable data on a  
regular basis.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-4 Other Precautions  
CD-ROM  
Keep the following notes in mind to use the CD-ROM for the server:  
Press the center of the storage case to remove the CD-ROM from the case.  
Do not drop the CD-ROM.  
Do not place anything on the CD-ROM or bend the CD-ROM.  
Do not attach any label onto the CD-ROM.  
Do not touch the signal side (nothing is printed on this side) with your hand.  
Place the CD-ROM with its printed side upward and gently put it on the tray.  
Do not scratch the CD-ROM or write anything directly on it with a pencil or ball-point  
pen.  
Do not leave the CD-ROM with foods and drinks, or in a place exposed to cigarette  
smoke.  
Do not leave the CD-ROM in a high-temperature place (e.g., place exposed to direct  
sunlight or close to a heater).  
When dust or fingerprints are attached on the CD-ROM, wipe the CD-ROM from its  
center to edge with a dry soft cloth slowly and gently.  
Use the CD cleaner to clean the CD-ROM. Do not use record spray/cleaner, benzene, or  
thinner.  
Keep the CD-ROM in a CD-ROM case when not in use.  
Tape Media  
The following describes data handling with the DAT, DLT, or AIT optionally available for the  
server.  
Saving your valuable data  
When you save your valuable data or programs into the cartridge tape, you should save  
them into two cartridge tapes to make the primary and secondary tapes.  
This enables you to restore your data from one tape when the other makes a read error, as  
well as to protect your valuable data and programs from loss.  
Three-generation data management  
NEC recommends that you should employ three-generation data management for data  
storage.  
Three-generation data management uses three cartridge tapes: A, B, and C. You save  
data to tape A on the first day, tape B on the second day, tape C on the third day, tape A on  
the forth day, and so on. That is, you save data into cartridge tapes cyclically from tape  
A through C.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other Precautions B-5  
This enables you, for example, to use tape B to restore the data when tape C makes a read  
error. Also when both tapes B and C make a read error, you can restore your valuable  
data by using the data stored in tape A.  
Keyboard  
The keyboard is a device to instruct you computer by entering alphanumeric characters or symbols.  
IMPORTANT:  
Do not pour any liquid such as water or put anything into the  
keyboard. Doing so may cause a failure of the keyboard.  
The keyboard provided with the server is designed for adjustment of  
an angle. Adjust the keyboard angle at which the keyboard is easy  
to operate. The adjustment assists in reducing strain on your  
shoulders, arms, and fingers.  
NOTE: The keyboard functions depend on the software. Refer to the  
manual that comes with the software for details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B-6 Other Precautions  
Mouse  
Like the keyboard, the mouse is a device to instruct your computer. Many OS's and application  
software require the mouse for operation.  
NOTE:  
Functions assigned to the mouse buttons vary depending on the  
software. For details, refer to the manual provided with the  
software.  
Use the mouse on a clean desk. Using the mouse on a dusty or  
dirty desk disturbs smooth movement or normal operation of the  
mouse. When your mouse movement seems dull, clean your  
mouse. (See Chapter 7.)  
Mouse operation includes "Click," "Double-click," and "Drag."  
Click:  
Press the button only once and release it.  
Double-click:  
Drag:  
Press the button twice consecutively and release it.  
Press and hold the button and move the mouse.  
Operation of the server involves combinations of these mouse operations and data entries with the  
keyboard.  
Click  
Pressing  
Click  
Click  
Click  
Double-click  
Drag  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix C  
IRQ  
The factory-set interrupt requests is listed below. Find an appropriate one to install an optional  
device.  
IRQ  
0
Peripheral Device (Controller)  
System timer  
Keyboard  
COM2 serial port (PCI)  
COM1 serial port (PCI)  
PCI  
Floppy disk drive  
PCI  
Real-time clock  
ACPI compliant system  
PCI  
PCI  
IRQ  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
30  
31  
49  
50  
Peripheral Device (Controller)  
Mouse  
Numeric processor  
Primary IDE  
Secondary IDE  
USB  
VGA  
USB  
LAN1  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
LAN2  
Adaptec SCSI  
Adaptec SCSI  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C-2 IRQ  
(This page is intentionally left blank.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix D  
Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
This section explains how to install the Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions.  
BEFORE INSTALLING WINDOWS SERVER 2003 X64  
EDITIONS  
Please read carefully the following information BEFORE commencing your Windows Server 2003  
x64 Editions Installation.  
Optional Board Supported by NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM attached to your system supports the following optional  
boards:  
NOTE: If you want to install the other boards by using a driver floppy  
disk ("OEM-FD for Mass storage device"), except ones listed below,  
see "Exceptional setup" and "Installing Optional Mass Storage Driver"  
of "Configuration Diskette Creator" in Chapter 6.  
Supporting installation of OS in NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
– N8103-80F Disk Array Controller (SCSI 1ch)  
– N8103-81F Disk Array Controller (SCSI 2ch)  
– N8103-91 Disk array controller (Internal SAS HDD)  
– Adaptec HostRAID(SCSI) (Controller on the I/O board)  
Other optional boards  
– N8103-56 SCSI Controller  
– N8103-65F SCSI Controller  
– N8103-75 SCSI Controller  
– N8103-95 SCSI Controller  
– N8190-126 SCSI Controller  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D-2 Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
Updating System  
If you modified the Windows system, execute "Update Express5800 system" in Master Control  
Menu.  
Re-installing to the Hard Disk Drive which has been upgraded to  
Dynamic Disk  
If you want to leave the existing partition when installing the system on the hard disk drive  
upgraded to Dynamic Disk, note the following issue:  
Do not select the partition that OS had been installed as the partition to install the OS  
newly.  
Select "Use the current File System" for the format of OS partition.  
Manual Installation when N8103-80F/81F and SCSI HostRAID Keeps  
Connection  
If you keep those controllers connecting during installation process, pop-up messages may appear.  
This does not affect on system behavior. Click [YES] and continue the installation. Follow the  
message hereafter.  
MO Device  
If you specify the file system as NTFS with MO Device connected during the installation, the file  
system will not be converted normally. Disconnect MO Device and restart the installation from  
the beginning.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions D-3  
Partition Size  
The size for the partition that the system is to be installed can be calculated from the following  
formula.  
Size necessary to install the system + Paging File Size + Dump File Size  
+ Application Size  
Size necessary to install the system = 4100MB  
Paging File Size (Recommended) = Mounted Memory Size * 1.5  
Dump file Size  
Application Size  
= Mounted Memory Size + 1MB  
= Required Size  
IMPORTANT:  
The above-mentioned paging file size is recommended for  
collecting debug information (memory dump). The paging file with  
initial size large enough to store the dump file in the boot drive is  
required.  
Correct debug information might not be able to be collected due to  
virtual memory shortage when the paging file is insufficient, so set  
an enough size of the paging file with the entire system.  
Regardless of the size of the mounted memory, or the Write  
debugging information (type of memory dump), the maximum size  
of the dump file is 'The size of the mounted memory + 1MB'.  
If you install any application program or the like, add necessary  
space to the partition to install these programs.  
For example, if the mounted memory size is 512MB, the partition size will be calculated by the  
above formula as follows:  
4100MB + (512MB * 1.5) + (512MB + 1MB) + Application Size  
= 5381MB + Application Size  
Dividing into the partition of the recommended size into multiple disks as written below will solve  
problem that it cannot be reserved in one disk.  
1. Set the "Size required for installation + Paging file size".  
2. See Chapter 5 and set that debugging information (equivalent to the dump file size) is to  
be written to a separate disk.  
(If the disk does not have enough free space to enable the dump file size to be written,  
then after installing the system using the "Size required for installation + Paging file size",  
install an additional new disk.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D-4 Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
INSTALLING WINDOWS SERVER 2003 X64 EDITIONS  
Preparations for Installation  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM  
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 Standard x64 Edition / Microsoft Windows Server  
2003 R2 Enterprise x64 Edition / Microsoft Windows Server 2003 Standard x64 Edition /  
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 Enterprise x64 Edition (CD-ROM)  
User's Guide  
Getting Started  
Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
Creating "Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition OEM-DISK for NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER"  
Before installing, create Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition OEM-DISK for NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER.  
NOTE: If you have already "Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition OEM-  
DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" for NEC Express5800 Server  
which you are going to install Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition, you  
do not need to create it again.  
You can create Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER with  
the following two procedures.  
Create from the menu which appears when running NEC Express5800 Server with NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER.  
If you have only NEC Express5800 Server to create Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition  
OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER, use this procedure.  
If Windows Server 2003 or Windows 2000 can be operated on NEC Express5800 Server,  
you can use the other procedure described later.  
Follow the steps below.  
1. Prepare one 3.5-inch floppy disk.  
2. Turn on your NEC Express5800 Server.  
3. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of the server.  
4. Press the RESET switch or press Ctrl + Alt + Delete to reboot the server .(You may also  
turn off and then on again to reboot the server.)  
The system will boot from the CD-ROM and NEC EXPRESSBUILDER starts.  
5. Select [Create Support Disk] from [Tools].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions D-5  
6. Select [Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER]  
from [Create Support Disk] menu.  
7. Insert a floppy disk into the floppy disk drive according to the instruction on the screen.  
Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER will be  
created.  
Write-protect and attach a label, then keep it safely.  
Create from [Master Control Menu]  
[Master Control Menu] runs on the following operating systems.  
– Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
– Windows Server 2003  
– Windows XP x64 Edition  
– Windows XP  
– Windows 2000  
– Windows Me/98/95  
– Windows NT 4.0  
You can create Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition OEM-DISK for NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER from [Master Control Menu], if you have the computer on which  
the above operating systems operate.  
Follow the steps below.  
1. Prepare one 3.5-inch floppy disk.  
2. Run the operating system.  
3. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of the server.  
[Master Control Menu] will appear.  
4. Click on [Setup] with left mouse button and click [Make OEM-DISK] and then [for  
Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition].  
NOTE: You can do the same operation with the menu appeared by the  
Right-click.  
5. Insert the floppy disk into the floppy disk drive according to the message.  
Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER will be  
created.  
Write-protect and attach a label, then keep it safely.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D-6 Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions Clean Installation  
This section explains how to perform a clean installation of Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions.  
1. Turn on the system power.  
2. Insert the Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
3. Press Ctrl + Alt + Delete to reset the system.  
After a bootable operating system has been installed on the hard disk drive, press Enter  
while the message "Press any key to boot from CD..." is displayed at the top of the screen.  
If no bootable operating system exists on the hard disk drive, this step is unnecessary.  
The Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions setup screen will appear.  
If the screen is not displayed, Enter was not pressed properly.  
Begin after turning on the system power again.  
4. Press F6 while the message "Setup is inspecting your computer's hardware  
configuration..." is displayed at the upper part of the screen.  
IMPORTANT: There is no visible indication on screen when F6 has  
been pressed.  
5. When the following message is displayed, press S.  
Setup could not determine the type of one or more mass storage devices  
installed in your system, or you have chosen to manually specify an adapter.  
Currently, Setup will load support for the following mass storage devices.  
The following message is displayed.  
Please insert the disk labeled  
manufacturer-supplied hardware support disk  
into Drive A:  
*Press ENTER when ready.  
6. Insert the Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
into the floppy disk drive, and press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions D-7  
7. Select the proper SCSI Adapter and press Enter.  
– Adaptec HOSTRAID driver for Windows XP/2003 x64 Edition  
(When Adaptec HOSTRAID (SCSI) is installed.)  
– MegaRAID SCSI 320-1 RAID Controller Driver  
(When N8103-80F board is installed.)  
– MegaRAID SCSI 320-2 RAID Controller Driver  
(When N8103-81F board is installed.)  
– LSI Logic MegaRAID SAS RAID Controller Driver (Server 2003 for x64)  
(When N8103-91F board is installed.)  
Continue performing tasks according to the subsequent messages that appear.  
8. When the following message is shown, press Enter to start "Welcome to Setup".  
9. When the installation of Windows Server 2003 has finished, the system reboots  
automatically.  
– Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions has installed: Go on the step 13  
– Windows Server 2003 R2 x64 Editions has installed: Go on the step 10  
10. The [Windows setup] screen will be displayed after logged on to the system.  
IMPORTANT:  
In this case, the [Windows setup] screen may not be displayed.  
Be sure to install Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 x64 Edition  
DISC 2 according to the following procedures.  
You can install Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 x64 Edition  
DISC 2 after the application of "System update".  
Be sure to install Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 x64 Edition  
DISC 2.  
In this case, note that the [Windows setup] screen is not displayed.  
11. Insert Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 x64 Edition DISC 2 CD-ROM into the CD-  
ROM drive.  
Confirm the parameters and click [OK].  
12. When the installation has completed, remove Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 x64  
Edition DISC 2 CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive, and restart the system.  
13. When the installation has completed, be sure to execute the tasks described in "Driver  
Installation and Advanced Settings" and "Updating the System" of manual.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D-8 Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
Reinstallation to Multiple Logical drives  
This subsection describes the procedure for reinstalling the operation system if the multiple logical  
drives exist.  
Before Re-installing the Operation System  
Be sure to make backup copies before re-installing the operation system just in case.  
Re-installing the Operation System  
1. Start the clean installation following the procedure described in this manual.  
2. Specify the partition in which you want to install the operating system when the following  
message appears:  
The following list shows the existing partitions and  
unpartitioned space on this computer.  
Use the UP and DOWN ARROW keys to select an item in the list.  
*
Cannot modify the drive letter of your system or boot volume. Confirm the proper  
drive letter is assigned and then, continue the setup.  
3. Continue the clean installation again following the procedure described earlier in this  
chapter.  
The drive letter of the re-installed system may differ from the one of the previous system.  
If you need to modify the drive letter, modify it according to the "Procedure for  
Modifying the Drive Letter".  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions D-9  
Procedure for Modifying the Drive Letter  
Be careful that the drive letter of the system or boot volume cannot modify with the following  
procedure.  
1. Click Start menu, right-click [My Computer], and specify [Manage] to start  
[Computer Management].  
2. Specify the [Disk Management] in the left side of the window.  
3. Right-click the volume you want to modify the drive letter and specify the [Change Drive  
Letter and Path...].  
4. Click [Yes].  
5. Choose the [Assign a drive letter] and specify the drive letter you want to assign.  
6. Click [OK].  
7. If the following message appears, click [Yes].  
Changing the drive letter of a volume may cause programs to no  
longer run. Are you sure you want to change this drive letter?  
8.  
Close the [Computer Management].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D-10 Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
Updating the System  
To ensure normal system operation you should update your system using the following procedures.  
1. Logon to the system using the administrator account or other account which is a member  
of the Administrators group.  
2. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
Master Control Menu is automatically appeared on the screen.  
3. Click on [Setup] with left mouse button and click on [Update NEC Express5800 system]  
section.  
4. Continue your work for system update as the following message.  
5. Click on [Restart Computer] to restart the system.  
6. Remove the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive immediately  
after clicking on [Restart Computer]  
IMPORTANT: If you change the configuration of the system (by  
adding or removing hardware or Operating system software  
components) or repair the system, you must run the system update  
again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions D-11  
DRIVER INSTALLATION AND ADVANCED SETTINGS  
This section describes on how to install and setup various standard drivers mounted on the device.  
For the information on installing and setting up the driver that is not described in this section, please  
refer to the document attached to the driver.  
PROSet  
PROSet is a utility that confirms the function of network contained in network driver.  
Utilizing PROSet enables the following items:  
Confirm detailed information of the adapter.  
Diagnose loop back test, packet transmission test and so on.  
Setup of teaming.  
Configuring several network adapters as one team provides the server a tolerant environment on any  
trouble and enhances throughput between the switches.  
PROSet is necessary to utilize these features.  
Follow the procedure below to install PROSet.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
2. The [Windows Explorer] dialog starts.  
* The procedure in the case of the standard start menu  
Click Start menu and click [Windows Explorer].  
* The procedure in the case of the classic start menu  
Click Start menu, point to [Programs], [Accessories] and click [Windows Explorer].  
3. Run "DXSETUP.EXE" in the following directory.  
CD-ROM DriveLetter:\WINNT\W2K3AMD\NS1\PROSET\WS03_32E  
The [Intel(R) PROSet - Install Shield Wizard] dialog starts.  
4. Click [Next].  
5. Choose "I accept the terms in the license agreement" and click [Next].  
6. Click [Install].  
7. When [Install Shield Wizard Completed] window is displayed, click[Finish].  
8. Restart the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D-12 Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
Network Driver  
Specify the details of network driver.  
One standard network driver that is mounted will be installed automatically, but the link speed and  
Duplex mode need to be specified manually.  
[When PROSet is not installed]  
1. The [Local Area Connection Properties] dialog box appears.  
* The procedure in the case of the standard start menu  
Click Start menu, click [Control Panel], click [Network Connections], and  
click[Local Area Connection].  
* The procedure in the case of the classic start menu  
Click Start menu, click [Settings] and click [Network Connections].  
The [Network Connections] dialog box appears.  
2. Right-click [Local Area Connection] and click [Properties] from pop-up menu.  
3. Click [Configure].  
The property dialog box for network adapter appears.  
4. Click the [Advanced] and specify the [Link Speed & Duplex] value the same as the value  
specified for HUB.  
5. Click [OK] on the property dialog box for network adapter.  
[When PROSet is installed]  
1. Open the [Device Manager]  
2. Double-click [(Network Adapter Name)] in the list.  
3. Click the [Link] and specify the [Link Speed & Duplex Settings] value the same as the  
value specified for HUB.  
4. Click [OK].  
Also, add or delete any protocols and services if necessary.  
You can operate the process on the property dialog box for local area network which can be  
appeared from [Network and Dial-up Connection].  
NOTE: We recommend you to add [Network Monitor] at [Adding  
Services]. [Network Monitor] can monitor the frame (or the packet) that  
the computer installing [Network Monitor] sends or receives. This tool  
is valuable when analyzing network trouble. For information on how to  
install the tool, see the "Setting for Solving Problems" described later in  
this chapter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions D-13  
Optional Network Board Driver  
If you want to utilize optional Network Board (N8104-86/88/111), install the driver stored in NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM.  
In case of utilizing (N8104-86/88/111)  
"CD-ROM Drive Letter:\WINNT\W2K3AMD\NS1\PRO100\WS03_32E"  
In case of utilizing (N8104-112/103/113/109/115)  
"CD-ROM Drive Letter:\WINNT\W2K3AMD\NS1\PRO1000\WS03_32E"  
If the procedure of installation is not clear, refer to the installation procedure described in the  
section "Installation of the Optional Network Board Driver".  
Installation of the Optional Network Board Driver  
1. Start Device Manager.  
2. Click [Network adapters] and double-click [(Network Adapter Name)].  
[(Network Adapter Name) Properties] appears.  
NOTE: [(Intel(R) PRO/1000...)] is the name of On-Board adapter. All  
other names show the Optional Network Board.  
3. Click [Driver] tab and click [Update Driver...]. [Hardware Update Wizard] appears.  
4. Select the [Install from a list or specific location (Advanced)] radio button and click  
[Next].  
5. Select the [Search for the best driver in these locations] radio button and check off the  
[Search removable media (floppy, CD-ROM...)] check box.  
6. Check the [Include this location in the search] check box and when using [(N8104-  
86/111)], specify [CD-ROM driveletter:\WINNT\W2K3AMD\NS1\PRO100\WS03_32E].  
And when using [(N8104-112/103/113/109/115)],  
specify [CD-ROM driveletter:\WINNT\W2K3AMD\NS1\PRO1000\WS03_32E].  
Then click [Next].  
7. Click [Finish].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D-14 Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
Adapter Fault Tolerance (AFT)/Adaptive Load Balancing (ALB)  
Adapter Fault Tolerance (AFT) is a feature that creates a group containing more than one adapter  
and automatically converts the process of the working adapter to the other adapter in the group  
when any trouble occurred on that adapter.  
Adaptive Load Balancing (ALB) is a feature that creates a group containing more than one adapter  
and enhance the through put by operating packet transmission from the server by all the adapters.  
This feature includes AFT feature.  
IMPORTANT:  
AFT/ALB setup must be operated after installing the drivers and  
restarting the system.  
All the adapters specified as a group of Adapter Teaming must exist  
on the same LAN. If they are connected to the separate switches,  
they will not work normally.  
If you want to utilize AFT/ALB feature, follow the procedure below to setup.  
1. Open the Network Adapter Property from the Device Manager.  
2. Select the [Teaming] tab, check "Team with other adapters" and click [New Team].  
3. Enter a name of the team and click the [Next].  
4. Check adapters to be included in the team and click [Next].  
5. In [Select a team mode], select [Adapter Fault Tolerance] or [Adaptive Load Balancing]  
and click [Next].  
6. Click [Finish].  
7. From the Device Manager, open the device property of the team name set above, select  
the [Settings] tab, and click [Modify Team].  
8. To set an adapter in the team as the primary adapter, select a driver and click [Set  
Primary].  
To set an adapter in the team as the secondary adapter, select a driver and click [Set  
Secondary].  
After terminating both settings, click [OK] and close the screen.  
Re-install the Network Driver  
The network driver will be installed automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions D-15  
Graphics Accelerator Driver  
Standard graphics accelerator drivers that are mounted will be installed automatically.  
The following is the procedure when it is necessary to install manually.  
If you want to utilize optional Graphics Accelerator Driver board, follow the document attached to  
the board to install the driver.  
* For the graphics accelerator driver for Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions, the use of a remote  
KVM console that installs the advanced N8115-02 remote management card is supported by the  
standard. A special driver need not be installed.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
2. Click Start menu, point to [Programs], [Accessories] and click [Windows Explorer]  
3. Run "SETUP.EXE" in the following directory.  
<CD-ROM Drive Letter>:\WINNT\W2K3AMD\VIDEO\SETUP.EXE  
4. Follow the message to continue the installation.  
5. Remove the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive, follow the  
direction on the screen and restart the system.  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-56/-75/-95/N8190-126)  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-56/-75/-95/N8190-126), update your system with NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM attached to your system.  
The SCSI controller driver will be installed automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D-16 Installing Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
Installing RAID Controller Driver (N8103-80F/81F)  
To additionally install the N8103-80F/81F in a system containing Windows Server 2003, connect  
the controller and take the following steps to install the driver:  
1. Start [Device Manager] from [Start] menu [Control Panel] [Administrative Tools]  
[Computer Management].  
2. Double-click [LSI Logic Megaraid SCSI 320-1/2] which Device Manager lists.  
3. Click the [Driver] tab and click [Update Driver...].  
4. When the "Update Device Driver Wizard" appears, select "Install from a list or specific  
location [Advanced]" and click [Next].  
5. Select the "Search for the best driver in these locations." and check the "Search removable  
media [floppy, CD-ROM...]" check box.  
6. Insert "Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy  
disk drive, and click [Next].  
7. Copying of the driver is completed, and the [Completing the Hardware Update Wizard]  
dialog box below appears. Click [Finish].  
SETTING FOR COLLECTING MEMORY DUMP  
(DEBUG INFORMATION)  
Set for collecting memory dump using the procedure described in Chapter 5.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
Installing Windows Server 2003  
This section explains how to install the Windows Server 2003 without using Express Setup.  
BEFORE INSTALLING WINDOWS SERVER 2003  
Please read carefully the following information BEFORE commencing your Windows Server 2003  
Installation.  
Optional Board Supported by NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM attached to your system supports the following optional  
boards:  
NOTE: If you want to install the other boards by using a driver floppy  
disk ("OEM-FD for Mass storage device"), except ones listed below,  
see "Exceptional setup" and "Installing Optional Mass Storage Driver"  
of "Configuration Diskette Creator" in Chapter 6.  
Supporting installation of OS in NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
– N8103-80F Disk Array Controller (SCSI 1ch)  
– N8103-81F Disk Array Controller (SCSI 2ch)  
– N8103-86 Disk Array Controller (0ch)  
– N8103-91 Disk array controller (Internal SAS HDD)  
– Adaptec HostRAID(SCSI) (Controller on the I/O board)  
Other optional boards  
– N8103-56 SCSI Controller  
– N8103-65F SCSI Controller  
– N8103-75 SCSI Controller  
– N8103-95 SCSI Controller  
– N8190-126 SCSI Controller  
[In case of use of N8103-91]  
In use of N8103-91, please surely install Windows Server 2003 ServicePack 1 by  
Windows Server 2003.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-2 Installing Windows Server 2003  
Disk Array Controller (N8103-91)  
Disk Array Controller (N8103-91) supports Windows Server 2003 Service Pack 1 or later.  
If your system is not Service Pack 1 or later, please update Service Pack.  
Installing Service Pack  
You can install the Service Pack on the server. When the Service Pack is not attached to your system,  
prepare it by yourself.  
Updating System  
If you modified the Windows system, execute "Update Express5800 system" in Master Control  
Menu.  
Re-installing to the Hard Disk Drive which has been upgraded to  
Dynamic Disk  
If you want to leave the existing partition when installing the system on the hard disk drive  
upgraded to Dynamic Disk, note the following issue:  
Do not select the partition that OS had been installed as the partition to install the OS  
newly.  
Select "Use the current File System" for the format of OS partition.  
Manual Installation when N8103-80F/81F/86 and SCSI HostRAID Keeps  
Connection  
If you keep those controllers connecting during installation process, pop-up messages may appear.  
This does not affect on system behavior. Click [YES] and continue the installation. Follow the  
message hereafter.  
MO Device  
If you specify the file system as NTFS with MO Device connected during the installation, the file  
system will not be converted normally. Disconnect MO Device and restart the installation from  
the beginning.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 E-3  
Partition Size  
The size for the partition that the system is to be installed can be calculated from the following  
formula.  
Size necessary to install the system + Paging File Size + Dump File Size  
+ Application Size  
Size necessary to install the system = 2900MB (Only Windows Server 2003)  
3500MB (Windows Server 2003 with Service  
Pack1)  
4400MB (Windows Server 2003 + Service Pack1  
CD-ROM)  
Paging File Size (Recommended) = Mounted Memory Size * 1.5  
Dump file Size  
= Mounted Memory Size + 12MB  
= Required Size  
Application Size  
IMPORTANT:  
The above-mentioned paging file size is recommended for  
collecting debug information (memory dump). The paging file with  
initial size large enough to store the dump file in the boot drive is  
required.  
Correct debug information might not be able to be collected due to  
virtual memory shortage when the paging file is insufficient, so set  
an enough size of the paging file with the entire system.  
The maximum paging file size which can be set on one partition is  
4095MB. If the above paging file size exceeds 4095MB, specify  
4095MB for the paging file size.  
The maximum dump file size for the system with more than 2GB  
memory mounted is '2048MB + 12MB'.  
If you install any application program or the like, add necessary  
space to the partition to install these programs.  
For example, if the mounted memory size is 512MB, the partition size will be calculated by the  
above formula as follows:  
2900MB + (512MB * 1.5) + (512MB + 12MB) + Application Size  
= 4192MB + Application Size  
Dividing into the partition of the recommended size into multiple disks as written below will solve  
problem that it cannot be reserved in one disk.  
1. Set the "Size required for installation + Paging file size".  
2. See Chapter 5 and set that debugging information (equivalent to the dump file size) is to  
be written to a separate disk.  
(If the disk does not have enough free space to enable the dump file size to be written,  
then after installing the system using the "Size required for installation + Paging file size",  
install an additional new disk.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-4 Installing Windows Server 2003  
About the Upgrade to Windows Server 2003 R2  
The "in-place upgrade" from Windows Server 2003 to Windows Server 2003 R2 is not  
recommended because it may overwrite any files or registries, and cause unexpected impact to the  
system or the applications.  
If you install Windows Server 2003 R2, backup user data referring "Windows Server 2003 Clean  
Installation", and reinstall Windows Server 2003 R2.  
NOTE: "in-place upgrade" is to perform overwrite upgrade from  
Windows Server 2003 which already installed to Windows Server 2003  
R2.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 E-5  
INSTALLING WINDOWS SERVER 2003  
Preparations for Installation  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM  
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 Standard Edition / Microsoft Windows Server 2003  
R2 Enterprise Edition / Microsoft Windows Server 2003 Standard Edition / Microsoft  
Windows Server 2003 Enterprise Edition (CD-ROM)  
User's Guide  
Getting Started  
Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
Windows Server 2003 Service Pack (CD-ROM)  
Creating "Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER"  
Before installing, create Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
NOTE: If you have already "Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" for NEC Express5800 Server which you  
are going to install Windows Server 2003, you do not need to create it  
again.  
You can create Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER with the  
following two procedures.  
Create from the menu which appears when running NEC Express5800 Server with NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER.  
If you have only NEC Express5800 Server to create Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK  
for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER, use this procedure.  
If Windows Server 2003 or Windows 2000 can be operated on NEC Express5800 Server,  
you can use the other procedure described later.  
Follow the steps below.  
1. Prepare one 3.5-inch floppy disk.  
2. Turn on your NEC Express5800 Server.  
3. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of the server.  
4. Press the RESET switch or press Ctrl + Alt + Delete to reboot the server .(You may also  
turn off and then on again to reboot the server.)  
The system will boot from the CD-ROM and NEC EXPRESSBUILDER starts.  
5. Select [Create Support Disk] from [Tools].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-6 Installing Windows Server 2003  
6. Select [Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER] from [Create  
Support Disk] menu.  
7. Insert a floppy disk into the floppy disk drive according to the instruction on the screen.  
Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER will be created.  
Write-protect and attach a label, then keep it safely.  
Create from [Master Control Menu]  
[Master Control Menu] runs on the following operating systems.  
– Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
– Windows Server 2003  
– Windows XP x64 Edition  
– Windows XP  
– Windows 2000  
– Windows Me/98/95  
– Windows NT 4.0  
You can create Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER from  
[Master Control Menu], if you have the computer on which the above operating systems  
operate.  
Follow the steps below.  
1. Prepare one 3.5-inch floppy disk.  
2. Run the operating system.  
3. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of the server.  
[Master Control Menu] will appear.  
4. Click on [Setup] with left mouse button and click [Make OEM-DISK] and then [for  
Windows Server 2003].  
NOTE: You can do the same operation with the menu appeared by the  
Right-click.  
5. Insert the floppy disk into the floppy disk drive according to the message.  
Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER will be created.  
Write-protect and attach a label, then keep it safely.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 E-7  
Windows Server 2003 Clean Installation  
This section explains how to perform a clean installation of Windows Server 2003.  
1. Turn on the system power.  
2. Insert the Windows Server 2003 CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
3. Press Ctrl + Alt + Delete to reset the system.  
After a bootable operating system has been installed on the hard disk drive, press Enter  
while the message "Press any key to boot from CD..." is displayed at the top of the screen.  
If no bootable operating system exists on the hard disk drive, this step is unnecessary.  
The Windows Server 2003 setup screen will appear.  
If the screen is not displayed, Enter was not pressed properly.  
Begin after turning on the system power again.  
4. Press F6 while the message "Setup is inspecting your computer's hardware  
configuration..." is displayed at the upper part of the screen.  
IMPORTANT: There is no visible indication on screen when F6 has  
been pressed.  
5. When the following message is displayed, press S.  
Setup could not determine the type of one or more mass storage devices  
installed in your system, or you have chosen to manually specify an adapter.  
Currently, Setup will load support for the following mass storage devices.  
The following message is displayed.  
Please insert the disk labeled  
manufacturer-supplied hardware support disk  
into Drive A:  
*Press ENTER when ready.  
6. Insert the Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER into the  
floppy disk drive, and press Enter.  
Select the [Adaptec Ultra320 SCSI Cards (WinXP/Server 2003 IA-32)] and press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-8 Installing Windows Server 2003  
7. Select the proper SCSI Adapter and press Enter.  
– Adaptec HostRAID U320 Driver Ver 1.02 For Windows 2000/XP/2003  
(When Adaptec HostRAID (SCSI) is installed.)  
– MegaRAID SCSI 320-1 RAID Controller Driver (When N8103-80F board is installed.)  
– MegaRAID SCSI 320-2 RAID Controller Driver (When N8103-81F board is installed.)  
– Adaptec I2O RAID Driver Disk for 32bit Windows 2000/XP/2003  
(When N8103-86 board is installed.)  
– LSI Logic MegaRAID SAS RAID Controller Driver (Server 2003 32-bit)  
(When N8103-91 board is installed.)  
Continue performing tasks according to the subsequent messages that appear.  
8. When the following message is shown, press Enter to start "Welcome to Setup".  
9. When the installation of Windows Server 2003 has finished, the system reboots  
automatically.  
– Windows Server 2003 has been installed: Go on the step 13.  
– Windows Server 2003 R2 has been installed: Go on the step 10.  
10. When Windows Server 2003 R2 has been installed, the [Windows setup] screen will be  
displayed after logged on to the system.  
IMPORTANT:  
In this case, the [Windows setup] screen may not be displayed.  
Be sure to install Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 DISC 2  
according to the following procedures.  
You can install Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 DISC 2 after  
the application of "System update".  
Be sure to install Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 DISC 2.  
In this case, note that the [Windows setup] screen is not displayed.  
11. Insert Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 DISC 2 CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
Confirm the parameters and click [OK].  
12. When the installation has completed, remove Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 DISC 2  
CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive, and restart the system.  
13. When the installation has completed, be sure to execute the tasks described in "Driver  
Installation and Advanced Settings" and "Updating the System" of manual.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 E-9  
Upgrade Installation  
IMPORTANT: It is not the procedure of upgrade installation to  
Windows Server 2003 R2 from Windows Server 2003.  
Please refer to [About the upgrade to Windows Server 2003 R2] for  
details.  
NOTE: Please do the upgrade installation after deleting the graphics  
accelerator driver.  
Procedures below upgrade the installed Windows 2000 to Windows Server 2003.  
1. Power on the system and start Windows 2000.  
2. Log on as an administrator.  
3. Insert the Windows Server 2003 CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
Then, [Select an operation] dialog will appear.  
NOTE: If the [Select an operation] dialog box does not appear, start  
\SETUP.EXE from CD-ROM drive.  
4. Select [Install Windows Server 2003].  
Then, a dialog box asks to select the upgrade or clear installation.  
5. Select "Upgrade (recommended)" and click the Next.  
Follow the messages and continue. The system will automatically restart after copying  
the files.  
NOTE: You can leave the Windows Server 2003 CD-ROM in CD-  
ROM drive.  
6. If the RAID controller or SCSI controller is installed in the system, press F6 while a  
message, "Press F6 if you need to install a third party SCSI or RAID driver...", is on the  
screen.  
IMPORTANT: There is no visible indication on screen when F6 has  
been pressed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-10 Installing Windows Server 2003  
7. When the following message is displayed, press S.  
Setup could not determine the type of one or more mass storage devices  
installed in your system, or you have chosen to manually specify an adapter.  
Currently, Setup will load support for the following mass storage devices.  
The following message is displayed.  
Please insert the disk labeled  
manufacturer-supplied hardware support disk  
into Drive A:  
*Press ENTER when ready.  
8. Insert the Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER into the  
floppy disk drive, and press Enter.  
A list of mass storage devices is displayed.  
Select the [Adaptec Ultra320 SCSI Cards (Win XP/Server 2003 IA-32)] and press Enter.  
Then, it returns to the screen of Procedure 7.  
9. If the optional board is installed, select the proper SCSI Adapter and press Enter.  
– Adaptec HostRAID U320 Driver Ver 1.02 For Windows 2000/XP/2003  
(When Adaptec HostRAID (SCSI) is installed.)  
– MegaRAID SCSI 320-1 RAID Controller Driver  
(When N8103-80F board is installed.)  
– MegaRAID SCSI 320-2 RAID Controller Driver  
(When N8103-81F board is installed.)  
– Adaptec I2O RAID Driver Disk for 32bit Windows 2000/XP/2003  
(When N8103-86 board is installed.)  
– LSI Logic MegaRAID SAS RAID Controller Driver (Server 2003 32-bit)  
(When N8103-91F board is installed.)  
Continue performing tasks according to the subsequent messages that appear.  
10. When the following message is shown, press Enter to start "Welcome to Setup".  
11. When the installation of Windows Server 2003 has finished, the system reboots  
automatically.  
– Windows Server 2003 has been installed: Go on the step 15.  
– Windows Server 2003 R2 has been installed: Go on the step 12.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 E-11  
12. When Windows Server 2003 R2 has been installed, the [Windows setup] screen will be  
displayed after logged on to the system.  
IMPORTANT:  
In this case, the [Windows setup] screen may not be displayed.  
Be sure to install Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 DISC 2  
according to the following procedures.  
You can install Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 DISC 2 after  
the application of "System update".  
Be sure to install Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 DISC 2.  
In this case, note that the [Windows setup] screen is not displayed.  
13. Insert Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 DISC 2 CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
Confirm the parameters and click [OK].  
14. When the installation has completed, remove Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 DISC 2  
CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive, and restart the system.  
15. When the installation has completed, be sure to execute the tasks described in "Driver  
Installation and Advanced Settings" and "Updating the System" of manual.  
SCSI controller (N8103-56)  
If your system has a controller (N8103-56), following message often appears on the  
display during the upgrade installation to Windows Server 2003.  
Please type D:/i386 and click OK. (D: CD-Drive)  
Insert disk  
The file 'adpu160m.sys' on Adaptec Windows 2000 Family Manager set V1.12 S2 is needed.  
Type the path where the file is located, and then click OK.  
If PROSet is already installed, uninstall the PROSet before upgrading.  
If the teaming function is enabled, disable the function before uninstalling PROSet.  
During upgrade installation, [Disk Insert] dialog box may appear.  
If it appears, click Cancel.  
When upgrade installation is completed, [Device Driver Wizard] dialog box may appear.  
If it appears, click Cancel, then update the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-12 Installing Windows Server 2003  
Reinstallation to Multiple Logical drives  
This subsection describes the procedure for reinstalling the operation system if the multiple logical  
drives exist.  
Before Re-installing the Operation System  
Be sure to make backup copies before re-installing the operation system just in case.  
Re-installing the Operation System  
1. Start the clean installation following the procedure described in this manual.  
2. Specify the partition in which you want to install the operating system when the following  
message appears:  
The following list shows the existing partitions and  
unpartitioned space on this computer.  
Use the UP and DOWN ARROW keys to select an item in the list.  
*
Cannot modify the drive letter of your system or boot volume. Confirm the proper  
drive letter is assigned and then, continue the setup.  
3. Continue the clean installation again following the procedure described earlier in this  
chapter.  
The drive letter of the re-installed system may differ from the one of the previous system.  
If you need to modify the drive letter, modify it according to the "Procedure for  
Modifying the Drive Letter".  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 E-13  
Procedure for Modifying the Drive Letter  
Be careful that the drive letter of the system or boot volume cannot modify with the following  
procedure.  
1. Click Start menu, right-click [My Computer], and specify [Manage] to start  
[Computer Management].  
2. Specify the [Disk Management] in the left side of the window.  
3. Right-click the volume you want to modify the drive letter and specify the [Change Drive  
Letter and Path...].  
4. Click [Yes].  
5. Choose the [Assign a drive letter] and specify the drive letter you want to assign.  
6. Click [OK].  
7. If the following message appears, click [Yes].  
Changing the drive letter of a volume may cause programs to no  
longer run. Are you sure you want to change this drive letter?  
8.  
Close the [Computer Management].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-14 Installing Windows Server 2003  
Updating the System - Installing Service Pack -  
IMPORTANT: If you install Windows Server 2003 CD-ROM which  
contains Service Pack 1 to your system, you do not have to apply  
Service Pack 1 again.  
To ensure normal system operation you should update your system using the following procedures.  
1. Logon to the system using the administrator account or other account which is a member  
of the Administrators group.  
2. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
Master Control Menu is automatically appeared on the screen.  
3. Click on [Setup] with left mouse button and click on [Update NEC Express5800 system]  
section.  
4. Continue your work for system update as the following message.  
5. Click on [Restart Computer] to restart the system.  
6. Remove the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive immediately  
after clicking on [Restart Computer]  
IMPORTANT: If you change the configuration of the system (by  
adding or removing hardware or Operating system software  
components) or repair the system, you must run the system update  
again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 E-15  
DRIVER INSTALLATION AND ADVANCED SETTINGS  
This section describes on how to install and setup various standard drivers mounted on the device.  
For the information on installing and setting up the driver that is not described in this section, please  
refer to the document attached to the driver.  
PROSet  
PROSet is a utility that confirms the function of network contained in network driver.  
Utilizing PROSet enables the following items:  
Confirm detailed information of the adapter.  
Diagnose loop back test, packet transmission test and so on.  
Setup of teaming.  
Configuring several network adapters as one team provides the server a tolerant environment on any  
trouble and enhance throughput between the switches.  
PROSet is necessary to utilize these features.  
Follow the procedure below to install PROSet.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
2. The [Windows Explorer] dialog starts.  
* The procedure in the case of the standard start menu  
Click Start menu and click [Windows Explorer].  
* The procedure in the case of the classic start menu  
Click Start menu, point to [Programs], [Accessories] and click [Windows Explorer].  
3. Run "PROSET.EXE" in the following directory.  
CD-ROM DriveLetter:\WINNT\DOTNET\BC5\PROSET\WS03XP32  
The [Intel(R) PROSet - InstallShield Wizard] dialog starts.  
4. Click [Next].  
5. Choose "I accept the terms in the license agreement" and click [Next].  
6. Choose "Typical" and click [Next].  
7. Click [Install].  
8. When [InstallShield Wizard Completed] window is displayed, click [Finish].  
9. Restart the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-16 Installing Windows Server 2003  
Network Driver  
Specify the details of network driver.  
One standard network driver that is mounted will be installed automatically, but the link speed and  
Duplex mode need to be specified manually.  
[When PROSet is not installed]  
1. The [Local Area Connection Properties] dialog box appears.  
* The procedure in the case of the standard start menu  
1. Click Start menu, Click [Control Panel], Click [Network Connections], and Click  
[Local Area Connection].  
* The procedure in the case of the classic start menu  
1. Click Start menu, Click [Settings] and Click [Network Connections].  
The [Network Connections] dialog box appears.  
2. Right-click [Local Area Connection] and click [Properties] from pop-up menu.  
2. Click [Configure].  
The property dialog box for network adapter appears.  
3. Click the [Advanced] and specify the [Link Speed & Duplex] value the same as the value  
specified for HUB.  
4. Click [OK] on the property dialog box for network adapter.  
[When PROSet is installed]  
1. The [Intel(R) PROSet for Wired Connections] dialog box appears.  
* The procedure in the case of the standard start menu  
Click Start menu, point to [Control Panel] and click [Intel(R) PROSet Wired].  
* The procedure in the case of the classic start menu  
1. Click Start menu, point to [Settings] and click [Control Panel].  
2. Double-click [Intel(R) PROSet Wired] on the [Control Panel] window.  
2. Click [(Network Adapter Name)] in the list.  
3. Click the [Speed] and specify the [Link Speed & Duplex Settings] value the same as the  
value specified for HUB.  
4. Click [Apply] and click [OK].  
Also, add or delete any protocols and services if necessary.  
You can operate the process on the property dialog box for local area network which can be  
appeared from [Network and Dial-up Connection].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 E-17  
NOTE: We recommend you to add [Network Monitor] at [Adding  
Services]. [Network Monitor] can monitor the frame (or the packet) that  
the computer installing [Network Monitor] sends or receives. This tool  
is valuable when analyzing network trouble. For information on how to  
install the tool, see the "Setting for Solving Problems" in Chapter 5.  
Re-install the Network Driver  
The network driver will be installed automatically.  
Graphics Accelerator Driver  
Standard graphics accelerator drivers that are mounted will be installed automatically.  
The following is the procedure when it is necessary to install manually.  
If you want to utilize optional Graphics Accelerator Driver board, follow the document attached to  
the board to install the driver.  
*
For the graphics accelerator driver, the use of a remote KVM console that installs the advanced  
N8115-02 remote management card is supported by the standard.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
2. Click Start menu, point to [Programs], [Accessories] and click [Windows Explorer]  
3. Run "SETUP.EXE" in the following directory.  
<CD-ROM Drive Letter>:\WINNT\DOTNET\VIDEO\SETUP.EXE  
4. Follow the message to continue the installation.  
5. Remove the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive, follow the  
direction on the screen and restart the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-18 Installing Windows Server 2003  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-65F)  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-65F), install it according to the following procedure:  
1. Start [Device Manager] from [Start] menu [Control Panel][Administrative Tools] →  
[Computer Management].  
2. Double-click the SCSI Controller driver which Device Manager lists as Other device.  
3. Click [Update Driver].  
4. When the "Update Device Driver Wizard" appears, select "Install from a list or specific  
location [Advanced]" and click [Next].  
5. Select "Don't search. I will choose the driver to install" and click [Next].  
6. Click [Have Disk..].  
7. Insert "Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy  
disk drive, enter "a:\" into "copy manufacturer's file from:" and click [OK].  
8. Specify the following driver and click [Next].  
[INITIO INI-A10XU2W PCI SCSI Controller] (When N8103-65F board is installed.)  
The installation of the driver is completed.  
Restart the system according to the message appeared on the screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 E-19  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-75)  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-75), install it according to the following procedure:  
<In the case of use of Windows Server 2003 SevicePack1 or Windows Server 2003  
R2>  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-75), update your system with NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM attached to your system.  
The SCSI controller driver will be installed automatically.  
<In the case of Windows Server 2003 which has not installed SevicePack1>  
1. Start [Device Manager] from [Start] menu [Control Panel] [Administrative Tools]→  
[Computer Management].  
2. Double-click the SCSI Controller driver which Device Manager lists as Other device.  
3. Click [Update Driver].  
4. When the "Update Device Driver Wizard" appears, select "Install from a list or specific  
location [Advanced]" and click [Next].  
5. Select "Don't search. I will choose the driver to install" and click [Next].  
6. Click [Have Disk..].  
7. Insert "Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy  
disk drive, enter "a:\" into "copy manufacturer's file from:" and click [OK].  
8. Specify the following driver and click [Next].  
[Adaptec SCSI Card 29320ALP -Ultra320 SCSI] (When N8103-75 board is installed.)  
The installation of the driver is completed.  
Restart the system according to the message appeared on the screen.  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-56/-95/N8190-126)  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-56/-95/N8190-126), update your system with NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM attached to your system.  
The SCSI controller driver will be installed automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-20 Installing Windows Server 2003  
Installing Disk Array Controller Driver (N8103-80F/81F)  
To additionally install the N8103-80F/81F in a system containing Windows Server 2003, connect  
the controller and take the following steps to install the driver:  
<In the case of use of Windows Server 2003 SevicePack1 or Windows Server 2003  
R2>  
1. Start [Device Manager] from [Start] menu [Control Panel] [Administrative Tools]  
[Computer Management].  
2. Double-click [LSI Logic Megaraid SCSI 320-1/2] which Device Manager lists.  
3. Click the [Driver] tab and click [Update Driver...].  
4. When the "Update Device Driver Wizard" appears, select "Install from a list or specific  
location [Advanced]" and click [Next].  
5. Select the "Search for the best driver in these locations." and check the "Search removable  
media [floppy, CD-ROM...]" check box.  
6. Insert "Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy  
disk drive, and click [Next].  
7. Copying of the driver is completed, and the [Completing the Hardware Update Wizard]  
dialog box below appears. Click [Finish].  
<In the case of Windows Server 2003 which has not installed SevicePack1>  
1. Start [Device Manager] from [Start] menu [Control Panel] [Administrative Tools]  
[Computer Management].  
2. Double-click the SCSI Controller driver which Device Manager lists as Other device.  
3. Click the [Driver] tab and click [Update Driver...].  
4. When the "Update Device Driver Wizard" appears, select "Install from a list or specific  
location [Advanced]" and click [Next].  
5. Select the "Search for the best driver in these locations." and check the "Search removable  
media [floppy, CD-ROM...]" check box.  
6. Insert "Windows Server 2003 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy  
disk drive, and click [Next].  
7. Copying of the driver is completed, and the [Completing the Hardware Update Wizard]  
dialog box below appears. Click [Finish].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 E-21  
About Windows Activation  
Windows Server 2003 must be activated before you can use Windows Server 2003.  
Windows activation process is as follows.  
NOTE: When you use Windows Server 2003 R2, activation process is  
not needed.  
1. Click [Run] on [Start] menu.  
Type as follows in the [Open:] box, and click [OK].  
oobe/msoobe /a  
2. When the screen as follows is displayed, click [Next].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-22 Installing Windows Server 2003  
The following screen is displayed.  
3. Process "Windows activation" according to the following message.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows Server 2003 E-23  
Available Switch Options for Windows Server 2003 Boot.ini File  
Many different switches will be available if you edit Boot.ini file.  
For the available switch options, refer to the following information:  
Microsoft Knowledge Base - Article ID: 833721  
"Available switch options for the Windows XP and the Windows Server 2003 Boot.ini  
files"  
If your system has a memory capacity in excess of 4GB in its installing, adding /PAE switch in  
Boot.ini file will enable the system to be installed with over 4GB of memory.  
However, the Microsoft operating system products which support /PAE switch option are limited.  
Refer to the following article in Microsoft Knowledge Base to check the supported products.  
Microsoft Knowledge Base - Article ID: 291988  
"A description of the 4GB RAM tuning feature and the Physical Address Extension  
switch"  
Below is the example on how to add /PAE switch to Boot.ini file.  
1. Click [Start], point to [Settings], and then click [Control Panel].  
2. In [Control Panel], double-click [System].  
3. Click the [Advanced] tab, and then click [Settings] under [Setup and Recovery].  
4. Under [System Setup], click [Edit] to open [Boot.ini].  
5. Add "/PAE" to [Operating Systems] section in [Boot.ini] file, and then save it.  
<Example of Boot.ini file>  
[boot loader]  
timeout=30  
default=multi(0)disk(0)rdisk(0)partition(2)\WINDOWS  
[operating systems]  
multi(0)disk(0)rdisk(0)partition(2)\WINDOWS="Windows Server 2003" /fastdetect  
multi(0)disk(0)rdisk(0)partition(2)\WINDOWS="Windows Server 2003, PAE" /fastdetect  
/PAE  
C:\CMDCONS\BOOTSECT.DAT="Microsoft Windows Recovery Console" /cmdcons  
This is the end of editing Boot.ini file.  
NOTE: If you choose one of the items in the "Default operating  
system" drop-down list box in [Setup and Recovery] group box, you  
can make your system start automatically from the switch you  
specified.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-24 Installing Windows Server 2003  
SETTING FOR COLLECTING MEMORY DUMP  
(DEBUG INFORMATION)  
Set for collecting memory dump using the procedure described in Chapter 5.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix F  
Installing Windows 2000  
This section explains how to install the Windows 2000 without using Express Setup tool.  
BEFORE INSTALLING WINDOWS 2000  
Please read carefully the following information BEFORE commencing your Windows 2000  
Installation.  
Optional Board Supported by NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM attached to your system supports the following optional  
boards:  
NOTE: If you want to install the other boards by using a driver floppy  
disk ("OEM-FD for Mass storage device"), except ones listed below,  
see "Exceptional setup" and "Installing Optional Mass Storage Driver"  
of "Configuration Diskette Creator" in Chapter 6.  
Supporting installation of OS in NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
– N8103-80F Disk Array Controller (SCSI 1ch)  
– N8103-81F Disk Array Controller (SCSI 2ch)  
– N8103-86 Disk Array Controller (0ch)  
– Adaptec HostRAID(SCSI) (Controller on the I/O board)  
Other optional boards  
– N8103-56 SCSI Controller  
– N8103-65F SCSI Controller  
– N8103-75 SCSI Controller  
– N8103-95 SCSI Controller  
– N8190-126 SCSI Controller  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F-2 Installing Windows 2000  
Disk Array Controller (N8103-91)  
Disk Array Controller (N8103-91) does not support Windows 2000.  
Installing Service Pack  
You can install the Service Pack on the server. When the Service Pack is not attached to your  
system, prepare it by yourself.  
Updating System  
If you modified the Windows system, execute "Update Express5800 system" in Master Control  
Menu.  
Re-installing to the Hard Disk Drive which has been upgraded to  
Dynamic Disk  
If you want to leave the existing partition when installing the system on the hard disk drive  
upgraded to Dynamic Disk, note the following issue:  
Do not select the partition that OS had been installed as the partition to install the OS  
newly.  
Select "Use the current File System" for the format of OS partition.  
Manual Installation when N8103-80F/81F/86 and SCSI HostRAID Keeps  
Connection  
If you keep those controllers connecting during installation process, pop-up messages may appear.  
This does not affect on system behavior. Click [YES] and continue the installation. Follow the  
message hereafter.  
MO Device  
If you specify the file system as NTFS with MO Device connected during the installation, the file  
system will not be converted normally. Disconnect MO Device and restart the installation from  
the beginning.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows 2000 F-3  
Partition Size  
The size for the partition that the system is to be installed can be calculated from the following  
formula.  
Size necessary to install the system + Paging File Size + Dump File Size  
+ Application Size  
Size necessary to install the system = 1000MB  
Paging File Size (Recommended) = Mounted Memory Size * 1.5  
Dump file Size  
Application Size  
= Mounted Memory Size + 12MB  
= Required Size  
IMPORTANT:  
The above-mentioned paging file size is recommended for  
collecting debug information (memory dump). The paging file with  
initial size large enough to store the dump file in the boot drive is  
required.  
Correct debug information might not be able to be collected due to  
virtual memory shortage when the paging file is insufficient, so set  
an enough size of the paging file with the entire system.  
The maximum paging file size which can be set on one partition is  
4095MB. If the above paging file size exceeds 4095MB, specify  
4095MB for the paging file size.  
The maximum dump file size for the system with more than 2GB  
memory mounted is '2048MB + 12MB'.  
If you install any application program or the like, add necessary  
space to the partition to install these programs.  
For example, if the mounted memory size is 512MB, the partition size will be calculated by the  
above formula as follows:  
1000MB + (512MB * 1.5) + (512MB + 12MB) + Application Size  
= 2292MB + Application Size  
Dividing into the partition of the recommended size into multiple disks as written below will solve  
problem that it cannot be reserved in one disk.  
1. Set the "Size required for installation + Paging file size".  
2. See Chapter 5 and set that debugging information (equivalent to the dump file size) is to  
be written to a separate disk.  
(If the disk does not have enough free space to enable the dump file size to be written,  
then after installing the system using the "Size required for installation + Paging file size",  
install an additional new disk.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F-4 Installing Windows 2000  
INSTALLING WINDOWS 2000  
Preparations for Installation  
NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM  
Microsoft Windows 2000 Server / Microsoft Windows 2000 Advanced Server (CD-ROM)  
Windows 2000 Service Pack (CD-ROM)  
User's Guide  
Getting Started  
Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER  
Creating "Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER"  
Before installing, create Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER.  
NOTE: If you have already "Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER" for NEC Express5800 Server which you are  
going to install Windows 2000, you do not need to create it again.  
You can create Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER with the following two  
procedures.  
Create from the menu which appears when running NEC Express5800 Server with NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER.  
If you have only NEC Express5800 Server to create Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER, use this procedure.  
If Windows Server 2003 or Windows 2000 can be operated on NEC Express5800 Server,  
you can use the other procedure described later.  
Follow the steps below.  
1. Prepare one 3.5-inch floppy disk.  
2. Turn on your NEC Express5800 Server.  
3. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of the Server.  
4. Press the RESET switch or press Ctrl, Alt and Delete to reboot the server .(You may also  
turn off and then on again to reboot the server.)  
The system will boot from the CD-ROM and NEC EXPRESSBUILDER starts.  
5. Select [Create Support Disk] from [Tools].  
6. Select [Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER] from [Create Support  
Disk] menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows 2000 F-5  
7. Insert a floppy disk into the floppy disk drive according to the instruction on the screen.  
Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER will be created.  
Write-protect and attach a label, then keep it safely.  
Create from [Master Control Menu]  
[Master Control Menu] runs on the following operating systems.  
– Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions  
– Windows Server 2003  
– Windows XP x64 Edition  
– Windows XP  
– Windows 2000  
– Windows Me/98/95  
– Windows NT 4.0  
You can create Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER from [Master  
Control Menu], if you have the computer on which the above operating systems operate.  
Follow the steps below.  
1. Prepare one 3.5-inch floppy disk.  
2. Run the operating system.  
3. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of the server.  
[Master Control Menu] will appear.  
4. Click on [Setup] with left mouse button and click [Make OEM-DISK] and then [for  
Windows 2000].  
NOTE: You can do the same operation with the menu appeared by the  
Right-click.  
5. Insert the floppy disk into the floppy disk drive according to the message.  
Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER will be created.  
Write-protect and attach a label, then keep it safely.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F-6 Installing Windows 2000  
Windows 2000 Clean Installation  
This section explains how to perform a clean installation of Windows 2000.  
1. Turn on the system power.  
2. Insert the Windows 2000 CD-ROM in the CD-ROM drive.  
3. Press Ctrl + Alt + Delete to reset the system.  
After a bootable operating system has been installed on the hard disk drive, press Enter  
while the message "Press any key to boot from CD..." is displayed at the top of the screen.  
If no bootable operating system exists on the hard disk drive, this step is unnecessary.  
The Windows 2000 setup screen will appear.  
If the screen is not displayed, Enter was not pressed properly.  
Begin after turning on the system power again.  
4. Press F6 while the message "Setup is inspecting your computer's hardware  
configuration..." is displayed at the upper part of the screen.  
IMPORTANT: There is no visible indication on screen when F6 has  
been pressed.  
5. When the following message is displayed, press S.  
Setup could not determine the type of one or more mass storage devices  
installed in your system, or you have chosen to manually specify an adapter.  
Currently, Setup will load support for the following mass storage devices.  
The following message is displayed.  
Please insert the disk labeled  
manufacturer-supplied hardware support disk  
into Drive A:  
*Press ENTER when ready.  
6. Insert the Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER into the floppy disk  
drive, and press Enter.  
A list of mass storage devices is displayed.  
Select the [Adaptec Ultra320 SCSI Cards (Win2000)] and press Enter.  
Then, it returns to the screen of Procedure 5.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows 2000 F-7  
7. Select the proper SCSI Adapter and press Enter.  
– Adaptec HostRAID U320 Driver Ver 1.02 For Windows 2000/XP/2003  
(When Adaptec HostRAID (SCSI) is installed.)  
– MegaRAID SCSI 320-1 Controller Driver  
(When N8103-80F board is installed.)  
– MegaRAID SCSI 320-2 Controller Driver  
(When N8103-81F board is installed.)  
– Adaptec I2O RAID Driver Disk for 32bit Windows 2000/XP/2003  
(When N8103-86 board is installed.)  
Continue performing tasks according to the subsequent messages that appear.  
After installation is completed, be sure to execute the tasks described in "Driver Installation and  
Advanced Settings" and "Updating the System" of this manual.  
Reinstallation to Multiple Logical Drives  
This subsection describes the procedure for reinstalling the operation system if the multiple logical  
drives exist.  
Before Re-installing the Operation System  
Be sure to make backup copies before re-installing the operation system just in case.  
Re-installing the Operation System  
1. Start the clean installation following the procedure described in this manual.  
2. Specify the partition in which you want to install the operating system when the following  
message appears:  
The following list shows the existing partitions and  
unpartitioned space on this computer.  
Use the UP and DOWN ARROW keys to select an item in the list.  
*
Cannot modify the drive letter of your system or boot volume. Confirm the proper  
drive letter is assigned and then, continue the setup.  
3. Continue the clean installation again following the procedure described earlier in this  
chapter.  
The drive letter of the re-installed system may differ from the one of the previous system.  
If you need to modify the drive letter, modify it according to the "Procedure for  
Modifying the Drive Letter".  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F-8 Installing Windows 2000  
Procedure for Modifying the Drive Letter  
Be careful that the drive letter of the system or boot volume cannot modify with the following  
procedure.  
1. Click Start menu, right-click [My Computer], and specify [Manage] to start [Computer  
Management].  
2. Specify the [Disk Management] in the left side of the window.  
3. Right-click the volume you want to modify the drive letter and specify the [Change Drive  
Letter and Path...].  
4. Click [Yes].  
5. Choose the [Assign a drive letter] and specify the drive letter you want to assign.  
6. Click [OK].  
7. If the following message appears, click [Yes].  
Changing the drive letter of a volume may cause programs to no  
longer run. Are you sure you want to change this drive letter?  
8. Close the [Computer Management].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows 2000 F-9  
Updating the System - Installing Service Pack -  
IMPORTANT: This system does not support Windows 2000 Service  
Pack 1 - 3.  
If you install Windows 2000 CD-ROM which contains Service Pack 4  
to your system, you do not have to apply Service Pack 4 again.  
NOTE: If you run the Update of System with the MO device  
connected, refer following attention.  
<If you insert the MO media>  
Remove MO media from the MO device immediately after clicking on  
[Restart Computer].  
<If you do not insert the MO media>  
If the message "There is no disk in the drive. ..." is shown during the  
Update of System, click [Cancel] or [Continue] and continue the  
update.  
To ensure normal system operation you should update your system using the following procedures.  
1. Logon to the system using the administrator account or other account which is a member  
of the Administrators group.  
2. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
Master Control Menu is automatically appeared on the screen.  
3. Click on [Setup] with left mouse button and click on [Update NEC Express5800 system]  
section.  
4. Continue your work for system update as the following message.  
5. Click on [Restart Computer] to restart the system.  
6. Remove the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive immediately  
after clicking on [Restart Computer]  
IMPORTANT: If you change the configuration of the system (by  
adding or removing hardware or Operating system software  
components) or repair the system, you must run the system update  
again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F-10 Installing Windows 2000  
DRIVER INSTALLATION AND ADVANCED SETTINGS  
This section describes on how to install and setup various standard drivers mounted on the device.  
For the information on installing and setting up the driver that is not described in this section, please  
refer to the document attached to the driver.  
PROSet  
PROSet is a utility that confirms the function of network contained in network driver. Be sure to  
install. Utilizing PROSet enables the following issues:  
Confirm detailed information of the adapter.  
Diagnose loop back test, packet transmission test and so on.  
Specify teaming.  
Configuring several network adapters as one team provides the server an environment tolerant on  
any trouble and enhance through put between the switches.  
PROSet is necessary to utilize these features.  
Follow the procedure below to install PROSet.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
2. Click Start menu, point to [Program], [Accessory] and click [Explorer].  
3. Run "PROSET.EXE" in the following directory.  
<CD-ROM DriveLetter>:\WINNT\W2K\BC5\PROSET\WIN2K\  
The [Intel(R) PROSet - InstallShield Wizard] dialog starts.  
4. Click [Next].  
5. Choose "I accept the terms in the license agreement" and click [Next].  
6. Choose "Typical" and click [Next].  
7. Click [Install].  
8. When [InstallShield Wizard Completed] window is displayed, click [Finish].  
9. Restart the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows 2000 F-11  
Network Driver  
[When PROSet is not installed]  
1. Click Start menu and click [Network and Dial-Up Connection].  
The [Network and Dial-Up Connection] dialog box appears.  
2. Right-click [Local Area Connection] and click [Properties] from pop-up menu.  
The [Local Area Connection Properties] dialog box appears.  
3. Click [Configure].  
The property dialog box for network adapter appears.  
4. Click the [Advanced] and specify the [Link Speed & Duplex]value the same as the value  
specified for HUB.  
5. Click [OK] on the property dialog box for network adapter.  
6. Click [OK] on the [Local Area Connection Properties] dialog box.  
Also, add or delete any protocols and services if necessary. You can operate the process from  
[Network and Dial-up Connection] to display the property dialog box for local area network.  
NOTE: We recommend you to add [Network Monitor] at [Adding  
Services]. [Network Monitor] can monitor the frame (or the packet) that  
the computer installing [Network Monitor] sends or receives. This tool  
is valuable when analyzing network trouble. For information on how to  
install the tool, see the "Setting for Solving Problems" in Chapter 5.  
[When PROSet is installed]  
1. Double-click [Intel(R) PROSet Wired] on the [Control Panel] window.  
The [Intel(R) PROSet for Wired Connections] dialog box appears. Double-click the  
[Intel(R) PROSet Wired] icon.  
2. Put the cursor to the network driver in the list.  
3. Click the [Advanced] and specify the [Link Speed & Duplex] value the same as the value  
specified for HUB.  
Also specify the other network driver with the same progress above.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F-12 Installing Windows 2000  
Re-install the Network Driver  
After installing OS and deleting the network drivers, if you want to re-install the network drivers,  
follow the procedure below.  
1. Restart OS and logon to your system.  
2. [Upgrade Device Driver Wizard] dialog box appears.  
Click [Next].  
3. Confirm that the [Search for a suitable driver for my device (recommended)] radio button  
is selected and click [Next].  
4. Select the [Specify a location] check box and deselect other check boxes.  
Click [Next].  
5. Other [Upgrade Device Driver Wizard] dialog box opens.  
When using [Intel(R) PRO/1000MT Dual Port Network Connection], specify [<CD-ROM  
drive letter>:\WINNT\W2K\BC5\PRO1000\WIN2K].  
Then click [OK].  
6. Click [Next].  
7. Click [Finished].  
After re-installing the network drivers, the link speed and Duplex mode need to be  
specified.  
Refer to "Network Driver" described earlier.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows 2000 F-13  
Graphics Accelerator Driver  
Standard graphics accelerator drivers that are mounted will be installed automatically.  
The following is the procedure when it is necessary to install manually.  
If you want to utilize optional Graphics Accelerator Driver board, follow the document attached to  
the board to install the driver.  
*
For the graphics accelerator driver, the use of a remote KVM console that installs the advanced  
N8115-02 remote management card is supported by the standard.  
1. Insert the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
2. Click Start menu, point to [Programs], [Accessories] and click [Windows Explorer]  
3. Run "SETUP.EXE" in the following directory.  
<CD-ROM Drive Letter>:\WINNT\W2K\VIDEO\SETUP.EXE  
4. Follow the message to continue the installation.  
If the dialog message "Digital Signature could not been found." appears, select [Yes] to  
continue. If the dialog message "Direct X Ver.8 isn't installed." appears, select [continue]  
to continue.  
5. Remove the NEC EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM from the CD-ROM drive, follow the  
direction on the screen and restart the system.  
USB 2.0 Driver  
USB 2.0 Driver is pre-installed. When restoring the system or re-installing the system, the driver is  
automatically installed in the process of updating the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F-14 Installing Windows 2000  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-65F/75)  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-65F/75), install it according to the following procedure:  
1. Start [Device Manager] from [Start] menu [Control Panel][Administrative Tools] →  
[Computer Management].  
2. Double click the SCSI Controller driver which Device Manager lists as unknown device.  
3. Click [Update Driver].  
4. When the "Update Device Driver Wizard" appears, select "Install from a list or specific  
location [Advanced]" and click [Next].  
5. Select "Don't search. I will choose the driver to install" and click [Next].  
6. Click [Have Disk..].  
7. Insert "Windows 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy disk  
drive, enter "a:\" into "copy manufacturer's file from:" and click [OK].  
8. Specify the following driver and click [Next].  
– [INITIO INI-A10XU2W PCI SCSI Controller] (When N8103-65F board is installed.)  
– [Adaptec SCSI Card 29320ALP - Ultra320 SCSI] (When N8103-75 board is installed.)  
The installation of the driver is completed.  
Restart the system according to the message appeared on the screen.  
Installing SCSI Controller Driver (N8103-56/-95/N8190-126)  
If you utilize SCSI controller driver (N8103-56/-95/N8190-126), update your system with NEC  
EXPRESSBUILDER CD-ROM attached to your system.  
The SCSI controller driver will be installed automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Windows 2000 F-15  
Installing RAID Controller Driver (N8103-80F/81F)  
To additionally install the N8103-80F/81F in a system containing Windows 2000, connect the  
controller and take the following steps to install the driver:  
1. When the [Found New Hardware Wizard] dialog box appears, click [Next].  
2. When the [Install Hardware Device Drivers] dialog box appears, select [Search for a  
suitable driver for my device (Recommended)], and click [Next].  
3. When the [Locate Driver Files] dialog box appears, select [Floppy disk drives], insert  
"Windows Server 2000 OEM-DISK for NEC EXPRESSBUILDER" into the floppy disk  
drive, and click [Next].  
4. When the [Driver Files Search Results] dialog box appears, click [Next].  
5. Copying of the driver is completed, and the [Completion of the new hardware detection  
wizard] dialog box below appears. Click [Complete].  
Available Switch Options for Windows 2000 Boot.ini File  
Many different switches will be available if you edit Boot.ini File.  
For the available switch options, refer to the following information:  
Microsoft Knowledge Base - Article ID: 170756  
"Available Switch Options for the Windows NT Boot.ini File"  
If your system has a memory capacity in excess of 4GB in its installing, adding /PAE switch in  
Boot.ini file will enable the system to be installed with over 4GB of memory.  
However, the Microsoft operating system products which support /PAE switch option are limited.  
Refer to the following article in Microsoft Knowledge Base to check the supported products.  
Microsoft Knowledge Base - Article ID: 291988  
"A description of the 4GB RAM tuning feature and the Physical Address Extension  
switch"  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F-16 Installing Windows 2000  
Below is the example on how to add /PAE switch to Boot.ini file.  
1. Click [Start], point to [Programs], point to [Accessories], and then click [Notepad].  
2. On the [File] menu, click [Open...].  
3. In the [Open] dialog box, in the [Look in] drop-down list box, click "%systemroot%"  
drive.  
4. In the [Open] dialog box, in the [Files of type] drop-down list box, click "All Files" and in  
the [File name] drop-down list box, enter "Boot.ini". And then, click [Open].  
The content of Boot.ini file will be displayed.  
5. Add "/PAE" to [Operating Systems] section in [Boot.ini] file, and then save it.  
<Example of Boot.ini file>  
[boot loader]  
timeout=30  
default=multi(0)disk(0)rdisk(0)partition(1)\WINNT  
[operating systems]  
multi(0)disk(0)rdisk(0)partition(1)\WINNT="Windows 2000" /fastdetect  
multi(0)disk(0)rdisk(0)partition(1)\WINNT="Windows 2000, PAE" /fastdetect /PAE  
This is the end of editing Boot.ini file.  
NOTE: If you choose one of the items in the "Default operating  
system" drop-down list box in [Setup and Recovery] group box, you  
can make your system start automatically from the switch you  
specified.  
SETTING FOR COLLECTING MEMORY DUMP  
(DEBUG INFORMATION)  
Set for collecting memory dump using the procedure described in Chapter 5.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix G  
Product Configuration Record Table  
Use this table for information about setup and system environment change.  
Hardware  
Main Unit  
Model name  
Serial No.  
Date Installed  
CPU  
#1  
Clock  
Clock  
Serial No.  
Serial No.  
Date Installed  
Date Installed  
#2  
Memory  
#1, #2  
#3, #4  
#5, #6  
#7, #8  
Monitor  
Size  
Size  
Size  
Size  
Serial No.  
Serial No.  
Serial No.  
Serial No.  
Date Installed  
Date Installed  
Date Installed  
Date Installed  
Type  
Model name  
Serial No.  
Date Installed  
Hard Disk Drive  
ID0  
Type  
Serial No.  
Capacity  
Type number  
Type  
Date Installed  
ID1  
ID2  
ID3  
ID4  
ID5  
Serial No.  
Capacity  
Type number  
Type  
Date Installed  
Serial No.  
Capacity  
Type number  
Type  
Date Installed  
Serial No.  
Capacity  
Type number  
Type  
Date Installed  
Serial No.  
Capacity  
Type number  
Type  
Date Installed  
Serial No.  
Capacity  
Type number  
Date Installed  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
G-2 Product Configuration Record Table  
Backup Device  
Slot 1  
Size  
Capacity  
Serial No.  
Model name  
Type number  
Date Installed  
PCI Slot #1B  
Model name  
Model name  
Model name  
Model name  
Model name  
Model name  
Serial No.  
Date Installed  
PCI Slot #2B  
PCI Slot #3B  
PCI Slot #1C  
PCI Slot #2C  
PCI Slot #3C  
Printer  
Serial No.  
Date Installed  
Serial No.  
Date Installed  
Serial No.  
Date Installed  
Serial No.  
Date Installed  
Serial No.  
Date Installed  
Model name  
Manufacturer  
Serial No.  
Date Installed  
Additional Cabinet for Disk  
Model name  
Serial No.  
Date Installed  
External Peripheral Device 1  
Model name  
Serial No.  
Manufacturer  
Date Installed  
External Peripheral Device 2  
Model name  
Serial No.  
Manufacturer  
Date Installed  
External Peripheral Device 3  
Model name  
Serial No.  
Manufacturer  
Date Installed  
External Peripheral Device 4  
Model name  
Serial No.  
Manufacturer  
Date Installed  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product Configuration Record Table G-3  
Software  
Firmware version  
OS  
Name:  
Name:  
HPFS  
Version:  
Version:  
Application of RUR media  
File system  
Apply  
FAT  
NTFS  
Others (  
)
Bundled software installed  
Licensed software installed  
Application running when a failure  
occurred  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
G-4 Product Configuration Record Table  
(This page is intentionally left blank.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Multi Tech Systems Network Card MultiConnect Adapter Serial to Ethernet Adapter with IP User Manual
National Instruments Marine RADAR NI USB 6525 User Manual
NewAir Air Conditioner AC14000E User Manual
Niles Audio Speaker CM4PR User Manual
Nokia Bluetooth Headset BH 903 User Manual
NordicTrack Home Gym NTHK99901 User Manual
NordicTrack Treadmill NTTL11992 User Manual
One for All TV Video Accessories SV 9031 User Manual
Panasonic DVD Player DVD A350A User Manual
Parasound Stereo Amplifier A 52 User Manual